vvEPA
           United States
           Environmental Protection
           Agency
            Water Engineering
            Research Laborat<
            Cincinnati OH 45!:
           Technology Transfer
Handbook
                       . --i Information
                     Cincinnati OH 452§8


                     EPA/625/6-87/bf7
            Retrofitting
            POTWs for Phosphorus
            Removal in the
            Chesapeake Bay
            Drainage Basin

-------

-------
                                    EPA/625/6-87/017
                                     September 1987
              Handbook


Retrofitting POTWs for Phosphorus
            Removal in the
 Chesapeake Bay Drainage  Basin
         U.S. Environmental Protection Agency
         Office of Research and Development

        Water Engineering Research Laboratory
              Cincinnati, OH 45268

      Center for Environmental Research Information
              Cincinnati, OH 45268

-------
                                       Notice
This document has  been reviewed in accordance with the U.S. Environmental Protection
Agency's peer and administrative review policies and approved for publication. Mention of trade
names or commercial products does not constitute endorsement or recommendation for use.

This document is not intended to be a guidance or support document for a specific regulatory
program. Guidance documents  are  available from EPA and  must be consulted to address
specific regulatory issues.

-------
                                    Contents
Chapter
Page
1   INTRODUCTION	   1

    1.1 Purpose  	   1
    1.2 Handbook Organization	   1

2   DESCRIPTION OF RETROFIT PHOSPHORUS REMOVAL TECHNOLOGIES  	   5

    2.1 Introduction	   5
    2.2 Items Common to Most Retrofitting Situations  	   5
       2.2.1 Insolubilization of Phosphorus Compounds   	   5
       2.2.2 Addition  of Metallic Salt	   6
       2.2.3 Addition  of Polymer 	   6
       2.2.4 Mixing Requirements	   6
       2.2.5 Sequence of Chemical and Physical Reactions  	   7
       2.2.6 Importance of Suspended Solids Control  	   7
       2.2.7 Engineering Guidance Provided on General Schematics 	   7
       2.2.8 Sludge Production at Facilities Retrofitted for Phosphorus Removal  	   7
       2.2.9 Sludge Production Related to Different Effluent TP Requirements.	   8
    2.3 Process Options for Retrofitting Existing CBDB Facilities
       to Achieve Phosphorus Control 	   9
       2.3.1 Retrofitting CBDB Facilities with Chemical Control of Phosphorus   	   9
       2.3.2 Retrofitting CBDB Facilities with Biological Control of Phosphorus   	   16
    2.4 References	   21

3   SUMMARY OF EXISTING PHOSPHORUS REMOVAL PERFORMANCE DATA	   23

    3.1 Introduction 	   23
    3.2 Chemical Phosphorus Removal	   23
       3.2.1 Effect of Application Point on Chemical Use   	   23
       3.2.2 Effect of Effluent Limit on Chemical Use  	   31
       3.2.3 Effect of Chemical Phosphorus Removal on Sludge Generation 	   31
       3.2.4 Effect of Chemical Phosphorus Removal on pH  	   36
       3.2.5 Cost of Chemicals	   36
    3.3 Biological Phosphorus Removal  	   38
       3.3.1 PhoStrip Process  	:	   38
       3.3.2 A/O Process	   39
    3.4 References 	   40

-------
                              Contents (continued)
Chapter
Page
4   PROCESS DESIGN SYNOPSES FOR RETROFITTING CHEMICAL
    PHOSPHORUS REMOVAL  	   41

    Design Synopsis 1: Plug Flow, Complete Mix, and Step Aeration
       Activated Sludge Systems  	   42
    Design Synopsis 2: Contact Stabilization Activated Sludge Systems  	   45
    Design Synopsis 3: Pure Oxygen Activated Sludge Systems  	   48
    Design Synopsis 4: Extended Aeration and Oxidation Ditch
       Activated Sludge Systems  	   51
    Design Synopsis 5: Two-Stage Nitrification Activated Sludge Systems   .	   54
    Design Synopsis 6: High-Rate Trickling Filter Systems    	   57
    Design Synopsis 7: Standard-Rate Trickling Filter Systems	 .   60
    Design Synopsis 8: RBC Systems  	   63
    Design Synopsis 9: Lagoon Systems	   66

5   HARDWARE DESIGN AND O&M CONSIDERATIONS FOR CHEMICAL PHOSPHORUS
    REMOVAL IN SMALL TO MEDIUM PLANTS (<10 MGD)		   69

    5.1 Introduction	   69
    5.2 Aluminum Compounds  	   69
       5.2.1 Dry Alum	   69
       5.2.2 Liquid Alum  	   71
       5.2.3 Dry Sodium Aluminate	   73
       5.2.4 Liquid Sodium Aluminate  	   75
       5.2.5 Aluminum Chloride  	   76
    5.3 Iron Compounds  	   77
       5.3.1 Liquid Ferric Chloride	   77
       5.3.2 Ferrous Chloride (Waste Pickle Liquor)	   79
       5.3.3 Ferric Sulfate  	   79
       5.3.4 Ferrous Sulfate  	   80
    5.4 Polyelectrolytes  	   80
       5.4.1 Dry Polymers  	   80
       5.4.2 Liquid Polymers   	   81
    5.5 Design of Chemical Feed Systems  	   83
       5.5.1 Chemical Feed Systems  	   83
       5.5.2 Chemical Feeders	   83
       5.5.3 Sizing Chemical  Feed System Components 	   86
       5.5.4 Optimum Feed Points and Feed Point Flexibility	   87
       5.5.5 Room Layouts for Chemical Storage, Preparation, and Pumping  	   87
    5.6 Chemical Equipment Suppliers  	   88
    5.7 Staffing  Requirements for Chemical Addition  	   88
    5.8 Sludge Considerations  	   99
    5.9 Laboratory Requirements 	    100
    5.10 Safety  and OSHA Requirements for Chemical Addition	    100
       5.10.1 Ferric Chloride   	-	    100
       5.10.2 Polymer  	    102
       5.10.3 OSHA Requirements  	    103
    5.11 References  	• • •    103
                                         IV

-------
                             Contents (continued)
Chapter                                                                    Page

6  PROCESS AND HARDWARE DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS FOR RETROFITTING
   ACTIVATED SLUDGE PLANTS WITH BIOLOGICAL PHOSPHORUS REMOVAL   ..   105

   6.1 Introduction  	   105
   6.2 PhoStrip Process	   105
       6.2.1 Conditions Prerequisite to PhoStrip Retrofit  	   105
       6.2.2 Design Considerations  	x.	   105
       6.2.3 Attainability of Effluent Limits	   107
       6.2.4 Lime Handling	   107
   6.3 A/O Process	   107
       6.3.1 A/O Operating Conditions	   108
       6.3.2 Design Considerations	   108
       6.3.3 Attainability of Effluent Limits  	   109

7  COMPATIBILITY OF CHEMICAL AND BIOLOGICAL PHOSPHORUS REMOVAL
   WITH NITROGEN CONTROL	   111

   7.1 Introduction  	   111
   7.2 Process Considerations for Complying with Dual Nutrient
       Control Requirements	   111
       7.2.1 Control of Process pH Value  	   111
       7.2.2 Biomass Environmental Management	   112
       7.2.3 Engineering Aspects	   112
   7.3 Dual Process Removal and Nitrification Processes  	   113
       7.3.1 Chemical Phosphorus Removal and Nitrification  	   113
       7.3.2 Biological Phosphorus Removal and Nitrification	   113
       7.3.3 Oxygen Requirements for Nitrification   	   114
   7.4 Dual Phosphorus Removal and Nitrogen Removal Processes   	   114
       7.4.1 Phosphorus and Nitrogen Removal with  Multi-Stage Biological
            Processes Supplemented with Chemicals 	   114
       7.4.2 Phosphorus and Nitrogen Removal with Managed Biological Systems   ...   115
   7.5 References  	   120

8  ESTIMATING COSTS FOR CHEMICAL PHOSPHORUS REMOVAL IN THE CBDB .   123

   8.1 Introduction	   123
   8.2 Illustrative Example	   125
   8.3 References  	;	: . .   126

-------
                              Contents (continued)
Chapter

9   FACTORS AFFECTING IMPLEMENTATION OF PHOSPHORUS REMOVAL
    IN THE CBDB  	
Page
  133
    9.1 Introduction	   133
    9.2 Cost to Implement Phosphorus Removal  	   133
    9.3 Comparison of Chemical and Biological Retrofit Systems   	   133
       9.3.1 Effect of Excessive Infiltration/Inflow on Process Selection   	   133
       9.3.2 Process Reliability 	   133
       9.3.3 Potential Technological Advances  	   134
       9.3.4 Impact of License Fees  	   134
       9.3.5 Degree of Operation and Control Difficulty 	   134
       9.3.6 Additional Staffing Requirements  	   134
       9.3.7 Degree of Maintenance Difficulty  	   135
    9.4 Administrative Issues  	   135
       9.4.1 Planning and Construction Period Schedules	   135
       9.4.2 Operator Training Seminars	   135
    9.5 References 	•   135
                                         VI

-------
                                        Figures
Number
Page
2-1    Sequence of increased liquid/solids separation and phosphorus removal	   8
2-2    Importance of effluent TSS on effluent TP  	   8
2-3    Retroffiting plug flow, step aeration, complete mix, pure oxygen,
       and single-stage nitrification activated sludge systems for
       chemical phosphorus removal	-	   11
2-4    Retrofitting extended aeration and oxidation ditch activated
       sludge systems for chemical phosphorus removal	 .	   12
2-5    Retrofitting contact stabilization activated sludge systems for
       chemical phosphorus removal	   13
2-6    Retrofitting two-stage biological nitrification systems for
       chemical phosphorus removal	   14
2-7    Retrofitting standard-rate trickling filters for chemical
       phosphorus removal	   15
2-8    Retrofitting high-rate trickling  filters for chemical phosphorus removal   	   16
2-9    Retrofitting RBCs for chemical phosphorus removal  	   17
2-10   Retrofitting wastewater lagoons for chemical phosphorus removal  	   18
2-11   Retrofitting plug flow, step aeration, complete mix, and pure
       oxygen activated sludge systems with the Phostrip process for
       phosphorus removal		   19
2-12   Retrofiting plug flow, step aeration, and pure oxygen activated
       sludge systems with the A/O  process for biological phosphorus removal  	   20
2-13   Conceptual  sequence of  reactions in the A/O process	   21

3-1    Alum-to-influent TP ratio  vs. effluent TP concentration	   32
3-2    Ferric iron-to-influent TP  ratio vs. effluent TP concentration    	   32
3-3    Sludge generation rate vs. effluent TP concentration   	   36
3-4    Sludge generated  vs. metal ion-to-influent TP ratio     	   37

5-1    Dry feed system alternatives   	   72
5-2    Viscosity of alum solutions	   74
5-3    Liquid chemical feed system alternatives for elevated storage  	   75
5-4    Liquid chemical feed system  alternatives for ground storage   	   75
5-5    Freezing point curve for commercial ferric chloride solutions	   77
5-6    Viscosity vs. composition of ferric chloride solutions at various temperatures   ...   78
5-7    Manual dry  polymer feed system	   82
5-8    Automatic dry polymer feed system	   82
5-9    Plunger-type metering pump   	   84
5-10   Diaphragm-type metering pump    	   84
5-11   Screw feeder	   86
5-12   Beam balance-type gravimetric feeder   	   87
                                           VII

-------
                                Figures (continued)
Number	   Page
5-13
5-13
5-13
5-13
5-13
5-13
5-13
5-13
5-13
5-13

6-1
6-2
7-1

7-2

7-3

7-4

7-5


8-1

8-2

8-3

8-4

8-5

8-6

8-7

8-8
Typical
Typical
Typical
Typical
Typical
Typical
Typical
Typical
Typical
Typical
chemical
chemical
chemical
chemical
chemical
chemical
chemical
chemical
chemical
chemical
system
system
system
system
system
system
system
system
system
system
layout No. 1
layout No. 2
layout No. 3
layout No. 4
layout No. 5
layout No. 6
layout No. 7
layout No. 8
layout No. 9
layout No. 10
Phostrip process flow diagram  	
A/O process flow diagrams 	
Multi-stage biological process supplemented with chemicals for
combined nitrogen and phosphorus removal  	
Schematic of an activated sludge system retrofitted for the
A2/O process   	
Schematic of an activated sludge system retrofitted for the
Bardenpho process  	
Schematic of an activated sludge system retrofitted for the
UCT process   	
Schematic of activated sludge system retrofitted for the
modified  Bardenpho process   	
Estimated chemical phosphorus removal costs for an influent
TP range of 6 -10 mg/l and an effluent TP limitation of 2 mg/l
Estimated chemical phosphorus removal costs for an influent
TP range of 6 -10 mg/l and an effluent TP limitation of 1 mg/l.
Estimated chemical phosphorus removal costs for an influent
P range of 6 -10 mg/l and an effluent TP limitation of 0.5 mg/l
Estimated chemical phosphorus removal costs for an influent
TP range of 6 -10 mg/l and an effluent TP limitation of 0.2 mg/l
Estimated chemical phosphorus removal costs for an influent
TP range of 3 - 6 mg/l and an effluent TP limitation of 2 mg/l.
Estimated chemical phosphorus removal costs for an influent
TP range of 3 - 6 mg/l and an effluent TP limitation of 1 mg/l
Estimated chemical phosphorus removal costs for an influent
TP range of 3 - 6 mg/l and an effluent TP limitation of 0.5 mg/l
Estimated chemical phosphorus removal costs for an influent
TP range of 3 - 6 mg/l and an effluent TP limitation of 0.2 mg/l.
 89
 90
 91
 92
 93
 94
 95
 96
 97
 98

106
109

116

117

119

120

121


124

125

126

127

128

129

130

131
                                          VIII

-------
                                       Tables
Number
                                                                         Page
1-1
1-2

2-1

3-1

3-2

3-3

3-4

3-5

3-6

3-7

3-8

3-9

3-10

3-11

3-12

3-13
3-14
3-15
3-16

3-17

5-1
5-2
5-3
5-4
5-5
5-6
5-7
5-8
5-9
CBDB Plant Matrix  	
Summary of Handbook Contents
 2
 3
Sludge Production With and Without Chemical Addition	   9
Phosphorus Removal Performance and Cost Data for Existing
Plug Flow Activated Sludge Plants   	
Phosphorus Removal Performance and Cost Data for Existing
Complete Mix Activated Sludge Plants	
Phosphorus Removal Performance and Cost Data for Existing
Contact Stabilization Activated Sludge Plants	
Phosphorus Removal Performance and Cost Data for Existing
Pure Oxygen Activated Sludge Plants	
Phosphorus Removal Performance and Cost Data for Existing
Step Aeration Activated Sludge Plants	
Phosphorus Removal Performance and Cost Data for Existing
Extended Aeration Activated Sludge  Plants	
Phosphorus Removal Performance and Cost Data for Existing
Two-Stage Nitrification Activated Sludge Plants    	
Phosphorus Removal Performance and Cost Data for Existing
High-Rate Trickling Filter Plants	
Phosphorus Removal Performance and Cost Data for Existing
Standard-Rate Trickling Filter Plants    	
Phosphorus Removal Performance and Cost Data for Existing
RBC Plants	
Phosphorus Removal Performance and Cost Data for Existing
Oxidation Ditch Plants	
Metal lon-to-lnfluent TP  Ratio (Weight Basis) for Various Points
of Application	
Summary Information on Selected POTWs in the CBDB  	
Summary Information on Selected POTWs in Michigan  	
Average Chemical Cost for Phosphorus Removal  	
Summary of PhoStrip Plant Operating Conditions for Lansdale
and Little Patuxent	
Pontiac A/O Wastewater Treatment Facility Performance Data  . .  .
Available Grades of Dry Alum	
Solubility of Alum at Various Temperatures  	
Dry Alum Suppliers to the Chesapeake Bay Area  	
Crystallization Temperatures of Liquid Alum	
Liquid Alum Suppliers to the Chesapeake Bay Area  	
Dry Sodium Aluminate Supplier to the Chesapeake Bay Area  . .
Liquid Sodium Aluminate Suppliers to the Chesapeake Bay Area
Aluminum Chloride Supplier to the Chesapeake Bay Area   	
Liquid Ferric Chloride Suppliers to the Chesapeake Bay Area  . .
24

25

26

26

27

27

28

28

29

30

30

31
33
34
37

39
40

69
69
71
73
74
76
76
77
78
                                          IX

-------
                                Tables (continued)
Number  	   Pa9e

5-10   Ferrous Chloride Supplier to the Chesapeake Bay Area   	  80
5-11   Properties of Ferric Sulfate  	  80
5-12   Ferric Sulfate Suppliers to the Chesapeake Bay Area 	  81
5-13   Ferrous Sulfate Supplier to the Chesapeake Bay Area   	  81
5-14   Polymer Suppliers to the Chesapeake Bay Area  	  81
5-15   Types of Chemical Feeders  	  88
5-16   Dry Chemical Feeder Suppliers	  99
5-17   Chemical Feed Pump Suppliers   	   100
5-18   Polymer Preparation  Systems 	•	   101
5-19   Chemical Storage Tanks  	   101
5-20   Manpower Required  to Operate and Maintain Chemical Feed Systems  	   102
5-21   Comparison of Filter  Yields With and Without Alum Addition   	   102
5-22   Estimated Sampling and Analytical Needs for Phosphorus Removal
       by Chemical Addition	   103

9-1    Estimated Capital Costs to Retrofit CBDB Plants for Phosphorus Removal Using
       Chemical Addition, Arranged by Influent TP, Effluent TP, and Design Flow  ....   134
9-2    Estimated Capital Costs to Retrofit CBDB Plants for Phosphorus
       Removal Using Chemical Addition; influent TP Range: 6-10 mg/l    	   135
9-3    Estimated Capital Costs to Retrofit CBDB Plants for Phosphorus
       Removal Using Chemical Addition; Influent TP Range: 3 - 6 mg/l   .	 .   136
9-4    Estimated Annual Chemical Costs for Phosphorus Removal	   136
9-5    Comparison of Chemical and Biological Retrofit Systems  	   137
9-6    Estimated Time Periods for Retrofitting an Existing Plant to
       Phosphorus Removal	   137

-------
                              Acknowledgments
Many individuals contributed  to  the  preparation  and review of this  handbook. Contract
administration was provided by the Center for Environmental Research Information, Cincinnati,
Ohio.

Major Author:
Shin Joh Rang - McNamee, Porter & Seeley, Ann Arbor, Ml

Contributing Authors:
Victor I. Cooperwasser - McNamee, Porter & Seeley, Ann Arbor, Ml
Lucy B. Pugh - McNamee, Porter & Seeley, Ann Arbor, Ml
Edwin F. Earth - BarthTec, Cincinnati, OH

Reviewers:
Walter G.  Gilbert - EPA-OIG,  Washington,  DC
Wen H. Huang - EPA-OMPC, Washington,  DC                       .          •
Richard M. Kashmanian - EPA-OPPE, Washington,  DC
Richard C. Brenner -  EPA-WERL,  Cincinnati, OH
Orville E.  Macomber - EPA-CERI,  Cincinnati, OH
Joseph  J.  Macknis - EPA-Chesapeake Bay  Program, Annapolis,  MD
Peter S. Tinsley  - Maryland DHMH, Baltimore, MD
Khandu Patel - Maryland DHMH, Baltimore, MD
James F. Smith - North Carolina DEM, Raleigh,  NC
Timothy E. Carpenter - Pennsylvania DER, Harrisburg, PA
Richard I.  Sedlak - The Soap and Detergent Assoviation, New  York, NY
P. Mac Berthouex - University  of Wisconsin,  Madison, Wl
Ed  D.  Smith  - USDA-CERL,  Champaign, IL
Alan E. Pollock - Virginia WCB, Richmond, VA

Contract Project Officer:
Denis J. Lussier  - EPA-CERI, Cincinnati, OH
                                         XI

-------

-------
                                             Chapter 1
                                           Introduction
1.1 Purpose
The  states of Maryland,  Pennsylvania, and  Virginia
have many  wastewater treatment  facilities that
discharge into the Chesapeake Bay Drainage Basin
(CBDB).  For the protection of the ecology of the
Chesapeake  Bay, phosphorus removal  has been
implemented at  selected  treatment  facilities and
needs to be instituted at a greater number of sites.

This document assesses the technology, economics,
and  efficiency  of phosphorus removal  processes
available for  use in the CBDB to achieve required
levels  of protection.  Since phosphorus removal
requirements in  the  CBDB  vary  a great  deal with
geographical  location, this assessment includes the
feasibility of achieving effluent  total phosphorus (TP)
concentrations  of 0.2, 0.5,  1,  and  2 mg/l. Also
addressed is the impact that a requirement for either
nitrification or nitrogen removal has on phosphorus
removal processes.

The  information base for this document includes data
collected  from  various  municipal  wastewater
treatment facilities in  the United  States,  particularly
those located in the CBDB and  the  Great Lakes
Drainage Basin, as well as from other sources.

This document is a reference manual for government
officials,  design engineers and  plant operators in the
CBDB to assist them  in retrofitting existing treatment
plants to remove phosphorus.

This document covers the following broad areas:

1. Chemical phosphorus  removal information  is
   tailored to reflect  those factors specific to the
   CBDB,  i.e., influent   phosphorus, effluent
   phosphorus, and plant type.

2. Biological phosphorus removal technologies are a
   recent development and may  be feasible at this
   time  for retrofitting certain plants  in the CBDB.
   Biological phosphorus  removal discussions  and
   data are also tailored to reflect conditions specific
   to the CBDB.
3.  Several  plants in  the CBDB  may  require
   concurrent phosphorus and  nitrogen  removal.
   Information is presented to enable engineers to
   select appropriate  phosphorus removal  systems
   that  will  be compatible with current or  future
   nitrogen removal requirements.

4.  Data presented  correspond to the  sizes of plants
   and process types found in the CBDB. Influent TP
   concentration  ranges of 6 to 10 mg/l and 3 to 6
   mg/l and effluent TP limits of 2, 1, 0.5, and 0.2
   mg/l are considered.

Based on data provided  by Virginia,  Maryland,  and
Pennsylvania environmental agencies, there are  526
municipal wastewater plants discharging to the CBDB
from  these  three  states (144  in  Virginia,  219 in
Maryland,  and 163 in Pennsylvania). Ninety-nine of
these plants are removing phosphorus (10 in Virginia,
28 in Maryland,  and 61  in Pennsylvania). Seventy-
eight  plants are achieving nitrification. In addition, a
number of extended  aeration  plants are known to
nitrify seasonly.  A  matrix  showing  the  design
capacities and types of these plants is given in Table
1 -1 .
1.2 Handbook Organization
Table 1-2 presents  a brief  summary of each of the
nine chapters that compose  this document.

-------
Table 1-1.    CBDB Plant Matrix
Design Flow (mgd)1
Plant Type
Activated Sludge - Plug Ftaw


Activated Sludge - Complete Mix

Activated Sludge - Contact
Stabilization

Activated Sludge - Pure Oxygen


Activated Sludge - Step Aeration


Activated Sludge - Extended
Aeration

Trickling Filter - High Rate


Trickling Filter - Standard Rate


Rotating Biological Contactors


Combined Trickling Filter-
Activated Sludge

Others*


Total


Grand Total
State
VA
MD
PA
VA
MD
PA
VA
MD
PA
VA
MD
PA
VA
MD
PA
VA
MD
PA
VA
MD
PA
VA
MD
PA
VA
MD
PA
VA
MD
PA
VA
MD
PA
VA
MD
PA

< 0.1
.
_
2(1)
46(0)

-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
12(0)
74(0)
9(1)
-
9(0)
-
3(0)
6(0)
2(0)
1 (0)
3(0)
-
-
-
-
16(0)
-
1(1)
32(0)
138 (0)
14(3)
184 (3)
0.1 -1
,
-
18(4)
13(5)

3(0)
-
8(4)
-
-
-
-
-
-
14(0)
17(2)
46(11)
1 (0)
10(0)
-
6(0)
1 (0)
12(3)
3(0)
7(2)
-
1 (0)
-
2(2)
34(0)
-
-
62(0)
48(9)
86 (24)
196 (33)
1 -5
-
-
21 (10)
5(0)
5(4)
1 (0)
4(2)
-
10(5)
-
-
-
-
-
-
2(0)
5(2)
5(1)
6(0)
6(0)
-
-
-
7(6)
1 (0)
1 (1)
-
1 (1)
-
-
5(1)
-
-
24(4)
17(7)
44 (22)
85 (33)
5- 10
2(0)
-
4(3)
3(0)
2(1)
1(1)
-
-
2(2)
-
1 (0)
1 (0)
-
-
-
1 0)
1(0)
1(1)
2(1)
-
-
-
1 (1)
-
-
-
-
- -
1 (D
-
-
-
6(1)
6(5)
11 (8)
23 (14)
> 10
3(0)
-
3(1)
5(1)
4(4)
-
-
-
2(1)
6(0)
2(2)
2(2)
2(1)
"
-
KD
3(1)
-
-

-
-
1 (0)
1 (0)
1 (1)
-
-
-
-
-
3(1)
-
-
20(5)
10(7)
8(4)
38 (16)
Total by
State1
5(0)
-
48(19)
13(1)
70 (15)
2(1)
7(2)
-
22(12)
5(0)
3(3)
3(2)
2(1)
~
-
29 (1)
100 (6)
61 (13)
8(1)
27(1)
-
9(0)
8(0)
23 (10)
6(1)
11 (3)
-
2(1)
*
3(3)
58(2)
-
1 (1)
144 (10)
219 (28)
163 (61)
526 (99)
Grand
Totali
53 (19)


85 (17)

29 (14)


11 (5)


2(1)


190(20)

35(2)


40 (10)


17(4)


5(4)


59(3)


526 (99)



   1 Plants already removing phosphorus are indicated in parentheses.
   2 Oxidation ditches, lagoons, activated sludge nitrification, Griffith system, overland flow, primary treatment, combined trickling filter-rotating
    biological contactors.

-------
Table 1-2.    Summary of Handbook Contents

	    Chapter	Description
 1. Introduction

 2. Description of Retrofit
    Phosphorus Removal
    Technologies

 3. Summary of Existing
    Phosphorus Removal
    Performance Data
 4. Process Design
    Considerations for
    Retrofitting Chemical
    Phosphorus Removal

 5. Hardware Design and
    O&M Considerations for
    Chemical Phosphorus
    Removal in Small to
    Medium Plants [< 0.44
    m3/s (10 mgd)]

 6. Process and Hardware
    Design Considerations
    for Retrofitting Activated
    Sludge Plants with
    Biological Phosphorus
    Removal
 7. Compatibility of
    Chemical and Biological
    Phosphorus Removal
    with Nitrogen Control

 8. Cost Estimates for
    Chemical Phosphorus
    Removal in the CBDB
  9.  Potential Effects of
     Various Implementation
     Factors on Phosphorus
     Planning in the CBDB
Introduction and guide for using
handbook.
General engineering considerations
for retrofittting plants to remove
phosphorus by chemical addition or
biological uptake.
Tabulation of performance and
costs data from selected plants in
the United States and Canada
Process design synopsis sheets for
chemical addition retrofit for each
process type, plant size, influent
phosphorus range, and effluent
phosphorus limit.
Information on chemical
characteristics, suppliers, and
costs; chemical storage and
feeding; typical chemical feed
system layouts; safety
considerations; and laboratory and
safety requirements.
Detailed analysis and comparison
of the A/O and Phostrip biological
phosphorus removal  processes.
The effects of combined
phosphorus and nitrogen control on
the engineering requirements for
retrofitting plants by chemical
addition or biological uptake.

Estimated capital, annual chemical,
and annual chemical plus amortized
chemical system capital cost
graphs for retrofitting plants to
chemical phosphorus removal in
the CBDB.

Broad factors in implementing
phosphorus removal in the CBDB,
including total area-wide costs for
retrofitting (at different influent
phosphorus levels and different
effluent phosphorus limits), a
comparison of key factors affecting
chemical and biological retrofit
systems, impact of license fees,
difficulty of process operation,
additional staffing required, degree
of maintenance difficulty,
 implementation schedules,, and
operator training requirements.

-------

-------
                                            Chapter 2
                  Description of Retrofit Phosphorus Removal Technologies
2.1 Introduction

A variety of wastewater treatment processes exist in
the CBDB. These facilities range in design complexity
from lagoon systems to various modifications of the
activated sludge process.

Experience gained at numerous  treatment plants in
the Great  Lakes Drainage  Basin between the  late
1960s and early  1980s has  shown that some degree
of phosphorus removal can  be retrofitted into almost
any existing facility. In a specific retrofit situation, the
degree of compliance with a required effluent TP limit
is related  to process  configuration, organic  and
hydraulic loadings, and operator dedication.

This chapter presents a simplified  explanation of
phosphorus removal chemistry and discusses general
engineering  considerations for  retrofitting  existing
plants  to control effluent  phosphorus using  either
chemical addition or  biological  uptake technology. In
some cases  where very stringent effluent TP limits
are imposed, it may be cost-effective  to utilize  a
combination  of biological and  chemical  phosphorus
removal  retrofit alternatives. Later in  this chapter, a
series  of flow diagrams (Figures 2-3 through 2-10)
is given that represents the  complete array of existing
suspended growth and  fixed film processes in the
CBDB. These figures are schematics that indicate the
location of  retrofitted equipment and chemical dosing
points  and provide  general  engineering  guidance
related  to  chemical  dosing  and clarification
requirements to  meet specific  effluent TP  limits.
Retrofit  requirements for  each  type of treatment
process  installed  in the CBDB (refer to Chapter 1 for
list of processes) will be addressed in detail later in
this manual.  However,  several items  are common to
most of the engineering  decisions  necessary  for
retrofitting  and  are discussed in this chapter. Table
9-5  compares  key factors affecting chemical  and
biological retrofit systems.

2.2 Items  Common to Most Retrofitting
Situations
Successful  phosphorus   control  depends  on
insolubilization of phosphorus compounds, either by
chemical or  biological reactions. Conditioning of the
insoluble  floe formed is necessary to promote good
settling properties, and unit processes  should be
provided with adequate capacities to ensure efficient
liquid-solids  separation.

2.2.7 Insolubilization of Phosphorus Compounds
Raw municipal  wastewater contains a  mixture  of
phosphorus  compounds  in the  organically-bound,
polyphosphate,  and orthophosphate forms.  The
orthophosphate  form is  the species that is most
efficiently insolubilized by the various chemicals used
to precipitate phosphorus.

Organic phosphorus compounds can settle out and
be  incorporated in  the primary  sludge  or be
biologically  converted to the orthophosphate  form  if
transferred to the secondary portion  of the treatment
process.  Polyphosphates are soluble compounds that
pass through primary treatment into the secondary
treatment process where biological enzymatic activity
converts them  to the orthophosphate form.
Orthophosphates are soluble, and if not insolubilized
by some mechanism, either deliberate or natural, will
pass  completely through  primary  and  secondary
processes and appear in the final effluent.

This chemistry  has  process  implications. Since
polyphosphates  are not  efficiently   insolubilized by
metallic salt cations, dosing of raw wastewater for
removal of phosphorus in primary treatment is less
effective  than use of metallic  salt  cations after the
polyphosphates  have  been  converted  to
Orthophosphates.  The lowest  primary  effluent TP
concentration that can be practically achieved by
metallic salt addition to raw wastewater is 1.5 to  2
mg/l.  Once all  forms of  phosphorus  have been
converted  to   orthophosphate,  the  chemical
insolubilization of phosphorus  with  a metallic  salt
cation  (M3 + ),  or biological  incorporation  of
phosphorus  into biomass,  can be viewed as follows:
           M3+  + PO43--» MPO4
(2-1)
              Enzymes
 Biomass + PO43: -» Biomass bound polyphosphates i
                                          (2-2)

-------
In the case of biological insolubilization, the biomass
converts  soluble  orthophosphate  to  intracellular
insoluble polyphosphates, which can be removed  in
the waste sludge.

2.2.2 Addition of Metallic Salt
Many of the schematics in this chapter show more
than one site of  injection of metallic  salt into the
wastewater flow.  Experience  has shown  that with
stringent effluent TP limits such as 0.5 mg/l or less, it
is desirable to  have multi-point  injection  capability.
This arrangement is;~caljed split dosing and results in
a  lower overall  mole ratio of metallic salt cation  to
phosphorus,  thereby  enhancing  insolubilization. For
less stringent effluent limits, such as 1 or 2 mg/l TP,
a  single injection  site  may  be adequate.  In either
case, however, since the capital cost of an additional
pump and piping  is  small, multi-injection capability
should be considered in any retrofitting plan.

The general practice in split  dosing  is to apply the
metal salt dose in  a ratio of 2:1, divided between the
first and  second injection sites, respectively.
Adjustment of this split may be necessary to suit local
circumstances.
In any retrofit flow scheme with a primary clarifier, it is
worthwhile  to  consider  selection  of  the primary
influent as the first chemical  injection  site. The
addition of metal salt and  polymer in the  influent  to
the primary clarifier improves the suspended solids
and organic substances capture  capability of this
process unit.  This  approach maximizes primary
sludge  production and,  if anaerobic  digestion  of
sludges  is  practiced, increases  total  methane
production. In  addition, the  increased  efficiency  of
primary clarification reduces the  organic load to the
secondary biological process.  This can  result  in less
secondary sludge  production and aeration energy
requirements,  as well  as  assist in  achieving
nitrification, if desired.

The actual  site  for  chemical  injection  into the
secondary portion  of a treatment process depends on
local conditions of accessibility, turbulence, and the
existing type of treatment process. Dosing points can
be selected at  the influent end of the reactor, at the
exit end of the  reactor, at intermediate points within
the reactor, between the reactor and final clarifier,  or
using various combinations thereof.

As noted  above, dosing into the secondary portion of
a treatment process is more efficient than dosing the
primary portion.  Not only is it certain that phosphorus
exists  as  orthophosphate, but  the  flow and
concentration peaks can be somewhat dampened by
the volumetric dilution afforded  by  the  secondary
reactor tankage.

2.2.3 Addition of Polymer
Most of the schematics in  this chapter  show the
addition of polymer in combination with metallic salt
addition. Experience has shown that the efficiency of
liquid-solids separation can be enhanced by polymer
addition.  However,  the  application of  polymers in
wastewater treatment is more art than science. While
anionic polymers  are usually the* most  effective
polyelectrolytes in combination with metallic salts, the
actual  type,  brand, and  concentration  must  be
determined on site. Suppliers are willing to assist in
conducting laboratory jar  tests for selection of the
most suitable product.

Deciding on the need for  polymer  can be guided by
laboratory jar tests. Since the capital cost for polymer
storage and dosing equipment is minimal,  however,
polymer  addition  should be  considered in  any
retrofitting plan. Provision for  polymer addition is
essential if phosphorus removal in the primary portion
of treatment is to be optimized and  in cases where an
effluent of 0.5 mg/l TP or less is  required. Polymer
addition  may not  be  necessary in  cases where
metallic salt  is added  to the  secondary portion of
treatment and/or the effluent TP requirements are 1
or 2 mg/l.

For the most efficient utilization  of polymer, some
finite  time  period  must be  provided  between
introduction  of metallic  precipitant  and  addition of
polymer.  The insolubilization reaction  between
metallic salt and orthophosphate must be completed
before polymer becomes  effective. A time lapse  of 1
to 5 minutes has been found to be suitable (1).

2.2.4 Mixing Requirements
Maximization of metallic  salt and  polymer  utilization
requires provision for adequate mixing. At the addition
points, conditions for rapid mixing are essential.  This
is necessary for  several  reasons. Contact  between
reacting  molecules must  be  provided, and  short-
circuiting  must be  prevented. Also,  the  chemical
solutions added have a greater density  and viscosity
and may  be  of  a different temperature  than the
wastewater.

Rapid mix conditions may exist at points of turbulence
caused by hydraulic jumps, aeration  apparatus, or
pump  impellers.  In some cases,  if rapid  mix
conditions do  not exist,  in-line  static mixers or
impeller-type mixers may  have to be  retrofitted at
the points of chemical addition.

After rapid mixing of the chemical additives,  a short
period of gentle mixing  must  be  provided to  allow
newly formed individual floe particles  to agglomerate
into a settleable sludge mass. Suitable conditions can
usually be found in exit piping from reactors, entrance
sections of clarifiers, or center wells of clarifiers,  if so
equipped. It is  seldom necessary to retrofit for  slow
mix conditions;  hydraulic  motion  between  unit
processes usually suffices. It is important to realize,
however,  that agglomeration   must occur  for
subsequent  efficient   liquid/solids  separation.

-------
References  1  and  2 are excellent  discussions  of
chemical addition and mixing, respectively.

2.2.5  Sequence  of Chemical  and  Physical
Reactions
The  conceptual sequence of  reactions  shown  in
Figure  2-1  summarizes  the control  points  for
ensuring efficient removal of phosphorus by chemical
addition. The initial short period of rapid mix provides
energy  to force molecular  contact between metallic
ions and  orthophosphate ions  to form an insoluble
compound, blending to prevent density currents, and
prevention of major short-circuiting. Polymer is then
introduced and blended by rapid  mix to  contact the
newly formed  precipitate and  absorb to  the particle
surface, thereby  enmeshing  several particles into
small individual floes. Slow  mixing  then provides
opportunity  for individual floes to adhere and form
larger  agglomerates that will  settle  by gravitational
force in the quiescent zone.  The  settled sludge,
containing the insolubilized  phosphorus, is withdrawn
to sludge handling operations, and the effluent flows
to the  next unit  operation or  is discharged to the
receiving stream.


2.2.6 Importance of Suspended Solids Control
As the  final effluent TP compliance level  is reduced
from 2 mg/l   to  0.5 mg/l  or  less, it becomes
increasingly important to control  effluent  suspended
solids.  Once  phosphorus  removal  is instituted  by
retrofitting  secondary  treatment  processes with
chemical  addition or biological phosphorus  uptake
capability, the  character of these suspended  solids
changes. The major objective of phosphorus control
is insolubilization  and transfer  of the phosphorus into
the  sludge mass. Therefore, the phosphorus content
of the sludge increases.
            «
Sludges  generated  from secondary  treatment
processes with either chemical addition or biological
uptake for phosphorus control  generally contain about
4.5  percent phosphorus on a  dry solids  basis. This
value   compares  with the   typical  1.5-percent
phosphorus content  (dry solids  basis) of biological
sludges produced where phosphorus removal is  not
practiced.

Figure  2-2  illustrates the critical  need  to  control
effluent suspended solids as the  percent phosphorus
in these  solids increases due  to phosphorus  control
practices. In the case of secondary treatment without
phosphorus   removal,  with  only  1.5  percent
phosphorus in the  suspended solids,  the phosphorus
content of the  effluent would  be largely in the form of
soluble phosphorus. The  contribution  to effluent
 phosphorus from paniculate matter in this case would
 be minor, provided the effluent total suspended solids
 (TSS)  concentration  did  not exceed the Federal
 secondary treatment standard  of 30 mg/l.
To achieve a 1-mg/l TP effluent limit  in phosphorus
removal systems with  suspended solids containing
4.5 percent  phosphorus,  however, the effluent TSS
could npt, exceed 22 mg/l. To achieve a 0.5-mg/l TP
effluent limit, the effluent TSS  would have to be
limited to 11  mg/l. Of course, any soluble phosphorus
in  the effluent would make these suspended  solids
concentrations even more restrictive. An effluent limit
of 2 mg/l TP is not likely to be impacted by effluent
TSS  concentrations  if the  Federal secondary
treatment standard of 30 mg/l is achieved.

2.2.7 Engineering Guidance Provided on General
Schematics
The schematics for each type of treatment process
presented provide  guidance  on  polymer  dosage,
metallic  ion-to-phosphorus  mole ratio,  and  final
clarifier surface overflow rate (SOR) for four different
TP limits. These are approximations  to allow initial
assessment  of  the feasibility of retrofitting a specific
facility to achieve a stated effluent TP limit.

When considering the retrofit of a treatment  plant with
either chemical or biological phosphorus removal, it is
unlikely that a  TP concentration of 0.5 mg/l or less
could be  achieved  if the existing  final clarifier SOR
exceeds 20  m3/m2/d (500 gpd/sq  ft). At SORs  above
this level, the final effluent TSS would almost certainly
be greater than  the 8 to  11 mg/l range  at  which
attainment  of  a 0.5-mg/l  TP  concentration  is
possible. In  these cases, provision for additional final
clarifier capacity and/or granular media filtration of the
secondary effluent should be considered in the  retrofit
plan.

2.2.8 Sludge Production  at Facilities  Retrofitted
for Phosphorus Removal
A survey was conducted  on 185 Ontario, Canada
wastewater treatment facilities regarding the impact of
chemical addition for phosphorus removal on  sludge
quantity  (3). The survey  showed that to  reach an
effluent TP of 1.0 mg/l, sludge mass increased by an
average of 40 percent at primary treatment plants and
26 percent at activated sludge plants.  These data are
summarized in Table 2-1. Information is provided on
sludge mass, percent dry solids,  and sludge volume
for  conventional  primary and  activated  sludge
processes before and after chemical addition.

In  another  study (4),  it was concluded  that the
impacts of all types of phosphorus removal processes
on sludge quantity, quality, stabilization, thickening,
dewatering,  incineration, and agricultural utilization are
related to site-specific  wastewater  characteristics
and   process  options  employed  and  that
generalizations of these impacts are not possible.

A recent technology evaluation (5) contains data for
four  full-scale  biological phosphorus  removal  retrofit
 projects. Two were PhoStrip processes, and two were
 activated sludge processes  modified  to include  an

-------
Figure 2-1.  Sequence of increased liquid/solids separation and phosphorus removal.
                            Insolubilization
                                                 Flocculation
                                                                   Sedimentation
Precipitant, M3 +
Wastewater, PO43-

rr

O

ix

Poll
i
m
«ner
r
O
X
O
J
m
O
X
0




Effluent
h<
Sludge, MPO4

Rapid Mix
dispersion and
reaction
Rapid Mix
dispersion and
reaction
Slow Mix
floe growth
Quiescence
floe settling
                                1-5         1-5        15-30
                                          Time for each reaction, minutes
                                                                     60 - 180
                          4.5% TP in TSS /'
                                      s
                                     f
Rgurs 2-2.  Importance of effluent TSS on effluent TP.

  TP in Final Effluent
  Contributed by TSS, mg/l

    1.4


    1.2


    1.0


    0.8


    0.6


    0.4


    0.2


     0
              I      I       I      I      I      I
        05     10     15    20     25     30

                   Final Effluent TSS, mg/l
anaerobic  stage at the head end of the  aeration
system. Waste activated sludge production for all four
facilities ranged from 0.7 to 1.0 kg volatile suspended
solids  (VSS)/kg total  BODs  (TBOD)  removed.  The
high value of 1.0  kg VSS/kg TBOD was noted  at a
facility that did  not practice  primary settling, and this
higher value was attributed to nondegradable  volatile
solids. When the PhoStrip process  is employed for
biological  phosphorus  removal,  additional solids are
contributed  by  the  lime  added  to insolubilize
phosphorus released by the  biomass in the anaerobic
stripper. This generally equates to about  20 mg/l of
lime, based on influent flow.

2.2.9  S/uc/ge  Production  Related to  Different
Effluent TP Requirements.            *
The discussion  in the preceding paragraphs concerns
sludge production for  facilities  achieving  compliance
with a 1-mg/l  TP requirement.  If  the requirement
were  2 mg/l TP instead of  1 mg/l, no material
difference  in sludge  production  would be  noted in
either the chemical or  biological systems.  Regardless
of the effluent  TP requirement, a certain amount of
chemical  precipitant must be  added  to  satisfy the
initial  chemical demand  of the wastewater.  This
demand must be met before efficient insolubilization
of phosphorus  occurs. Once  the  demand  is  met,
there is not much difference between  the amount of
precipitant required to  achieve  1  mg/l vs.  2 mg/l TP,
since the  ratio of metal ion  close to phosphorus
insolubilized  is  linear  in  this effluent concentration
range. Effluent  concentrations of 1 to  2 mg/l  TP are
about  the practical  limit  for  biological phosphorus
removal processes.

A requirement for compliance with a 0.5-mg/l  or less
TP effluent limit would increase sludge production in

-------
Table 2-1.   Sludge Production With and Without Chemical Addition (3)
• Type of Treatment


Dry Solids Produced, kg/1,000 m3
Dry Solids Produced, Ib/Mgal
Dry Solids Content, percent
Sludge Volume, percent of influent flow

Conventional
120
1,000
6.0
0.20
Primary
" Metal Salt Addition2
169
1,410
5.3
0.32
Activated
Conventional
173
1,443
4.5
0.38
Sludge1
Metal Salt Addition2-3
217
1,810
4.2
0.51
 1 Primary plus waste activated sludges.
 2 Plant influent TP = 7 mg/l; final effluent TP = 1 mg/l.
 3 Metal salt added to aerator.
both chemical  and biological  phosphorus removal
processes  compared  with  a 1- or 2-mg/l effluent
TP requirement.  As noted  previously, effluent
suspended solids would have to be controlled to near
10  mg/l  to reduce effluent TP to this  level.  The
additional suspended solids captured would result in
increased sludge  production and sludge  handling
requirements.

Chemical  phosphorus removal  processes  would
require an increase of about 20 percent in metal ion
dose to achieve a 0.5-mg/l or  less TP effluent. This
increase  would  be necessary to ensure efficient
phosphorus  insolubilization  and  to control the
solubility  product of the metal phosphate precipitate.

Biological phosphorus removal processes would in all
likelihood require a chemical supplement to achieve a
0.5-mg/l  or less TP concentration. Sufficient  metal
ion would have to  be added to insolubilize 0.5 to 1.5
mg/l TP  after  the  initial  chemical demand was met.
This would result in chemical sludge production and
increased total  sludge  production compared  with
achieving a 1- or  2-mg/l TP concentration.

2.3  Process  Options  for Retrofitting
Existing  CBDB  Facilities  to  Achieve
Phosphorus Control
The schematics illustrated in  Figures 2-3 through
2-10  indicate  that all  of the  various  treatment
processes  existing in  the CBDB could be retrofitted
for chemical phosphorus control. Only the activated
sludge processes, however,  are  considered  for
retrofitting to biological phosphorus control.  Options
for retrofitting  to  biological  phosphorus control  are
limited  in this document to  the   PhoStrip  and
Anaerobic/Oxic (A/O)   processes,  as  depicted
schematically  in  Figures   2-11  and  2-12,
respectively.

2.3.1  Retrofitting  CBDB Facilities with  Chemical
Control  of Phosphorus
The following  paragraphs and  Figures  2-3  through
2-10 provide general  guidance for adding chemical
phosphorus control to existing CBDB facilities. In the
following chemical control examples, some form  of
iron or aluminum  salt  is assumed as the source  of
metal  ion to insolubilize phosphorus.  Lime addition  to
the full wastewater flow is not recommended to obtain
the TP concentrations needed for compliance in the
CBDB  because  of the many O&M  problems
associated with its handling.

The M3+/lnf. TP  mole ratios shown in  Figures 2-3
through 2-10  are  initial chemical dose guidelines. It
is  well  recognized that  only soluble phosphorus  is
actually precipitated by  metal salts. Paniculate and
soluble  phosphorus taken up  biologically  do not
consume chemical.

Based on recent and ongoing research  (6,7) claims
have  been   made that  the   remaining  soluble
phosphorus (SP) not taken up biologically reacts with
metal  ion at stoichiometric mole  ratios of about 1.4 to
1.5 down to residual SP concentrations of 1 to 2 mg/l.
As shown in Figures  2-3 through 2-10,  much
higher chemical doses are needed to achieve effluent
TP concentrations  of  0.2   or  0.5  mg/l. The
investigators  carrying out  the above research (6,7)
have  developed a model that predicts that chemical
dose   is  independent  of  influent phosphorus
concentration in meeting low (<1 mg/l) effluent TP
concentrations. Rather, their theory suggests that any
variability in the ratio between M3+ dose and influent
SP or influent TP required to reach low (< 1  mg/l)
effluent TP concentrations is a  function of the initial
pH and alkalinity of the wastewater, microbial activity,
and mode of aeration and not the influent phosphorus
concentration itself.

While the above  research studies  (6,7) are being
completed and field tests conducted for verification, a
conventional  chemical  dosing  strategy based  on
influent TP is used  in  this document for all  four
effluent TP limits considered. In  addition to its impact
on the  dosing  guidance  provided  in  Figures 2-3
through 2-10, this conventional  sjtrategy  was utilized
in:  1) displaying  the chemical  phosphorus  removal
effluent quality data in Figures 3-1 and 3-2 and the

-------
chemical phosphorus removal sludge production data
in Rgure 3-4; 2)  developing the  chemical dose
requirements of the design synopses in Chapter 4; 3)
preparing  the chemical storage and supply  system
layouts in Rgures 5-13 through 5-22; 4) developing
the estimated chemical  phosphorus removal  cost
curves in Figures  8-1  through 8-8; 5) estimating
chemical  phosphorus  removal  capital costs  for
different plant sizes and effluent TP limits in Tables
9-1  through  9-3; and 6)  summarizing   annual
chemical costs for different effluent TP limits in Table
9-4.


If the above theory (6,7) is confirmed, those portions
of the above figures and  tables involving  the  0.5-
and  0.2-mg/l  effluent  TP  limits  would  require
modification.


2.3.1.1  Retrofitting  Plug  Flow,  Step  Aeration,
Complete Mix, Pure Oxygen,  and Single-Stage
Nitrification Activated  Sludge Systems  for
Chemical Phosphorus Removal
Rgure 2-3  indicates  that  all  the  above  activated
sludge process alternatives have basically the same
general flow scheme. Provided  that the  chemical
dose  and effluent  clarification  guidelines  discussed
previously are complied with, each process alternative
has  the  capability  to achieve an  effluent  TP
concentration of 2,  1,  0.5, or 0.2 mg/l. Considerations
specific to each option are discussed below.

When  compliance  with an effluent  limitation of 0.5
mg/l TP or less is required, a split dose of metal salt
is recommended.  Tertiary filtration may  also  be
necessary. Tertiary filtration is essential, however, to
achieve  0.2 m/L  TP.  A separate rapid  mix  and
flocculation  basin  may be  installed  between  the
secondary reactor and final clarifier to promote more
efficient use of chemicals and to minimize generation
of chemical sludge.

Well-operating plug flow and complete  mix  systems
should offer no problems  for  retrofitting other than
finding the optimum dosing points for metal salt and
polymer, if required. Step aeration systems may need
adjustment in the  location of  primary  effluent feed
points into the aeration basin. It may be  necessary to
increase  wastewater  aeration  time to ensure  the
enzymatic   conversion of   polyphosphates  to
orthophosphates. This would be particularly important
if a 0.5-mg/l TP  or  less  effluent  limit had to  be
achieved.

Retrofitting   single-stage nitrification  systems  for
chemical  phosphorus removal  requires  evaluation of
two  process operating considerations.  First,  the
chemicals commonly used for phosphorus  removal
are  acidic.  Furthermore,  biological  nitrification
reactions also  produce  hydrogen  ions. If  the
wastewater  does  not contain  enough  alkalinity to
neutralize the acidity generated by these two sources,
some provision for pH control will be necessary.

Second,  the metal  ion  side-products and metal
phosphate precipitates formed  and  occluded  into the
activated sludge mass contribute an inert fraction to
the biomass  that lowers  the  volatile content of the
mixed  liquor  suspended  solids  (MLSS) below  that
normally encountered  where mineral addition is not
practiced.  Historical wasting schedules for control of
the sludge retention time (SRT)  may have to be
altered from usual  operational  experience at a given
facility to  sustain  efficient  single-stage  nitrification.
This usually  involves  operating  at a  higher MLSS
concentration so that  the overall quantity  of  volatile
solids under aeration remains equal to or greater than
the prechemical addition level.  These two  process
considerations will be  discussed  in more detail in
Chapter 7.

The pH value of the bioreactor mixed liquor is also of
concern in retrofitting  pure oxygen activated sludge
systems with chemical phosphorus control. This type
of reactor is  typically covered  to provide  a gas-tight
environment for efficient  utilization  of  oxygen. Since
only the last aeration compartment  is normally vented
to the atmosphere, carbon dioxide resulting  from
biological  oxidation of wastewater constituents is
trapped in  solution rather than being  continually air
stripped from the reactor. Carbon  dioxide  in solution
acts as a  weak acid and, coupled with  the acidic
nature of  most  chemicals used  for phosphorus
control, can result  in pH values low enough to inhibit
normal microbiological metabolic reactions.

This coupled pH  effect  could occur regardless of
where the acidic  metal  salt  was dosed into the
system. If supplemental alkalinity is required,  soluble
alkalis such  as sodium  hydroxide, bicarbonate, or
carbonate should  be  selected.  Lime  would  not be
recommended  due to  the possibility  of  calcium
carbonate  scale formation from  the reaction of
calcium ions with dissolved carbon dioxide.

2.3.1.2  Retrofitting  Extended Aeration  and
Oxidation  Ditch  Activated  Sludge  Systems for
Chemical Phosphorus Removal
Figure 2-4 illustrates that these  two processes  have
similar  secondary treatment  flow schemes  and
typically are constructed  without primary clarification.
Degritted  wastewater  flows directly to the activated
sludge  bioreactor.  Both  processes usually are
designed for nominal aeration tank  detention times of
20-24 hours.  Extended aeration  systems  are of
conventional  aeration tankage  design,  while oxidation
ditches are constructed  in an oval, race-track  tank
configuration.  The process  considerations for
retrofitting  chemical  phosphorus  removal in these
systems are similar to  those discussed  for single-
stage nitrification. Due to  their long  aeration times and
high  SRTs,  these processes usually nitrify under
                                                  10

-------
Figure 2-3.  Retrofitting plug flow, step aeration, complete mix, pure oxygen, and single-stage nitrification activated sludge
           systems for chemical phosphorus removal.


     Polymer 'Metering                           , , •'••••'*•>          "*'"••-
     Storage  Pump                             ,
         1   L	
      Oegritted
     Wastewater
                     Prjmary
                     Clarifier
Activated Sludge
 Aeration Tank
                                      Return Sludge
                  Primary Sludge
       I --- 1   i --- 1
  Metal Salt Metering
   Storage   Pump
                                            Effluent
                            Waste Activated
                               Sludge
                                              Existing

                                              Retrofit
Final
Effluent
TP
mg/l
2
1
0.5
0.2
* at peak sustained

Polymer
Dose
mg/l
0.1 - 0.2
0.1 - 0.2
0.1 - 0.2
0.5 - 1.0
flow

M3+/lnf.TP
Ratio
mole
1.0-1.2
1.2-1.5
1.5-2.0
3.5 - 6.0

Final
Clarifier
SOR"
gpd/sqft
800
600
500
500

Final Effluent
Filtration
Required

No
No
Maybe
Yes

summer conditions. Therefore,  pH control can be a
seasonal process problem when acidic metal salts are
added. Supplemental alkalinity may be required during
the summer months.


The usual design and operational parameters for both
processes  are low food-to-microorganism  (F/M)
loadings,  long  SRTs,  long  aeration detention  times,
and low biological sludge yields  per mass  of BOD
removed. These interrelated factors produce a MLSS
that typically has a high inert fraction. Additional  inert
material contributed by metal ion addition can result in
MLSS with an even lower volatile fraction.  Volatile
fractions  below 50 percent  can  lead to unstable
operation. Sludge  wasting schedules may have to be
adjusted to prevent loss of active biomass.


Another  operational  adjustment  that can  be
considered for an extended  aeration  system  is
isolation of a portion of the aeration tankage to reduce
aeration detention time. This  should result  in an
increase in biological sludge yield and help control the
        inert-to-volatile ratio  of  the  MLSS.  This  operational
        adjustment may not be possible  with an  oxidation
        ditch  system,  however,  because  of  the  oval
        configuration of the aeration tank.

        With both processes, the above points become more
        critical if  a 0.5-mg/l TP or  less effluent limit is
        required. This criticality arises from the extra metal
        ion  required  and the lack  of a  primary clarifier to
        remove  inert  solids.  If  an  engineering  evaluation
        indicates that the buildup  of inert  material  could
        become  extensive,  tertiary  media filtration  with  a
        polish dose of metal ion  prior to  the  filter  might be
        considered to ease the  inerts  problem. Solids in the
        filter backwash  should  be transferred  directly to
        sludge processing units  and not returned  to  the
        secondary system. A jar test should be conducted to
        determine the necessary dosage of chemicals. If the
        required dosage is excessive,   a separate-stage
        tertiary chemical reactor-clarifier is recommended to
        achieve an effluent TP  concentration  of 0.5 mg/l or
        less.  A  pH  adjustment  system  should  also  be
        considered.
                                                   11

-------
Figure 2-4.   Retrofitting extended aeration and oxidation ditch activated sludge systems for chemical phosphorus removal.
    Metal Salt  Metering
     Storage    Pump
      i

      L_J  £?A
      Degritted
     Wastewater
  "T
  _4_
                                           Activated Sludge
                                            Aeration Tank
                                     Return Sludge
                              i—\   i—i
                             Metering  Polymer
                              Pump    Storage
                                   Effluent
                                                                         Waste Activated
                                                                            Sludge
                                                                                           Existing

                                                                                           Retrofit
final
Effluent
TP
mgn
2
1
0.5
0.2
* at peak sustained

Polymer
Dose
mg/l
0.1 - 0.2
0.1 - 0.2
0.1 - 0.2
0.5 - 1.0
flow

M3+/mf.TP
Ratio
mole
1.0- 1.2
1.2- 1.5
1.5-2.0
3.5 - 6.0

Final
Clarifier
SOR"
gpd/sqft
800
600
500
500

Final Effluent
Filtration
Required

No
No
Maybe
Yes

2.3.1.3 Retrofitting Contact Stabilization Activated
Sludge  Systems  for  Chemical  Phosphorus
Removal
The configuration of the contact stabilization activated
sludge process is shown  in Figure 2-5.  The major
process  consideration  for  retrofitting  contact
stabilization  facilities is  similar  to  that for step
aeration. The contact tank usually has a hydraulic
detention time (HOT)  of only 30 to 60 minutes for the
main stream primary  effluent flow. This may not be
enough HOT to provide for enzymatic conversion of
polyphosphates to  orthophosphates. The short
contact  time  could  also restrict  the  biological
conversion of organic phosphorus compounds to the
orthophosphate  form. These  items  become more
important if the effluent TP compliance level is  0.5
mg/l  or  less. Laboratory testing  could quantify  the
aeration  HOT  necessary for these conversions  to
ensure efficient insolubilization of phosphorus. Once
phosphorus has been insolubilized  by  metal  salt
addition and occluded into the  mixed  liquor biomass,
no resolubilization occurs in the reaeration  tank.  If
additional aeration HOT  is required,  the  split  of
tankage  volume  between  the  contact tank and  the
sludge  reaeration or  stabilization tank  could  be
modified if the plant layout permits.

2.3.1.4  Retrofitting Two-Stage   Biological
Nitrification  Systems for Chemical  Phosphorus
Removal
The schematic  provided in Figure  2-6  indicates  that
two-stage  nitrification  facilities offer  great flexibility
for metal  salt dosing  because of the  multiple  unit
processes  employed. Many  variations of  both
suspended growth and attached growth  processes in
different combinations  have been utilized for two-
stage nitrification.

To   achieve  a  1-  or  2-mg/l  TP  effluent
concentration, it may only  be necessary to dose one
unit process  with  metal salt. The primary clarifier or
first-stage carbonaceous  reactor would normally be
selected.  If the required effluent concentration  was
0.5 mg/I TP or less, a polish dose  could be provided
at the second-stage nitrification reactor.

The   cautions  noted  previously  relative  to  the
combined effect of metal salt addition and nitrification
                                                  12

-------
Figure 2-5.  Retrofitting contact stabilization activated sludge systems for chemical phosphorus removal.
     Polymer Metering
     Storage  Pump
  Metal Salt Metering
   Storage   Pump
                                                                                             Existing

                                                                                             Retrofit
Final
Effluent
TP
mg/l
2
1
0.5
0.2
" at peak

Polymer
Dose
mg/l
0.1 - 0.2
0.1 - 0.2
0.1 - 0.2
0.5- 1.0
sustained flow

M3+/inf. TP
Ratio
mole
1.0 - 1.2
1.2 - 1.5
1.5-2.0
3.5 - 6.0

Final
Clarifier
SOR*
gpd/sq ft
800
600
500
500

Final Effluent
Filtration
Required

No
No
Maybe
Yes

on lowering pH should be considered. Second-stage
processes also have very low  net cell  synthesis.
Therefore, the  discussion  on retrofitting  extended
aeration  systems  is relevant  to the  second-stage
nitrification reactor.  This implies that  only  a polish
dose of  metal salt  be  added to  second-stage
reactors  to avoid a large  buildup  of inerts  in  the
MLSS.

2.3.1.5  Retrofitting  Standard-Rate  Trickling
Filters for Chemical Phosphorus Removal
Standard-rate  trickling filters   (Figure  2-7)  can
achieve  the  effluent  phosphorus  concentrations
required  in the CBDB. Both rock and plastic media
trickling filters  have  been retrofitted for phosphorus
removal.
Since flow through  a trickling  filter  is typically more
laminar than  turbulent,  metal  salt  is  not  normally
dosed directly to the filter media.  Therefore, it may be
necessary to provide a rapid mix  chamber prior to the
secondary clarifier when the metal salt is added  after
the filter.

Polymer  addition capability is  considered necessary
for any trickling filter facility retrofitted  for  chemical
phosphorus control. If  metal salt  is  dosed to  the
primary clarifier, polymer is needed to ensure that a
large amount of inorganic solids does not carry  over
to the trickling filter and produce a biofilm with a high
inert solids fraction.  Standard-rate  filter biomass is
similar  to  the  biomass  of an  extended  aeration
process; i.e., it has a low  net cell synthesis and a
long SRT.

If  chemical addition  to  the  secondary clarifier is
planned, a critical  review should be made of existing
secondary  clarifier performance to  determine if the
SOR and depth are adequate to handle the increased
solids loading. This is particularly  important with older
trickling  filter installations that often were equipped
with shallow secondary clarifiers with relatively  high
SORs: When existing clarifiers are  found inadequate,
consideration should be given to adding new clarifiers
as required.

Typically,  trickling  filters  produce  effluents  that
contain  both  sloughed and colloidal  solids,  and
polymer  addition to the secondary  clarifier would be
necessary  to  meet  a 0.5-mg/l TP or  less  effluent
limit.
                                                   13

-------
Figure 2-6.  Retrofitting two-stage biological nitrification systems for chemical phosphorus removal.
     Polymer Metering
     Storage  Pump
   Motal Salt  Metering
   Storage    Pump
                                                                                            Existing

                                                                                            Retrofit
Fina)
Effluent
TP
mg/l
2
1
0.5
0.2

Polymer
Dose
mg/l
0.1 - 0.2
0.1 - 0.2
0.1 - 0.2
0.5 - 1.0

M3+/lnf. TP
Ratio
mole
1.0- 1.2
1.2-1.5
1.5-2.0
3.5 - 6.0
Final
Clarifier
SOR"
gpd/sqft
800
600
500
500
Final Effluent
Filtration
Required

No
No
Maybe
Yes
* at peak sustained flow
 2.3.1.6 Retrofitting High-Rate Trickling  Filters for
 Chemical Phosphorus Removal
 The  high-rate trickling filter  process  (Figure  2-8)
 represents the most difficult process in  the CBDB to
 retrofit for chemical phosphorus control. The typical
 designs for these systems favor high SORs for  both
 primary and  secondary  clarifiers.  Additionally,  the
 trickling filter unit  process is designed with  a  high
 hydraulic application rate  that leads to a short contact
 time  of wastewater with the biofilm and  incomplete
 bio-oxidation  of  organics. Final  effluent from  this
 process  typically is turbid  and contains dispersed
 suspended  solids  and  undegraded  organics.
 Conversion  of organically-bound  phosphorus  and
 polyphosphates to orthophosphates is limited by the
 short contact time. High-rate trickling filter systems
 have marginal capability to produce a final effluent of
 30 mg/l TBOD and TSS.

 Ail of these  process  characteristics are contrary to
 achievement  of  efficient phosphorus removal. Major
 emphasis for retrofitting a high-rate trickling  filter has
 to be placed on provision of efficient rapid mix  and
 flocculation capabilities to enhance  solids capture. In
all likelihood,  stringent effluent phosphorus  limits
would also be accompanied by more stringent effluent
BOD requirements, so the retrofit design would also
need to address enhanced organic removal. Polymer
addition capability would  also  be essential in any
chemical  phosphorus removal retrofit  of  a  high-rate
trickling filter system.

To  meet  a 2-mg/l  TP effluent  limit,  metal salt and
polymer addition to the primary clarifier would be the
preferred  choice.  This  dosing  arrangement would
reduce  the organic  load  on the high-rate filter and
provide some improvement in BOD removal.

Attainment of  a 1-mg/l TP effluent limit with a high-
rate  filter  system is questionable due to the limited
solids  capture of  clarifiers and the  presence  of
phosphorus forms that are not efficiently insolubilized
by  metal  ions. A  1-mg/l  concentration might  be
achieved  by adding a second dose of metal salt and
polymer after the high-rate filter,  thus improving both
phosphorus and  BOD  removals above the levels
obtainable with primary  clarifier metal  salt  addition
alone.
                                                    14

-------
Figure 2-7.  Retrofitting standard-rate trickling filters for chemical phosphorus removal.
     Polymer Metering
     Storage  Pump
   Metal Salt Metering
   Storage   Pump
                                                                                           Existing

                                                                                           Retrofit
Final
Effluent Polymer
TP Dose
mg/l tng/1
2 0.1 - 0.2
1 0.1 - 0.2
0.5 0.1 - 0.2
0.2 0.5-1.0

M3+/inf. TP ,
Ratio
mole
1.0 - 1.2
1.2- 1.5
1.5-2.0
3.5 - 6.0
Final
Clarifier
SOR*
gpd/sq ft
800
600
500
500
Final Effluent
Filtration
Required

No
No
Maybe
Yes
" at peak sustained flow
A  0.5- or 0.2-mg/l TP  effluent  limit would  probably
require  construction of a second-stage bioreactor
and  clarifier, or expansion of the  existing  high-rate
trickling filter system to reduce hydraulic and organic
loadings to standard-rate trickling filter loadings.

A  phased approach to the attainment  of a 0.5-  or
0.2-mg/l  TP  effluent  limit with  the existing system
could be  instituted. After the retrofit for dosing the
primary clarifier was in place to  achieve a 2-mg/l TP
effluent concentration,  laboratory  and  pilot testing
could be conducted to provide guidance on the need
for new  construction  to further reduce phosphorus
levels in the effluent.

2.3.1.7 Retrofitting Rotating Biological Contactors
for Chemical Phosphorus Removal
Retrofitting  a rotating  biological   contactor  (RBC)
system  for chemical  phosphorus removal  is  shown
schematically   in  Figure  2-9.   A  split   dose
arrangement  is  recommended for  attainment of a
0.5-  or 0.2-mg/l TP effluent  limit.  Provided that the
chemical  dosage  and  clarification  guidelines
discussed  previously  are  adhered  to,  no  major
problems  with  implementing  chemical phosphorus
control should be encountered.
An RBC system is similar to a standard-rate trickling
filter system,  and considerations  discussed  in that
section  of this chapter apply to RBC retrofits.  Since
the RBC is an attached growth process and  shear
forces act on the biofilm during the liquid immersion
portion of the rotational cycle, the effluent can contain
both sloughed  and  colloidal  suspended  solids.
Polymer addition to the final clarifier is recommended
to meet a 0.5- or 0.2-mg/l TP effluent limit.

2.3.1.8  Retrofitting  Wastewater  Lagoons for
Chemical Phosphorus Removal
Figure  2-10  depicts a  multi-cell  lagoon,  with
aeration  provided in the  first cell,  retrofitted  for
chemical phosphorus  control.   Information  on
phosphorus removal technology for lagoon systems is
scarce,  due in part  to the  fact that  most of  these
systems have flows less than 0.04 m3/s (1 mgd) and
many systems of this size are exempt from nutrient
control requirements.

Guidance is not offered in Figure 2-10 for attaining a
0.5-mg/l  TP or less effluent  limit with a retrofitted
lagoon  system. Mixing patterns, stratification,  short-
circuiting,  algal  growth,  pH  fluctuations,   large
                                                  15

-------
Rgure 2-8.   Retrofitting high-rate trickling fitters for chemical phosphorus removal.
    Polymer  Metering
    Storage   Pump
                                                                                         Effluent
   Metal Salt Metering
   Storage   Pump
                                                                                          Existing

                                                                                          Retrofit
Final
Eflluont Polymer
TP Dose
mg/i mg/1
2 0.1 - 0.2
1 0.1 - 0.2
0.5- 0.1 - 0.2
0.2~ 0.5-1.0
M3+/lnf. TP
Ratio
mole
1.0- 1.2
1.2 - 1.5
1.5-2.0
3.5 - 6.0
Final
Clarifier
SOR*
gpd/sqft
800
600
500
500
Final Effluent
Filtration
Required
No
No
Maybe
Yes
• at peak sustained flow
~ major expansion may be necessary
t may be necessary for 0.5 and 0.2 mg/L effluent TP
 surface-to-volume  ratios,  and  long  hydraulic
 retention  times (HRTs)  combine to  indicate  that a
 simple retrofit  could  not  reliably  achieve  this
 concentration.  To  meet this limit would  probably
 require construction of a separate tertiary  chemical
 treatment system (consisting of a flocculation  tank
 and a Clarifier) followed by  filtration. The same
 considerations  are also the  reason  Figure 2-10
 shows slightly higher metal salt dosages to achieve a
 2- or 1-mg/l  TP effluent  concentration than
 recommended  for  the  other  secondary  treatment
 processes discussed previously.

 Because  of the large liquid volume  of  cells  in a
 lagoon system, mixing of metal salt with wastewater
 can be a major process problem.  If aeration devices
 are present, the turbulence produced during aeration
 could  be utilized. If a quiescent cell is selected for
 chemical  dosing, a mixing device must be installed to
 ensure adequate mixing of chemical additives and cell
 contents.
 Polymer  addition  is  not  shown in  Figure  2-10
 because  not enough  experience has been reported
for a general recommendation to be made. Reference
8 contains several citations on lagoon systems dosed
with  metal salt  to  achieve  a 1-mg/l  TP  effluent
concentration.

2.3.2 Retrofitting CBDB Facilities with Biological
Control of Phosphorus
The  following  sections and  Figures  2-11  and  2-12
provide general  guidance  for  retrofitting  selected
suspended growth  activated  sludge   process
configurations  at existing facilities in  the CBDB with
biological  phosphorus  control.  Two proprietary
processes are considered, the PhoStrip process and
the  Anaerobic/Oxic  (A/0)  process.  The  PhoStrip
process  utilizes  a sidestrearn  unit  operation  to
chemically  insolubilize phosphorus  that has  been
stripped  or leached  from phosphorus-rich  biomass.
The  A/O process operates as  a main stream
biological phosphorus removal process.

These biological phosphorus  removal processes are
implemented  by maintaining  a cyclic exposure  of
aeration  tank  biomass to  anaerobic and aerobic
                                                  16

-------
 Figure 2-9.   Retrofitting RBCs for chemical phosphorus removal.
     Polymer  Metering
     Storage   Pump
   Metal Salt  Metering
    Storage    Pump
                                      Existing

                                      Retrofit
Final
Effluent
TP
mg/l
2
1
0.5
0.2
* at peak sustained
Polymer
Dose
mg/l
0.1 - 0.2
0.1 - 0.2
0.1-0.2
0.5- 1.0
flow
M3+/lnf. TP
Ratio
mole
1.0 - 1.2
1.2- 1.5
1.5-2.0
3.5 - 6.0

Final
Clarifier
SOR*
gpd/sqft
800
600
500
500

Final Effluent
Filtration
Required

No
No
Maybe
Yes

conditions. A period  of  acclimation is  necessary to
allow time for natural selection of microorganisms that
can  survive under these conditions. This period can
vary  from  2 to  4 weeks  for  establishment  of  a
steady-state  population.

During  the  anaerobic cycle,  these microorganisms
release intercellular-stored phosphorus to the  bulk
liquid while simultaneously  sorbing organics.  Upon
entering the subsequent aerobic cycle, the  same
microorganisms will degrade the sorbed organics and
remove the liberated phosphorus from the bulk liquid
by  incorporating  it  into  intercellular granules.
Reference  9 is an  excellent discussion  of biological
phosphorus removal processes  from an engineering
viewpoint. Reference 10 discusses the relationship of
wastewater composition to the feasibility of utilizing  a
biological process for  phosphorus removal  at  a
specific site.

2.3.2.1  Retrofitting Activated Sludge Systems for
Biological  Phosphorus  Removal  Using  the
PhoStrip Process
Figure 2-11 represents an activated sludge  system
that  has been retrofitted to  include  the PhoStrip
process. A portion of the  return sludge  stream is
subjected to anaerobic conditions in a reactor called
an "anaerobic stripper." The portion of return sludge
sent to the stripper can vary from 15 to 30 percent of
total plant flow. The purpose of the stripper tank is to
provide conditions  conducive  to  release  of
intercellular phosphorus from the microorganisms in
the  return  sludge  (phosphorus stripping).  Some
modifications of the  PhoStrip  process  employ an
elutriation stream with the stripper  operation; this is
not shown  in  Figure 2-11.  The elutriation  stream
may  be stripper  tank recycle, primary effluent,
secondary effluent, lime precipitation tank overflow, or
digester supernatant  return.  The  choice  and
magnitude  of the elutriation stream  is a  site-specific
selection  based  on  operational  and  wastewater
composition criteria. The purpose is to  increase the
efficiency of phosphorus stripping (5).

The  SRT of the return sludge  solids in  the  stripper
tank can vary from 5  to 20  hours, and the HOT can
vary from  1 to  10 hours. The return sludge solids in
the underflow from the stripper tank, which have now
been  partly stripped  of intercellular  phosphorus,  are
returned to  the aerobic aeration tank to biologically
                                                  17

-------
Figure 2-10. Retrofitting wastewater lagoons for chemical phosphorus removal.
       Degritted
     Wastowater
       i   r-ft-
       I	1  £._Ji
   Metal Salt  Metering
    Storage    Pump
                                                                                mix (Provide
                                                                                    mixing
                                                                                    chamber)
                           CelM
                                                      Cell 2
                                                                                             Floating
                                                                                             Aerator
                                                                Existing

                                                                Retrofit
           Final
          Effluent
           TP
           mg/1

            2
            1
M3+/Inf.TP
   Ratio
   mole

 1.2 - 1.5
 1.5 - 2.0
 insolubilize phosphorus from  the main  stream flow
 and then be recycled back to the anaerobic stripper.

 Overflow from the stripper  is treated  with lime in a
 precipitation tank  to  chemically insolubilize  the
 stripped  phosphorus. Lime  dosages  of 100  to  150
 mg/1 are typically used to increase the pH to 9.0 to
 9.5.  This equates to about 20  to 25 mg/1  of lime
 based on plant influent flow. Some facilities route the
 precipitation tank  contents  directly to  the  primary
 clarifier  as shown in Figure 2-11. Once insolubilized
 by lime,  the phosphorus does not resolubilize in the
 primary   clarifier. The  lime-phosphorus sludge  co-
 settles with the primary sludge. Other facilities employ
 a reactor-clarifier in lieu of a precipitation tank  and
 route only  reactor-clarifier  overflow to  the   primary
 clarifier.  The  underflow  lime-phosphorus  sludge  is
 disposed of separately.

 As further described in Chapter 6, aeration tank HOT
 should  be  between 4  and 10  hours for effective
 PhoStrip operation.  Detention  time in  extended
 aeration  plants may, therefore, need to be shortened
 by blocking a portion  of the  tankage. This  will  also
 result in a higher organic loading   rate,  which  is
 desirable for biological  phosphorus  removal.  On  the
 other hand, aerobic contact time  in  the  contact
                          stabilization process may be too short, necessitating
                          the use  of all  or a portion of the sludge reaeration
                          volume as additional contact volume. Typically, this
                          can be accomplished with minor modifications.

                          The  key  process feature  that determines the
                          efficiency of the PhoStrip concept is the differential
                          phosphorus  content  of  the  return  sludge  solids
                          entering  and leaving  the anaerobic stripper. This
                          differential times the mass of solids  passing through
                          the stripper is equivalent to the amount of phosphorus
                          removed from the  main  stream wastewater flow by
                          cycling a  portion of the return sludge through  the
                          stripper.

                          The  other non-effluent  outlet for phosphorus in  a
                          PhoStrip process   is  the  waste activated  sludge
                          removed from the  system. The phosphorus removed
                          at  a  PhoStrip  facility, therefore, is accomplished
                          through  a combination of stripping of return  sludge
                          and sludge wasting.

                          A  0.3-  to  0.6-percent  quantitative  loss  in  the
                          phosphorus content of the return sludge volatile solids
                          entering and leaving the  anaerobic stripper when the
                          aeration tank volatile solids ranged between 3.3  and
                          4.6  percent phosphorus has been  reported  (5).  A
                                                    18

-------
 Figure 2-11. Retrofitting plug flow, step aeration, complete mix, and pure oxygen activated sludge systems with the PhoStrip
            process for phosphorus removal.
      Wastewater
                                                  Aeration Tank
                                                                                               Effluent
                                             Return Sludge
                               (6)
Primary Sludge
                                                                    i
                                                                    l
                                                  /0>
                                                  (2)
                                              (4)
 +
_L_
                                                                                      Waste Activated
                                                                                          Sludge
 I	
     III,,
     |"[<8)f-»,J»
                                                                             Existing

                                                                             Retrofit
  Legend

  (1)   Portion of return sludge going to anaerobic stripper.
  (2)   Anaerobic stripper tank for leaching of phosphorus.
  (3)   Stripper tank overflow.
  (4)   Stripper tank underflow returned to activated sludge aeration tank.
  (5)   Tank containing lime slurry to precipitate phosphorus leached from return sludge in anaerobic stripper. Lime dose (CaO)
       25 mg/l based on plant influent flow.
  (6)   Insolubilized phosphorus returned to primary clarifier for co-settling with primary sludge.
  (7)   Lime storage.
  (8)   Lime slurry tank.
  (9)   Pump for transfer of lime slurry to phosphorus precipitating tank.
                                                                                   20-
phosphorus  mass  balance  at one facility without
primary  clarification  showed that 67 percent of the
overall phosphorus removal occurred by operation of
the stripper and lime precipitation and 33 percent was
removed via the waste activated sludge.


The PhoStrip  process can  achieve  2- and  1-mg/l
TP effluent concentrations without effluent  polishing.
A 0.5-mg/l TP  effluent  concentration  is  possible
when effluent suspended solids  concentrations are
low  (5).  To achieve an effluent limit of  0.2 mg/l TP
with PhoStrip,  filtration and split dosing of chemicals
should be considered.


Because the  PhoStrip process utilizes  a sidestream
chemical  addition  unit  process,  and  since  key
operational  parameters such as  return  sludge flow
rate through the  stripper, elutriation stream quality,
and elutriation stream  flow  rate  can  be readily
controlled, effluent phosphorus concentrations are not
as sensitive to influent wastewater composition as are
other biological phosphorus removal approaches.
                                     2.3.2.2 Retrofitting  Activated Sludge  Systems for
                                     Biological Phosphorus Removal  Using  the  A/O
                                     Process
                                     A schematic of an activated  sludge system retrofitted
                                     for biological  phosphorus removal employing the A/O
                                     process  is  presented  in  Figure  2-12. A  critical
                                     design feature of the A/O  process  is  provision  of
                                     sequential stages of two different  environments for
                                     the biomass to cycle through. Therefore, if an existing
                                     complete mix  activated sludge system  could not be
                                     retrofitted  into a  staged  reactor  by baffling,  the A/O
                                     process  would  not  be  suitable.  Installation  of a
                                     chemical backup  feed system  in  an A/O  process
                                     retrofit is  recommended  to  ensure that effluent TP
                                     concentrations of 1 and  0.5  mg/l can be consistently
                                     achieved.  Due to the  high  phosphorus  content  of
                                     effluent  solids, consideration of effluent  filtration  is
                                     also recommended if effluent concentrations  of  less
                                     than 1 mg/l TP must be obtained.

                                     Retrofit  with the A/O  process  is most  easily
                                     accomplished in  plug  flow activated  sludge tanks, but
                                     can  also be adapted to  most of the  other  activated
                                                     19

-------
Figure 2-12. Retrofitting plug flow, step aeration, and pure oxygen activated sludge systems with the  A/O process  for
           biological phosphorus removal.
                                             Activated Sludge
                                              Aeration Tank
 Dognttod
Wastewalor
                                          Anaerobic
                                          Stages1
                                              Oxic
                                            Stages2
                                           Return Sludge
                   Primary Sludge
                                                                                            Effluent
                                                                   Waste Activated
                                                                       Sludge
   Metal Salt  Motoring
    Storage    Pump
                                                                                              Existing

                                                                                              Retrofit
  Legend

  (D
  (2)
Mixing by submersible pump or mixers. No DO is present
Conventional aeration devices for achieving satisfactory DO levels.
     Final Effluent
        TP
           Probable Need for
           Chemical Addition
        mg/1

         2
         1
         0.5
         0.2
           None
           Occasional
           Continuous polish dose
           Continuous polish dose
sludge flow configurations. The ease of retrofit  is
determined by the ability to delineate and convert a
portion  of the  tankage to  an  anaerobic  stage.
Anaerobic here is defined as  the  absence of all DO
and oxidized nitrogen, while  anoxic refers  to the
conditions where DO  is low or absent but  oxidized
nitrogen is present. Space for construction of retrofit
facilities is normally not required for the A/O process,
and  generally  an  A/O  retrofit  is  more  easily
accomplished than a retrofit for PhoStrip.

The  A/O  process  induces a natural  selection  of
phosphorus-accumulating microorganisms to  occur
by providing alternate environments of anaerobic and
aerobic  (oxic)  conditions.  Wastewater  and  return
sludge are mixed in the anaerobic  stage. It  is not
necessary to  cover  this  stage  if  suitable  non-
turbulent mixing is provided. For example, mixing can
be accomplished by  submersible pumps or impeller
mixers in a  manner  that does not  cause oxygen
transfer from excessive exposure  of  liquid surface  to
air. The HRT of the anaerobic stage  can vary from 1
                                              to  2 hours. During this time, soluble phosphorus is
                                              released from the biomass into the  bulk liquid and,
                                              concurrently, organic matter (BOD) is  sorbed from  the
                                              bulk liquid and stored by the biomass.

                                              In the subsequent oxic stage with DO levels of 1 to 2
                                              mg/l, the  stored  organics  are biodegraded and new
                                              cellular  growth occurs coincident  with  transport of
                                              soluble  phosphorus  into  intercellular granules. The
                                              HRT of  the oxic stage can vary from 2 to 4 hours.

                                              This sequence of anaerobic  and aerobic  events is
                                              shown in  Figure  2-13. These reactions are common
                                              to   all  biological phosphorus removal  processes.
                                              These processes must be designed  and  operated to
                                              accommodate the anaerobic sorption  of  BOD   and
                                              release  of soluble phosphorus, followed by  aerobic
                                              cellular  synthesis and phosphorus uptake.

                                              The efficiency of phosphorus removal is affected by
                                              the ratio  of soluble  BOD5  (SBOD) to  SP  in  the
                                              system  influent.  A ratio of  influent SBOD  to SP of 10
                                                    20

-------
  Figure 2-13. Conceptual sequence of reactions in the A/O process.
                                                 SLOTS FOR SCUM TRANSPORT
                                                 BETWEEN STAGES
WASTEWATER FEED

f
                                                                                                  TO
                                                                                                CLARIFIER
 to .15 is  necessary  to achieve a 1-mg/l TP effluent
 concentration with main stream biological phosphorus
 removal processes such as A/O (5). To achieve a TP
 effluent concentration of  0.5 mg/l, the  ratio  would
 have to be  about 20 to  25. The effect  of internal
 recycle streams, such as digester supernatant, sludge
 thickener overflow, and filter press or vacuum filter
 filtrates on the influent SBOD-to-SP ratio must also
 be considered.

 An evaluation of four full-scale  biological phosphorus
 removal  facilities (5) revealed that none of the
 facilities practiced anaerobic digestion  of sludges.
 Chemical treatment of some  sludge handling recycle
 streams  was necessary to  prevent  previously
 removed  phosphorus from re-entering the  secondary
 system and adversely affecting attainment of effluent
 phosphorus limitations.

 Final clarifier design  and  operation is important for
 biological  phosphorus removal  processes.  A long
 sludge blanket residence time in a clarifier can lead to
 development of anaerobic conditions  in the blanket
 and  cause leaching  of soluble  phosphorus from the
 phosphorus  stored in  the  biomass   granules.
 Provisions for rapid sludge removal from the clarifier
and  reserve  return sludge  pumping capacity are
recommended where biological  phosphorus removal
is contemplated.


2.4  References
1. Encyclopedia  of Chemical  Processing  and
   Design.  Flocculation section, p. 184, Edited by
   J.J. McKetta. Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, NY,
   and Basel, Switzerland, 1985.

2. Wastewater Engineering: Treatment, Disposal,
   Reuse. Revised  by G. Tchobanoglous. McGraw-
   Hill, New York, NY, 2nd Edition,  1979.

3. Schmidtke,  N.  Estimating Sludge  Quantities at
   Wastewater Treatment Plants Using  Metal Salts
   to  Precipitate  Phosphorus.  Proceedings of the
   International Conference:  Management Strategies
   for  Phosphorus in  the  Environment,  Lisbon,
   Portugal.  Published by  Selper Ltd., London,
   England,  ISBN  0-948411-00-7,  1985.

4. Dick,  R.  Management  of  Phosphorus Laden
   Sludges.  Proceedings  of the International
   Conference:  Management   Strategies  for
                                                 21

-------
   Phosphorus in the Environment, Lisbon, Portugal.
   Published by  Selper Ltd., London, England, ISBN
   0-948411-00-7,  1985.

5. Tetreault, M.J., A.H. Benedict, C. Kaempfer, and
   E.F. Barth. Biological Phosphorus  Removal: A
   Technology Evaluation. JWPCF 58:823, 1986.

6. Personal communication from R.I.  Sedlak, The
   Soap and Detergent Association, New York, NY,
   to R.C. Brenner, U.S. EPA, Cincinnati, OH, May
   20, 1987.

7. Personal communication  from  D.  Jenkins,
   University of California,  Berkeley,  CA, to S.J.
   Kang,  McNamee, Porter and Seeley, Ann  Arbor,
   Ml, July 31, 1987.

8. Design  Manual,   Municipal Wastewater
   Stabilization  Ponds.  EPA-625/1-83-015,
   U.S.EPA, Center for Environmental Research
   Information, Cincinnati, OH, October  1983.

9. Summary Report of Workshop on  Biological
   Phosphorus  Removal in  Municipal  Wastewater
   Treatment.  Prepared  by  R.L.  Irvine and
   Associates, Inc., Sponsored by U.S. EPA,  Water
   Engineering Research Laboratory, Cincinnati, OH,
   Held at Annapolis, MD, September 1982.

10. Evans,  B. and P.  Crawford.  Introduction  of
   Biological Nutrient Removal in Canada. Presented
   at  Technology  Transfer Seminar on Biological
   Phosphorus Removal, Sponsored by Environment
   Canada, Burlington,  Ontario, Held  at Penticton,
   British Columbia, Canada, April 1985.
                                                22

-------
                                             Chapter 3
                 Summary of Existing Phosphorus Removal Performance Data
3.1  introduction

The chemical phosphorus removal performance data
presented in the first part of this chapter represent a
collection   of  information  from 76 wastewater
treatment plants located in the Great Lakes Drainage
Basin, including the states of Michigan, Ohio, Indiana,
Wisconsin, and Minnesota, as well as the Province of
Ontario, Canada. Data from a limited number of plants
in the CBDB are included for comparison: two  from
Virginia,  two from  Maryland, and two  from
Pennsylvania. Information from the plants in the Great
Lakes area  was  obtained  from  various  sources.
These sources include the  published literature and
direct contacts in the past and during preparation of
this  manual.  This data base includes treatment
process  sequence and performance information,
methods of phosphorus  removal  including  chemical
dosages and application  points, and  costs  for
chemical usage and overall sludge disposal.

Biological phosphorus removal is  relatively new, and
only a few full-scale plants are currently in operation
that  employ this technology. Performance of the
PhoStrip and A/O processes is discussed in the last
part of this chapter.


3.2 Chemicai Phosphorus Removal
Performance data for 82 plants that chemically
remove phosphorus are  summarized  in Tables 3-1
through 3-11. The plants are grouped together by
the type of secondary treatment process employed as
follows:

  15   Plug Flow Activated Sludge Systems
  15   Complete Mix Activated Sludge Systems
  11   Contact Stabilization Activated Sludge Systems
   2   Pure Oxygen Activated Sludge Systems
   5   Step Aeration Activated Sludge Systems
   8   Extended Aeration Activated Sludge Systems
   1   Two-Stage  Nitrification Activated   Sludge
      System
   4   High-Rate Trickling Filters
  10   Standard-Rate Trickling  Filters
   9   RBCs
   2   Oxidation Ditches
 Influent TP  concentrations ranged from 1.2 to 11.6
 mg/l, reflecting the impacts of inflow/infiltration and
 industrial inputs,  as  well  as other  site-specific
 conditions.

 Chemicals  used included  ferric  chloride, ferrous
 chloride, ferrous sulfate, alum, sodium aluminate, and
 lime, as well as a variety of polymers. The effluent TP
 permit limits range from 0.2  to 2.0 mg/l. For most of
 these plants the limit  is 1.0 mg/l. Actual effluent TP
 concentrations varied between 0.2 and 2.7 mg/l, with
 only eight plants  producing  average effluent  TP
 concentrations above 1.0 mg/l.

 Chemicals were applied at  most  plants at a  single
 location within the treatment system except for a few
 that practiced split dosing  at  two  locations. The
 principal application point  was  ahead of the primary
 clarifier for 42 percent  of the plants, in the  secondary
 biological process for 39 percent  of the plants, and
 ahead of the secondary clarifier for 19 percent  of the
 plants. It should be noted,  however, that many  of
 these plants  do have the flexibility to  split feed  at
 multiple locations. Polymer was used in conjunction
 with the metal salts in about half of the plants.

 Some form of tertiary suspended solids removal was
 employed at 29 percent of the plants.

 3.2.1 Effect of Application Point on Chemical Use
 A review  of the plants  in Tables 3-1 through 3-11
 was made of chemical dosages for various points  of
 application as expressed by  the ratios of metal salts
 to influent TP concentrations on a  weight basis.  A
 summary  is  provided  in Table 3-12 for alum, ferric
 chloride,  and  ferrous chloride.  Data  for  other
 chemicals are not  included  due to  the limited data
 base.

 The general trend  is  that less  chemicals  are used
 when dosed to the secondary process as  compared
 with the  primary process.  For those plants that use
polymer,  the  alum  dose does  not vary widely with
application point  but a definite  trend to lower doses
was revealed for ferric chloride the later it was applied
in the treatment  sequence. A trend was not evident
for ferrous chloride.
                                                 23

-------
          <§   §   §   5
          r^   T-i   O   O
i
                      8     §
                             CO     T-
                                  S   §
                             §
                                  8   8
                                                           §   8
                                                                     g
                                                                            "   o
          0
   f     I
                                  f?   §
                                     .  .
               to   ui   oSo  060   u>o
                                                                      f-. O  CO  CO CM   CD
          i   i
    D.   = S
               S   3
               O   5
        o o
                       d:  £
aj  co   o
O  o   m
                                             o
                     o t>   o
                     m 03   m
                     W ra   W
                                                     Itl SS   3
                                                           1
O   5 5  °.
6   6  6   E
»-  01  Mi

   ^  ™ '
"5  J5  ^ ~
m  O
                                                          II
J5  ~   <"«••=:
S  5  2 S   o
"5  s:   o K1   s:

I  1  !i   1

i£  £  £ o   i2
                                                                      E o
                                                                                       la-
                                                                                 O '«

                                                                                 •g  8
                   in  10
                              a     =
                                                 £  =
                                                                O
                                                                             S   £
                                                      24

-------
lllli

^ CM — Q n

— "^ o m g ^
2 a 5 o c
O
Q) _^_

O Q
en
_c
«
w Si
CO O ,?
to
a
o
t3  ±1
tX C-
Xj «
« a.
11
e=l
Sa
||

»

w


€&


f




"&





^
e










O)



•o
E






01
in
0
c\i
0
CD
0
O
o
in
8
CO
o
o
C3

CM
O
CO

a>
d

CD
in



06

in co
CO O
V


8
f*
_: •=
o ca
in O
o c5
CO CO

Ferrous Chloride
Axchem

CM
CM
d



q



S
.g"

S
CD 5
d d
c? fe
d T-


8 8
O CO
CD" co"
i 1
co" ^f

t


o o
CO S
O) O)

CO CM
d d

CO
•«T h-
•*r co

CM CD
U5 •fl'
CM CM

^ CO CO
T- O> O
"


V) W OJ
CO CO CO
80) CD
0 0
c? ctrt
d d' d
CO 0) CO
CO CO CO

Ferrous Chloride
Alum
Nalco 7763

T- CO
CO CO
d d



*j
CM CM
T^ d
5

•S ^
'5. (D
! i

s ®
S £
o> *v t*-
d d d
in co CD
odd


888
in h- co
•» CM" eo"
o o o
000
f^ CM m
co" in" - T "^ O
^



5 _S _5 _5
•gz «= ^ ^
o .i .i.i
(D t- ^_ k.
co a. a O-

Alum
Lime
Ferric Chloride
Hercules 847

^
O> T- -O
O T- CM



CM O CM
r Y-: CM
Z
S
^ 	 ^
1 « 5
CO O> (a
X .£ c

§"5J S
H. f £
d
o
r^
d


8
K"
o
o
^

t


co
N.
o
CD"

CD
d

CO
CO

a>
a>
CM*

C3J
O)




.9 .2
d d
m Q}
o5 co

Ferrous Sulfate
Nalco 7763


o
CM



O
CO

^
>
f
J3

S
CD
d
CM
q
T~


o
g
a"
o
O '
CO

t


0
CO
CO
CO

h-
d

m
in


q



»— o




5j 5
d d
CD CD
CO CO
(
Ferrous Chloride
Dow Seperan AF
30


CO
CM



CD
CO

JZ
•*-*"
_c

O
T to
d d
CM *t
CO CM
d d

' d
o o
o o
O CO
T-~ CO"
0 0
o o
co_ O>
«f *•-
o
0

1 co"

O CD
§0
t^
N-- CM"
CM CO

CO
N. h-
d d

co
O> t-
co -q-

T- CO
CO (D
O CM

CM O>
CO O




£ a
CO "5
0 m
u ci
CD co
CO CO

Alum
Ferrous Chloride

CO
I*- CM
CM CO



O CO
CM ui



s
s s
c
.5= CO

§
d
CD
d


o
o
o
co"
0
o
o
co"

f


1

r-
CD
d

CM
CO

CM

•» .

CM
i- CM
in o



1
Q- £
ti o
II

Ferrous Chloride
Nalco 7763

o>
to
CO



in
in



1

a.
<
CM
CO
d
Y—
CO
d


0
o
cq
^
0
o
q
-"

t


1

CM
O>
d

CM
to

CD
O
r-"

CO
CO T-
<£> 0



CD
£-1
GQ O
s 8
0) CO

Ferric Chloride
WT80


(0
CO



CM
CO


1
=i

10
O
CM CO
d d
CO ^
O> i-
d d


0 0
o o
T- O
CM" CM"
i- w
8 8
O O_
co" ^-"
CM CO

! (


1 2.
* s

CO OJ
i-1 d

(D CO
CO CD

01
CO CD
*"'

CO CM CM
*

£ 1
0
CO
d


0
o
o
in"
|
i

t


§
CO
CO
CO

in
d

a>
CO

CO
CO
CO

CM CD
CO O




1 1
CO CO
o o
E E
CLCt

IcM 1
J3 1
6 <» S.
w S. o
m 0) ^^
UL CO 3
C
fe
CO -g-
a

o
in a
co a>
S

-t-** "
c
S f:

Hi *~ o
25

-------
                       co    •*-
                                     *-  o  oi  in  as
                                     co  co  to  ~  ~
                             o  o  o  o  o
                                                        in  co  q

                                                    T^  O  O  r^
!s<
         ill
             SI


             t
                                     S  8  8  §  ?
                                     O  O   O  O  CM
                       8    8
                                   88?
                                     I-  CO   CM  CM  I-
                                                    in  T-   CM
«?
                                       80  2
                                       o  —
                                   *-*  r~»  T^
                                                               8
                                 ro  to  co   co
a                                                    2  CM   10  r-
                                                    ^  *-   oj  in
                              o  o  o
                                                O  O)  CO  OJ
                                         a
                                     CD  o  in  to  oj
           If
       'IJ]
                              o  o  o
                                 in  o  o>
                                                o  *-  to  T-  01
                                  co  in  in  m  co  co  co
                                     CO
                                             CD
                                                    §co  ^r
                                                    co  to
                                     i-:  T^  v^  oi  «
                                     ^inoie3>T^qT-;co

                                     CD  co  d  co  co  ui  **T  co
                                             T-  oi  i—  *••

                              5   i5
                         io  5   S
                                         £  £   9

                                         1
                                               S  (X  oZ
                                  ^£^•55  =
                                  fi  S  o  o   ^  s:
                                     0
                                         o
                                             m   O  LU
                          EEEdEduu
                          T?  *rr   *^   in  *^  m  m   m
Clar
                                        O  O  O   O   O


                                       OT  W  W  W  o5
                                      CO   CD  fl)
                              £
                            o  o  S  S

                            6  6  6  S
                                §cn   co  tn
                                333

                                g   i  S  |

                            i£  £  i£  £  3

                        r-     co  in
        i
                                  	      OI  CO  t~
                                  o   io  to  co  o>  01
                              T-  to   to  oj  m  oi   o
                                      s  II
                                           S  3
                                      -   M  •==
Qraf
                                      1  5
                                             ogo
                                  S   E  _
                                  Z   O  0.
                                                 H   Q

                                                                                                °
                                                                                E .3-1 T5

                                                                                            E21S
                                                                                          E.9-
                                                                                              1 t
                                                                                                . d

                                                                                                °
                                                                                                    f    5
                                                                                              jgn

                                                                                              ffii-
                                                                                   o)
                                                                          C  '-g "5 m c ^

                                                                          CB  i   5.2!
                                                                                   to
CO ,t=

•E<£
                                                                                                           5 m
                                                                                                           •—
                                                                                                 ~ —   CO tO

                                                                                                 "O   00

                                                                                                 e e   o o
                   i;
                                                                                     1°
                                                                                     SLL
                                                                                              .9*

                                                                                                    1,
                             IE
                                                                        26

-------
CD
a.

o


f

CO

•D
S

S
o
•o
 c
 (S
_
1 i

1 §
0) «

ll
I"S
0£


Chemicals

CD
s!
I1
c
f!




c
c
Q.
^
- |
I*
"1
:9 CD
H>
ll
«J


w

«





t
1





E








-a
CO

T3
CD






^
d
fe
d

1
o
o
o
in

o
8
t
.


CD
O>
CM

CM
d
CM
O
CO

CO
^


CO
W
cS
£L
"o
CQ
o
.CO

Ferrous Chloride


CD
CO

in
CO

X
O

i
CO
_J
1

CO
o
d
03
d

1
o
o
CO
CO*

o
o
in
gf
.
in
CO
i^
1

en
d
CO
ui

T-
^"
in
a> o
iri d

II
CO CO
O O
o d
CO W

Ferrous Chloride
SecoDyne 450


CO


CO
CO*
_
^
co
c
East Lansi

o
CO
d
CM
d

'
§
d
in
0
o
o
d
CD
.
o

^
s

CO
CO
d
CD
U)
CM
CO
CD
d

CD
"*""

.is
1
s
CO

Ferrous Sulfate


o>
in

0
S




z
I
UJ

fe
d
CO
o
d

1
8
CM"
'"'
8
CO
CO
.
o
o
CO
CM"
o>
o>
h-
d
CT)
^
in
d

CO
"*
i
1
s
03

Ferrous Chloride


^
in

0
d
CO

z

CO
Fort Wayn


d
£
d

*
0
o
o
in
CO
0
o
o
c\i
.


CO
CM"
T7.
S
d
CO
CO
CD
d


"
to
1
"5
S
S
co

Ferrous Sulfate


0
g

O
d
01
T-

—
5

Oak Creek






























1
CD
€
•5
E
CD


a.
CD

CI CO
— 'OT
c": *~^
CO -"
11
CD CD
T- OJ
                                                                          CD c •
                                                                          i|;
                                                                         56<
            I U

            IO
                                                                                   51   s
                                                                                    - >   o
                                                                                    « E   N
                                                                                    £$   °
S

                                                                                          co
            s
            o
                                                                        i E.9-S ts
                                                                        c 2 2. 9- o
t3


§

S
S£



1^
                                                                              .S

                                                                    1
                                                                    O
                                                                    O

                                                                    a.

                                                                    o

                                                                    OL
                                                                    JD
                                                                    co
                             o  o   o  o  o  o
                             o  o   o  o  o  o
                             in  o   in  o  cq  o

                                 'sf   oT  o       
-------
                                     ?s to
                                 <6ic
Isi
?3
                                      So:
     1
                                            I  S S  S
                                            0>  ^ •»  T^
                                               8 §
                                          £    co  oo  o>
                                               (DOT-
                                               oq  r-  co r-
                                               O  ^  JO JO  o O
                                               ffi  O  O O  mm
                                               c3  u  o o  c5 o
                                               OT  M  W W  W «
                                               6     Ss <§1
                                               •M  E  •= I, -S c
                                               £  !  ££ i£l
                                               U)  O  CO
                                                  o  >-"   ^

                                                  I  I   I
                                                  CD
                                                    8
                                               28

-------














c
S
a
fc»

£!
U.
a>
c
*5
^
0)
BS
a
t9
•o
c
s
co

a>
£
.?
X
UJ
I
re
O
U
T*
rformance am
O
0.
re

CC
»_ S ** &~
0? ^ — S

•§"§,

.C O
O Q



*>.
Si
m "O
60)
0>



Cfl
EC
u
6


>.
s 1
|u.

c
ca S
Q^



"c
o
a
i. "g
Sa
&1
5 QJ
wOC
a-g
-a §
feet
«-

»

«

-Q


j_
OI
E


	
"o>
E




1,
£














TJ
t

T3
£




o
d
5
CO


,

8
CO
T~
o
o
0
d
•
CO
in
OJ
co"




,j



CO
in
CM
tn
i-

in N-
oo o




«
s
CL *
m o
II
CO
CD
N-
Alum
Nalco 7763 or 1


CO
CO
d

113
*-

1
T3

^
O
1
.-
T-
in
co

o
d

8
c5
o
o
CM_
CO
0
O
in
o>
CM
CO
CO



CO
d



T_
•*
00
o
^

N- CO
CM O
CO






0) 0)
co ca
O O
j= ,i


Ferric Chloride
Polymer


S
d

CO
d



I
o>
•c
CD
^r co
CO CM
d CM
§00
O)
d d


. .

§o
o
in
co" N."
CO
8 8
in in
CO"  .
CM »-



1 fj
o .E
O c?
S
d
CD
d


,

0
o
^
o
8
CM
•
in
5
01



LO




r~~
a>
o>
a>
d

(O T-
o> o






.S o
II
E E
£ £


Ferric Chloride
Hercufloc 831


r-.
'"

„.
"*



I
£
CO
c
CM
d
tn
T-I


.

I
^
S
s
•
o
CO
N."




^J



^~
in

in
CM

co -^r
CM O






rR ?T
itE **~
g s
CO CO

w
Alum
Anionic Polyme


~
"

O
CO

a.
c"
Elizabethtow
•ST
"*
£
T-


1

CD
CM
CM
1
1
•^
N-
•
S
in
o



CM
d



CO
o>
^
in
"*

in co
oj oi






ii -M
5 5
E E
££


Ferric Chloride
Polymer


CO
CO

in
"*


o>

-CM
CO
"
CO
r«.
d


.

o
o
o
i
8
o
§
•
1
O)
o



m
d



CD
•*
^
o
CM

O)
o> d






0) Q)
§ 5
II


Ferric Chloride
Axchem 115


CO
CO

o
S



1
I






,


































15
mg/l of chemici
^
CO
f
a
o
is
E
™
too
"^ CO
ll
a?
,, t- CM
29

-------
              U>     T-
»     §
              8
                     §     i
                                   8
                                                        CO      i-
                                          §     8
       T--     Of


       o O   CO  O>   OO
       no  oo  tno  ~^
       O O
                             mm  m t-,  mm
                            ;^ .'r*  ;— fl)  :^ ^-
                             COOi  S] 'i:

                                           :  ~   •= —   -c
                                                           m   m
§g  oo  oo  o g1   oo   oO  oo  5o

S g  II  11  I j>   11   11  11  11
                            cL cL
                                      8
                                                 2     .•§  Si   § g

                                                 og   o»  §2
                                                 .eg   J=  g  O "t
                                                 O i>-   O  =   w  g

                                                 I 8   |S   1  I
1
                                                 —     0)
              3     i
                                   S     ,£
                                                                                              •§055
                                                                                                     §<
                                                                                                   .9-2 is
                                                                                                        8
                                                                                               IE.9-1
                                                                                              <0
                                                                                                     1:
                                                                                                     OC
                                                                                                     T5.E
                                                           S
S
                                                                                                                   g  g
                                                                                                                   .8  .2
                                                                                                     .
                                                                                                     6  -E
                                                                                                     S  O
                                                                                                     O  M

                                                                                                     •g  1
                                                            30

-------
Table 3-12.  Metal lon-to-lnfluent TP  Ratio  (Weight Basis)
           for Various Points of Application
Point of Application"

With Polymer
Alum
Ferric Chloride
Ferrous Chloride
Without Polymer
Alum
Ferric Chloride
Ferrous Chloride
Primary
Clarifier
1.81 (2)
3.95(11)
2.26 (5)
4.01 (2)
2.20 (1)
1.77(4)
Secondary
Biological
Process
1.63(3)
3.02 (3)
3.94 (4)
1.00(1)
2.40 (1)
2.35 (9)
Secondary
Clarifier
2.28 (4)
1.88(4)
1.62(3)
2.07 (5)
1.24(2)
2.13 (6)
  * Number of plants are indicated in parentheses.
 Impacts of polymer addition on the metal salt dosage
 were not shown to be consistent. In some plants, the
 metal  salt dosage was reduced  when  polymer was
 used.  In other plants, however, the metal salt dosage
 increased. This is an  apparent reflection of site-
 specific  conditions  such as  background  water
 chemistry, plant layout for mixing and flocculation,
 settling and control, and plant management operating
 strategies.

 The above ratios should be  examined with caution
 since they  are based on influent concentration.
 Removal  of phosphorus does occur  in both the
 primary clarifier and the biological process; therefore,
 ratios calculated on  an available phosphorus basis
 would  be somewhat  higher when  chemicals are
 dosed to the  secondary  biological   process  or
 secondary clarifier.

 3.2.2  Effect of Effluent Limit on Chemical Use
 The  relationships  between metal-to-influent  TP
 ratio  on  a  weight  basis  and effluent phosphorus
 concentration for aluminum and  iron  salts  for the
 plants summarized  in  Tables 3-1  through  3-11  are
 presented  in  Figures 3-1  and  3-2,  respectively.
 Data  for those plants with  tertiary treatment are
 distinguished from those  with secondary treatment,
 and chemical dosage ranges recommended for use in
 Chapter 2 are included.

 Although  some  plants  achieved  low effluent
 phosphorus concentrations without tertiary treatment,
 higher chemical dosages  were generally required to
 attain the same results. In both  cases, the chemical
 dosage  increased  as the  required   effluent   TP
 concentration  decreases.  Iron-to-influent TP weight
 ratios as high as  10 and aluminum-to-influent  TP
 weight ratios over 4 were needed to achieve effluent
 TP concentrations of  0.2  mg/l,  while  corresponding
 ratios to achieve an effluent  TP concentration of  1.0
 mg/l were down to 4 for iron and 3 for aluminum.
In  Table  3-13,  expanded performance data  for
specific plants in the CBDB are shown. Five plants,
four  activated sludge and  one trickling  filter, used
aluminum  salts for  two different  effluent TP limits:
Upper  Allen, PA; Seneca, MD; and, Elizabethtown,
PA, with 2.0 mg/l, and Dale City, VA, and Piscataway,
MD,  with  0.2  mg/l.  The corresponding A|3 +/influent
TP feed rates (weight basis) were  0.85,  0.8, 2.5,
2.34, and  1.78, respectively. The dosage  for the four
activated sludge plants was two to three  times more
to reach the 0.2-mg/l TP effluent limit  than  the 2.0-
mg/l limit.  Two trickling  filter plants used  ferric
chloride: Elizabethtown, PA, with  an effluent limit of
2.0  mg/l TP and Little Hunting Creek, VA, with  an
effluent limit of 0.2  mg/l  TP.  The corresponding
Fe3 + /influent TP feed rates (weight basis) were 1.39
and  4.69, respectively.  Again,  the dosage was over
three times higher to achieve the lower effluent limit
of 0.2  mg/l TP.  The Elizabethtown plant  added alum
from July 1985 through January 1986,  then  switched
to ferric chloride in February 1986. Data  from  one
CBDB plant, Damascus, MD, that does  not remove
phosphorus chemically are included in  Table 3-13 to
provide baseline information.

Polymer dosage varied from none at  Dale  City and
Elizabethtown to 2.8 mg/l at Little Hunting Creek and
3.8 mg/l at Piscataway.

3.2.3 Effect of Chemical Phosphorus Removal on
Sludge Generation
Sludge  generation resulting from  chemical
phosphorus removal  was evaluated for  selected
plants in  the  Chesapeake  Bay and the Great Lakes
Drainage Basins as  shown  in Tables 3-13 and 3-
 14,  respectively. Major contributing factors are  the
effluent phosphorus limit as described earlier, dosage
 rate, and sludge handling methods at the plant.

 The impact on  total  sludge  production  when
 phosphorus  removal  chemicals  are  added to
 secondary treatment plants is depicted in Figure 3-3.
 Total sludge production is represented  as multiples of
 mass  of raw  influent TSS  and is plotted against
 effluent TP concentration.  A marked  increase  in
 sludge production  is evident at  low  effluent  TP
 concentrations of 0.2 mg/l compared to 0.7 to  2.0
 mg/l.  The data in  Figurer  3-3 suggest  that  the
 quantity  of  sludge  produced  will be  2 to 3  times
 higher at very low effluent TP concentrations, such as
 0.2 mg/l,  than  at  more  moderate effluent  TP
 concentrations. The exact quantity further depends on
 the amount of chemicals added for sludge handling.

 The type of biological treatment process  also impacts
 the sludge quantity. The  least sludge generation  is
 expected from an extended aeration process, and the
 most  is expected  from a high-rate activated sludge
 process.
                                                   31

-------
Figure 3-1.   Alum-to-infJuent TP ratio vs. effluent TP concentration.
  AI3+/!nfluentTP (weight)

      6 r
                                                                 A  Secondary Treatment
                                                                 •  Tertiary Treatment
J	I	I	I
                                                                I	I
                                                                                                •

                                                                                                 I
                              .4          .6
                                                    .8         1         1.2

                                                        Effluent TP, mg/l
                                                                  1.4         1.6        1.8
Figure 3*2.   Ferric Iron-to-influent TP ratio vs. effluent TP concentration.
  Fe3+/InfluentTP (weight)

      10 r-          A
J	I
                                                               A Secondary Treatment
                                                               • Tertiary Treatment
J	I
                                                                I
                                                       •

                                                        I
                                                                                     I          I
                              .4
                                                    .8         1         1.2

                                                         Effluent TP, mg/l
                                                                  1.4         1.6        1.8
                                                             32

-------
                   t  CO
                                                          f-         co

                                                          ^  r?     CM
                                                                          g>
                                                                          b
                                                                                                                                 CM


                                                                                                                                 °     i
                                                                                                            ll
                                                                                                            |f

                                                                                                            to
                       r-   CO
                                                      O  CM

                                                      CM  r-'  £

                                                              3
                                             i

                                              fe
                                            = 7^
                                             o
                                                                                          10

                                                                                          CM
Mix Chamber

Upstream of

Sec. Clarifiers
                        00

                        co   in  T-
                   £
           o
                                         CO  CO

                                         co  en   CM
                                                  to
CM  CM         l~-

0  O  7?    CM
                                                                           HI
                                                                                      O)

                                                                                      °
                                                                           IO
                                                                             in
                    ^^
                    9
                    CM
                                                      CM   CM
                                                      o   cJ   e
                        O

                        CM
                                 in       co   CD

                            CM   CO   IO  CM   CO
                            O       **
                            CM       «-
                 CM  CM

                 O  O  £
                                O

                                CO
                                    f*^    00

                                    r^    CO
               CM

               O
                                                (5 CO
                                                o h-

                                                ife
                                                                                                    Q
                                                                           10

                                                                                    CM

CM  CM   E     00
         3
                                                                           c

                                                                           'E
                                         J2
                                                          .0) Q.




                                                          Q) ii







                                                          c:
                                                          o

                                                          '«
                                                          Q>  Q>


                                                          5g
                                                                                                                        r   •*.
                                                                                                                        *"'*
                                                                                                                 b

                                                                                                                 ai
                                                                                             2
                                                                                             °
                                                                                                                                            «
                                                                                                                                            O
                                                                                                                        10
                                                                                                                        in
                                                                                                                        o
                                                                                                                                         tf>
                                                                                                                                         S.
 co


 £

 CO
 co


 co
                                                                                                                 CO
                                                                              33

-------
CT

O

S


I
i


1
<;




g
a.




£
I




1
1
1


I




&
"g
CO
s
"i

1
1
s
o
**
&
s
CO
1
o


CD
I
1

^*


co
•s
g
o

1
CO
1



H


cq
r*



in





CO
en
*





o
CO




^
Jj



co
S3



iC


CO CO
CM t-



oj co
o





?.
K rf





8 2





i»- CM
CM T-
CM


CO
| *

ss

Influent TBOD,
Effluent TBOD,


to
cq en (j
CO T- CO O CO CD
^- r- Tf U.


cn o m
en •* Jc g
t- in if r-' fL. .s
in -J
1-  t
to .= _T* jo
05 C ' ~
en o co .Q
Number of St^
Sludge Conditii
Fe3+/TPorAI
Removed, I

T3
.S
CD o r^>
i1 ^ s
'£•
O


° d d




»_
^ OJ TJ-
U. r- t~~_
1 " N




£ T- CM
L d co
i~




E
CD CO
g d -
'£•
a


^ CM r-
u. co in
cj ° *

X)
0) -J3 I
*d S O Q) *^3
(0 a) Cf\ 3 O
1 IP If
S) §> jg 'c o.
-o Ecc |H
CO CO O
                                                                                                        m
                                                                                                        o

                                                                                                        d
               03  ^

               '-p  S-
               s  Q.
 CM

 d
                                                                                                              s.  s  s.
                                                                                                       CO"3  S
CD



6
    <      I
    X  C  co
u.  Q.  .9  J5


ra  §  .1  ra
IS  3  Jfe  "D
<5  e  •«  ^
P  S  z  co
                                                                            34

-------

1?
O CO
a.—




I0
IE *£?
ol-
0. ^"



£•
O
CD
CO


H
§
Q.

•D
C
.2
I
_C
C
o
t>_
I 1
i *
^
CO
O
a.

5

A) C.
Si Q)
co 
-Q
U
co (o m T- T- T-
fr- CO
»*w
o
<


T3
CO ''fr °o _i.
'cocvjTt-coor^coZ
fT-cJcNJm*— c\id(f;
.- GO T- I-. i-
B


CD
O>
T3
13
OT § ^ w oo
IBcocooocomoJ^co
n3 ,^ JH
>
1



co
< «- m co
-^" i^ in 05 co 10 co d ^
u_ co CM


£" in
co co co en T-
£°£:So5;eyo2.



CD
01

13
CO »-
* cq co cp r»- en
1
**


1)
.
!|iii!!||
i * s*
0 ^ | CM 55
O ° H-
r 5 E ^
f£ < -c Q
*c Q- ^«
a.
| 1 ?3
E ^ £ ^ f I
— ^ Q O CO "c
o § 0,2
II 1 i
Q. Q_ . -e

§
0 "S
Q S i? d
te '&
S Q







CO (D CO
o <= £ 

., *- *~ !J 2 0 0 0 5 d c c c c ,- " 1 r^ d to o co CD S ^ -Q I -. 1 "3 -D "S g, c | O) T3 3 "^ ^^ ® "SBSE^-|s ft f ff S1 1 s g, ^ 5 "f 5 s E O O H UJ Z CO 35


-------
Figure 3-3.   Sludge generation rate vs. effluent TP concentration.

  Sludgo Generation Rate -
  Total Sludge Mass/Raw TSS, Ib/lb

        4 r—
                                                                     • Alum - CBDB
                                                                     A. Ferric - CBDB
                                                                     A Ferric - Great Lakes
                                                                     O No Chemicals Added
                           •
                           I
I
I
                                            4                6
                                               Effluent TP, mg/l
                                                                                              10
The combined effects  of  effluent  phosphorus
concentration achieved and methods  of sludge
handling employed  on  sludge production is  further
illustrated  in  Figure 3-4. The  extended  aeration
processes at Upper Allen and Seneca produced low
sludge  generation rates (SGRs),  defined  as  total
mass of sludge produced per  unit of raw influent TSS
received at the plant, while  contact stabilization at
Dale City yielded a high SGR of 2.0. High SGRs of 2
to 3 were noted for plants that use lime  stabilization
for sludge conditioning and  have  low  effluent
phosphorus limits.
The treatment/sludge handling scheme  having  the
least impact on  sludge generation with  chemical
phosphorus removal was aerobic digestion followed
by  land application of liquid  sludge in an  extended
aeration plant. A  good example  is Upper Allen,  PA,
where  alum  addition  is  practiced, with an SGR of
0.36. Land  application of  anaerobically  digested
sludge at Elizabethtown, PA, produced an  SGR of 0.9
where  ferric  chloride was added  to this two-stage
trickling filter plant.
The least desirable sludge handling  alternative
evaluated was lime stabilization  followed  by vacuum
filtration. Not only was the quantity of lime necessary
to  stabilize  sludge excessive,  but  significant
maintenance  problems also existed  in plants utilizing
this sludge handling  sequence. Piscataway,  MD, and
Little Hunting Creek,  VA, produced SGRs  of 2.32 and
3.2, respectively, using this technology.

Polymer conditioning  of  sludge in  general results in
somewhat  lower  solids content  in  the cake, which
        means  higher  handling  costs.  This  alternative,
        however,  does  not  increase the  sludge quantity
        significantly.

        3.2.4 Effect of Chemical  Phosphorus Removal on
        pH
        Two  major  factors  contribute to  reductions  in  pH
        during  wastewater  treatment:  nitrification  and
        coagulants such  as aluminum and iron salts. Further
        description of these phenomena  are  presented  in
        Chapter 7.

        Low  to  moderate  alkalinity  necessitates  pH
        adjustment in some parts  of  CBDB where chemical
        phosphorus removal is practiced.  Examples  were
        found in  Seneca,  MD, and  Dale  City, VA,  where
        seasonal nitrification is  also required. The dosages of
        caustic  soda at  Dale City and  sodium hydroxide at
        Seneca  necessary to prevent unacceptable  pH
        depression vary with the  seasonal  nitrification
        operation. Other  CBDB  plants  having  facilities
        necessary to feed  caustic  chemicals  were  not
        operating  these facilities at the  time the plants were
        studied.

        3.2.5 Cost of Chemicals
        The cost of phosphorus removal chemicals  was
        calculated on a  pound removed basis and included
        the cost  of metal salts and  polymer  (when  used).
        Average costs  were then determined for  individual
        chemicals  with  and  without  polymer  use and for
        effluent TP concentrations greater  or less than 0.5
        mg/l. These average costs are presented in Table 3-
        15.
                                                 36

-------
Figure 3-4.   Sludge generated vs. metal ion-to-influent TP ratio.
  Sludge Generation Rate -
  Total Sludge Mass/Raw TSS, Ib/lb

       4  i—
                                             (0.2)
                                              '
   Aluminum Salt
   Ferric Chloride
   Effluent TP Cone.
   Dose Ratio Based on Metal Ion/Influent TP
« Dose Ratio Based on Metal Ion/IP Removed
                                                                                                  Little Hunting Creek, VA*
                                                                                                  TF
                                                                                                  Lime Stab.
                                                                                                  Filter Press

                                                                                                     (0.2) &
                                           Piscataway, MD*
                                           2-Stage AS
                                           Lime Stab.
                                           Filter Press

                                          (0.2)9
          Dale City, VA"
          Contact Stab.
          Chem. Reactor-Clarifier
          Aerobic Digestion
          Filter Press w/Polymer
                      Seneca, MD*
                      Ext. Aeration
                      Aerobic Dig.
                      Filter Press
                                                     (0.2) •
(0.7)4 Warren, Mr

      Lime/Ferric Cond.
      Belt Press
                          Elizabethtown, PA'

                                  (1-7) A
                                          Lansing, Mr
                                          AS
                                          Zimpro
                                          Vac. Filtration

                                          (0.65)A
         Elizabethtown, PA*
         TF
         Anaer. Digestion.
         Land Application
(0.9)4
 Port Huron. Mr
 AS
 Lime Stab.
 Land Application
                       (2.0)« Upper Allen. PA"
                              Ext. Aeration
                              Aerobic Dig.
                        	Lf nd Applicatiqn
                                                   2                    3

                                                  AI3+/TP or Fe3+/TP (weight)
Table 3-15. Average Ch
Chemical
Alum
Sodium Aluminate
Ferric Chloride
Ferrous Chloride
Ferrous Sulfate
Lime
lemical Cost for Phosphorus Removal (S/lb TP removed)*
Effluent TP > 0.5 mg/l Effluent TP
Without Polymer
1.29 (5)
1.54(1)
0.51 (3)
0.53 (19)
0.33 (4)
0.81 (1)
With Polymer
1.50 (5)
1.40 (1)
1.30(10)
1.02(10)
0.70(1)
0.81 (1)
Without Polymer
1.91 (4)

1.38(1)
0.25(1)
0.10 (3)
-
< 0.5 mg/l
'With Polymer
4.81 (4)
-
, 2.39(8):
0.44 (2)
-
' -
    Number of plants indicated in parentheses.
 As expected,  chemical costs were  higher for those
 plants achieving effluent TP concentrations less  than
 0.5  mg/l, with the  exception of  those  plants using
 ferrous  salts.  Alum  was 40 percent more  expensive
 than ferric chloride  for plants at which  polymer  was
                not used,  and  100 percent  more  expensive  when
                used in combination with polymer.  Ferrous salts were
                used  at only  a handful  of  plants achieving  effluent
                phosphorus concentrations  less than 0.5 mg/l,  and
                the average  cost  was  very  low,  probably  because
                                                           37

-------
ferrous iron was available as pickle liquor for the cost
of shipping only.


3.3 Biological Phosphorus Removal

3.3.1 PhoStrip Process
3.3.1.1 PhoStrip Process Performance
Thirteen  full-scale plants  have been  constructed or
retrofitted to  the PhoStrip process to  date, and a
fourteenth is under construction at Ithaca, NY. Five of
the completed facilities are no longer  being operated
with PhoStrip  for phosphorus  removal. Several have
converted to chemical phosphorus removal, and in
one case the  need for phosphorus compliance was
eliminated. Design flow rates for the PhoStrip process
have ranged from 0.04 to 1.3 m3/s (0.9 to 30 mgd).
Most of the plants were designed to achieve effluent
TP concentrations of  1.0  mg/l, although two  were
designed for an effluent concentration of less than 0.5
mg/l TP with tertiary filtration.

Rve PhoStrip  plants were designed to operate with
pure oxygen aeration, and  nine with conventional air
aeration. A variety of activated sludge flow regimes
have been  selected for  use in  conjunction with
PhoStrip,  including complete mix,  plug flow, contact
stabilization, step aeration,  two-stage nitrification,
and high-rate  activated  sludge.  Equalization and
tertiary filtration were incorporated in many of the
PhoStrip treatment sequences. Over  half the  plants
were designed with more than one anaerobic stripper.
Eight plant designs   used one or  more  reactor*
clarifiors for lime precipitation, while the remaining  six
had one  or more mixer/flocculators  and co-settled
the lime-phosphorus  sludge in the primary clarifiers.
Reactor-clarifier overflow  was the  most  frequently
chosen  elutriation source,  and stripper tank sludge
recycle  was provided in five of the plants. Primary
effluent was the elutriation source for two plants.

Performance data are available for four of the eight
PhoStrip plants  currently  in operation. The four  for
which data are not available are Tahoe-Truckee, CA;
Southtowns, NY; Brockton, MA; and Rochester, MN.
Brief descriptions of  and performance summaries  for
the four operating plants are given below.

Adrian,  ML   The  0.31-m3/s  (7.0-mgd) Adrian
PhoStrip plant has  been in  operation  since  19SO.
PhoStrip was  constructed  as  part of the first-stage
activated sludge system followed by a second-stage
nitrification system.  Primary  effluent  serves as the
elutriate, and  lime precipitation  is  carried out in a
flocculation tank with  the lime-phosphorus sludge
co-settled in  the  primary  clarifiers.  Secondary
effluent receives tertiary filtration prior to discharge.

Overall, the performance of the PhoStrip  process at
Adrian  has  been   good, with  average removal
efficiencies for TBOD, TSS, and TP of 95,  97, and 69
 percent, respectively, during the period October 1981
 through  September  1982 without the second-stage
 system in operation.

 Savage,  MD.  The  Little  Patuxent Wastewater
 Treatment Plant serving Savage,  MD,  is  a two-
 stage, plug flow, activated sludge PhoStrip plant with
 two strippers and  two  reactor-clarifiers. Reactor-
 clarifier overflow is used as the elutriate. A 1985 data
 summary indicated that for  an average flow  of 0.39
 m3/s (8.8 mgd)  and  an average influent  (to the
 PhoStrip  process)  TP concentration of  8.6  mg/l,
 secondary effluent TP   averaged 0.8 mg/l while the
 filtered  effluent averaged  0.4  mg/l. Occasional daily
 excursions of the effluent TP above 1.0 mg/l have
 been encountered.

 Reno-Sparks,  NV.  The  Reno-Sparks Wastewater
 Treatment Facility  is a single-stage,  plug  flow,
 activated sludge PhoStrip plant with five strippers and
 two mixer/flocculators using stripper sludge recycle as
 the elutriate. At an  average flow  of  1.1  m3/s (25.4
 mgd) and an average influent TP concentration  of
 7.25 mg/l, the average effluent TP concentration was
'0.31  mg/l for the period  June 1985 through March
 1986. Effluent phosphorus excursions above 1.0 mg/l
 rarely occurred on a daily basis. It should be noted
 that this excellent performance was achieved without
 tertiary filtration.

 Lansdale,  PA. This 0.1-m3/s (2.5-mgd) plant has
 no primary.  Wastewater  flows  to  an  activated
 sludge-PhoStrip system  for BOD  and  phosphorus
 removal.  Reactor-clarifier overflow  and  secondary
 effluent  are  used to  elutriate  phosphorus  in the
 stripper.

 Nitrification occurs  in a separate-stage activated
 sludge  system. Waste biological  sludges  are
 combined with the  waste chemical sludge from the
 PhoStrip  process, gravity thickened, stabilized  with
 lime, and then dewatered or spread on land.

 A  1984-1985  data summary  indicated  average
 effluent concentrations of 0.8 mg/l for TP,  3  mg/l for
 TBOD  and 4  mg/l for TSS were achieved with the
 first-stage  activated  sludge-PhoStrip  system. Table
 3-16 summarizes typical  operating conditions for the
 Lansdale and Little Patuxent  plants (1).
 3.3.1.2 Cost for PhoStrip Process Retrofit
 Retrofit costs for the  PhoStrip process  must be
 evaluated on a site-specific basis.  Capital  costs will
 include construction of  a stripper  tank, reactor-
 clarifier  or chemical  mix/flocculation  tank,  lime
 handling facilities, and associated piping, as well as a
 license fee  charged  for  use  of the  proprietary
 process. O&M costs will include energy for pumping
 and mixing, lime,  and maintenance associated with
 operating a lime feed system.
                                                  38

-------
Table 3-16. Summary of PhoStrip Plant Operating Conditions for Lansdale
Lansdale
Parameter
Stripper
SDT, hr
Feed flow rate, percent of mainstream flow
Elutriation flow rate, percent of feed flow
Elutriation rate1, l/g TSS/d
Underflow rate, percent of mainstream flow
Recycle rate, percent of stripper flow
Overflow rate, percent of mainstream flow
Effluent Total P, mg/l
Effluent Ortho P, mg/l
Reactor-Clarifier
Effluent Total P, mg/l
Effluent Ortho P, mg/l
Overflow rate, gpd/sq ft
Lime dosage
mg/l
PH
Activated Sludge Process
F/M, kg TBOD/kg MLVSS/d
MLSS, mg/l .
TP/VSS, percent
SRT, days
. HRT, hr
Return sludge ratio
DO, mg/l :
Sludge production4, kg VSS/kg TBOD
,-•: 1982

20
14
124
0.14
10
0
23
20.6
16.4
• -.
3.6
0.9
1,600

100
9.0:

0.16
1,900
3.3
6.5
46
^•** - :'
0.16
2-3
1.0
and Little Patuxent
Little Patuxent
July 1984

8
22
121
0.72
14
0
35
9.5
7.2

3.9
0.9
1,120

160
9.5

. 0.52.3
2.9502
4.0
3.72.3
2.6
0.32-
1.3
0.7

April 1985

7
34
50
0.25
21
78
31
20.0
17.6

7.2
1.2
840

100
9.5

0.5
2,000
4.6
2.8
3.0
0.57
2-5
"
 1 Based on mass of solids in stripper.
 2 Estimated from solids balance.
 3 Calculated based on estimated MLSS.
 4 Based on removed carbonaceous TBOD.
The  capital  cost for the hardware for the PhoStrip
process at Adrian, Ml, in 1977, was $556,000 for the
design flow  of 0.31 m3/s (7.0 mgd). The license fee
was  $250,000,  making the total  cost $806,000. The
license fee amount may not be representative of the
fee that would  be charged today. The annual O&M
cost in  1986 was  approximately $25,000, of which
$14,800 was for lime,  $6,000 for  labor, and $4,200
for excess sludge handling and disposal.

3.3.2 A/O Process

3.3.2.1 A/O  Process Performance
Two full-scale A/O plants are currently in operation:
Largo, PL,  and Pontiac,  Ml.  Another 13 full-scale
A/O  systems  are, currently  in .design  or  under
construction with  design  capacities of  0.13 to 3.1
nr>3/s (3 to 70 mgd). Available data for the Largo and
Pontiac facilities are summarized  below.

Largo, FL. The Largo  A/O system is a retrofit of a
plug-flow  activated sludge plant.designed  for a flow
of 0.14  m3/s  (3.2 mgd). Anaerobic and aerobic
detention  times  are 1.5 and 2.6 hours,  respectively.
Influent TP averged 8.9 mg/l  during the performance
test  period, while the effluent TP averaged 1.85 mg/l.
The  effluent SP concentration during the same period
averaged  0.51   mg/l. The plant  was designed to
achieve an effluent TP of 1.5. mg/l. Sludge handling
consists of aerobic digestion followed  by mechanical
dewatering.

Pontiac, Ml. The A/O system in  Pontiac is a 0.15-
m3/s  (3.5-mgd)  retrofit  of a  plug-flow  activated
sludge train. Detention times for  the  anaerobic  and
aerobic stages  are  longer here, 2.1  and 7.7 hours,
respectively. TP was reduced  from an  average
influent concentration of  3.7 mg/l to  an average
effluent concentration of 0.9 mg/l on a  U.S.  EPA
demonstration  project  during  a   period when
nitrification  was being  achieved and  the main
treatment  process was receiving full  in-plant  recycle
of  sidestreams, including  anaerobic  digester
supernatant.  During  the  1-year demonstration
project, average effluent TP concentrations exceeded
1  mg/l during only two  2-week   periods.  The
excursions were attributed to the effect of extremes in
pH caused by  industrial discharges.   The plant  has
been  successfully operating for about 2 years  with
seasonal  nitrification  and  recycle  of anaerobic
digester supernatant.  It  was  shown  that  only a
fraction of the phosphorus removed biologically  was
released  into   the  digester  supernatant  under
anaerobic  conditions.  The mechanism  by which
phosphorus is trapped in the solids in the digester is
being further studied, but it is currently hypothesized
                                                  39

-------
Toblo 3-17.  Pontlac A/O Wastewater Treatment Facility Performance Data
                                       Influent
Effluent
Parameter
Timo Period
Flow, mgd
TBOD, mg/l
TSS, mg/l
TP, mg/l
With Nitrification
10/1/84-11/14/84
2.86
163
140
3.7
Without Nitrification
2/6/85 - 3/31/85
4.28
136
136
2.6
With Nitrification
-
-
9.4
7
0.9
Without Nitrification
-
-
11
10
0.7
that phosphorus is being chemically precipitated in
tho presence of magnesium  and ammonia in the
digester to an insoluble compound called magnesium
ammonium phosphate. The  average performance of
the Pontiac A/O system is  summarized  in Table 3-
17  for a 45-day period with nitrification  and full in-
plant digester  supernatant  recycle and a  54-day
period without  nitrification, but with full  in-plant
digester supernatant recycle.

3.3.2.2 Cost for A/O Process  Retrofit
As  with PhoStrip,  retrofit costs for the A/O process
must be evaluated on a  site-specific basis. Capital
costs include construction of baffles to separate the
various stages, removal of existing aeration devices in
anaerobic  stages, possible  addition  of aeration
devices in aerobic stages, and  installation of mixers in
anaerobic stages.   O&M costs  include energy  for
internal  recycle pumping, if  required, and to operate
the mixers.  It has been reported that some savings in
aeration power may be realized due to the decreased
aerobic  stage organic loading resulting from the BOD
removal that occurs in the anaerobic stages (2).

Retrofit costs (in 1984 dollars) for the Pontiac project
totaled  $57,000 for  conversion of  a  0.15-m3/s
(3.5-mgd) plug flow activated sludge train to an A/0
system. The  license fee was waived   for Pontiac
because this was a demonstration project.


3.4 References
1. Tetreault,  M.J.,  A.H. Benedict, C. Kaemfer, and
  E.F.  Barth.  Biological  Phosphorus Removal: A
  Technology Evaluation. JWPCF 58:823, 1986.

2. Brannan, K.P., C.W.  Randall, and L.D. Benefield.
  The Anaerobic  Stabilization of  Organics  in  a
  Biological  Phosphorus   Removal System.
  Presented at the 59th Annual  Conference,  Water
  Pollution  Control Federation, Los Angeles,  CA,
  October 1986.
                                                  40

-------
                                             Chapter 4
           Process Design Synopses for Retrofitting Chemical Phosphorus Removal
This chapter is primarily directed to the plant designer
who has the task of retrofitting an existing wastewater
treatment  plant to  phosphorus removal by means of
chemical precipitation. The designer should  refer to
the design synopsis that  pertains  to the  plant
category to be retrofitted. This chapter also should be
of interest to plant operators and  regulators charged
with reviewing construction grant  applications. There
are nine design synopses covering the following plant
categories:

1. Plug Flow,  Complete Mix, and Step  Aeration
   Activated Sludge Systems
2. Contact Stabilization Activated Sludge Systems
3. Pure Oxygen Activated Sludge Systems
4. Extended  Aeration and Oxidation Ditch Activated
   Sludge Systems
5. Two-Stage  Nitrification  Activated   Sludge
   Systems
6. High-Rate Trickling Filter Systems
7. Standard-Rate Trickling  Filter Systems
8. RBC Systems
9. Lagoon Systems

Each  design synopsis  provides information on  the
following 12 areas, grouped by required effluent TP
concentration {0.2, 0.5, 1, and 2 mg/l):

1.  Chemical dose requirements
2.  Points of metal salt addition
3.  Points of polymer addition
4.  Impact on  overall secondary  treatment  process
    performance
5.  Impact on sludge settling
6.  Impact on sludge quantities and characteristics
7.  Impact on sludge thickening
8.  Impact on sludge handling/disposal facilities
9.  Impact on  return sludge  and  sludge  handling
    recycle streams
10. Impact of wastewater temperature
11. Effluent polishing requirements
12. Process flexibility recommendations

The  choice  of chemical  for use  in  phosphorus
removal must be made on  a  site-specific basis  and
will depend primarily on cost and availability.  The use
of lime for  chemical phosphorus removal is  not
recommended due to the many associated problems
in handling.

Metal salt-to-influent TP weight ratios were used as
initial chemical dose guides for the design synopses
in this  chapter. Once a facility is in operation and a
data base exists, more precise  dosage ratios of metal
salt-to-influent SP  can be established for  routine
operational control.
                                                 41

-------
                                       Design Synopsis  1:
         Plug Flow, Complete Mix, and Step Aeration Activated Sludge Systems

1. Chemical dose requirements:
   Required Effluent TP
M3+/lnfluentTP
 Ratio (weight)    Polymer Dose
mg/l
0.2
0.5
1
2

2.0-5.0
1.5-2.0
1.2-1.5
1.0-1.2
mg/l
0.2-1.0
0.1-0.5
0.1-0.2
0.1-0.2
2. Points of metal salt addition:

   For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/I effluent TP:
   Ahead of both primary and secondary clarifiers.

   For 1 and 2 mg/l effluent TP:
   Ahead of primary or secondary clarifier.

3. Points of polymer addition:

   For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l eff. TP (will be necessary):
   Ahead of both primary and secondary clarifiers.

   For 1 mg/I eff. TP (will be necessary):
   Ahead of primary or secondary clarifier.

   For 2 mg/l eff. TP (may be necessary):
   Ahead of primary or secondary clarifier.

4. Impact on overall secondary treatment process performance:
   When  phosphorus removal chemicals are added to the secondary treatment  process, metal phosphate
   precipitates and other metal ion precipitates are formed and occluded into the activated sludge mass.  This
   contributes an inert fraction to the MLSS, and wasting schedules for control of SRT may have to be altered.

   For 0.2 mg/I effluent TP:
   Process pH must be monitored since high dosages of metal salts can result in depressed pH values.

5. Impact on sludge settling:
   Sludge  settling rates  are  normally improved when metal salts are added to  primary and/or secondary
   cfarifiers. Polymer addition is sometimes also necessary in conjunction with metal salt addition to aid in solids
   agglomeration and capture and prevent carry-over of inorganic solids to the secondary treatment process or
   fine floe particles to the final effluent.  Best results are attained when clarifiers are greater than 2.7 m (9 ft)
   deep.

   For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/I effluent TP:
   Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 20 m3/m2/d (500 gpd/sq ft).

   For 1 mg/l effluent TP:
   Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 24 m3/m2/d (600 gpd/sq ft).

   For 2 mg/I effluent TP:
   Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 32 m3/m2/d (800 gpd/sq ft).
                                                42

-------
6. Impact on sludge quantities and characteristics:
  When chemicals are added prior to primary clarifiers,  sludge  yields will  increase due to the formation of
  insoluble metal hydroxides and the entrapment of BOD and suspended solids onto floes. Primary sludge will,
  therefore, contain a greater amount of organic matter since it is captured with the inorganic floes.

  Solids production also increases when  chemicals are added to the secondary treatment process, but not to
  as great an extent. Waste secondary sludge will contain a higher fraction of inert solids than normal.

  For 0.2 mg/1 effluent TP:
  Increases in sludge production greater than 200 percent can be expected due to the extremely high dosages
  of chemicals necessary  to achieve this low effluent limit. Actual increases, however, will depend on site-
  specific conditions.

  For 0.5 mg/1 effluent TP:
  Increases in sludge production of 100 to 200 percent have been documented when chemicals  are added to
  both  the  primary  and secondary  treatment  processes.  Actual increases,  however,  will  depend  on site-
  specific conditions.

  For 1 and 2 mg/1 effluent TP:
  Increases in sludge production of 60 to 100 percent have been documented when chemicals are added to
  the primary treatment process, and 40 to 60 percent when chemicals are added to the secondary treatment
  process. Actual increases, however, will depend on  site-specific conditions.

7. Impact on sludge thickening:
  The increased sludge volumes resulting from chemical phosphorus removal will lead to both higher solids and
  hydraulic loading rates on gravity and flotation thickeners.  Thickener design loading rates may,  therefore, be
  exceeded in plants that are at or near treatment capacity.  Solids capture may decrease when design loading
  rates are exceeded.

8. Impact on sludge handling/disposal facilities:
  The increase in sludge production may cause the design loading rates of sludge handling/disposal facilities to
  be  exceeded  if the plant is at or near  treatment capacity. Under these circumstances,  sludge disposal
  facilities may not operate correctly and may need to be reviewed and upgraded to  handle the  additional
  quantities and  types of sludges generated (e.g., conversion of low-rate digesters to high-rate digesters or
  a two-stage digestion  system to a single-stage digestion system).

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/1 effluent TP:
  Anaerobic sludge digestion may be inhibited due to the high proportion of chemical sludge resulting from high
  dosages of  chemical.  Use  of this  method of sludge stabilization should be avoided, therefore, if possible,
  where very low effluent phosphorus is required.

9. Impact on return sludge and sludge handling recycle streams:
  Return activated sludge will contain a higher fraction of inert solids when phosphorus removal chemicals  are
  used  in the secondary treatment process. As a result, higher return sludge rates will normally be  required.

  The concentration of certain constituents in sludge handling recycle streams such as nitrogen, phosphorus,
  and soluble organics  may  also  increase  when chemical phosphorus removal is  imposed  on an existing
  treatment plant. This factor needs to be considered in the overall retrofit design and is particularly important if
  biological reactor capacity is marginal.

10. Impact of wastewater temperature:
  Phosphorus removal performance decreases in cold  temperatures due to decreased settleability of chemical
  floes resulting from greater liquid viscosity and density. Increased chemical dosages and polymer use may be
  required.
                                                 43

-------
11. Effluent polishing requirements:

   For 0.2 mg/l effluent TP:
   Polymer addition to the primary and secondary clarifiers and tertiary filtration will be required.

   For 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
   Polymer addition to the primary and secondary  clarifiers will be required. Additional clarifier capacity  or
   tertiary filtration may be necessary.

   For 1 and 2 mg/l effluent TP:
   Effluent polishing should not be necessary.

12. Process flexibility recommendations:
  For 0.2 mg/l effluent TP:
  ® Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
  « Row equalization:
  » Polymer addition:
  e Effluent polishing:
necessary
necessary
necessary
necessary
   In addition, pH control instrumentation and dosing of pH neutralizing chemicals may be required.
   For 0.5 mg/I effluent TP:
   » Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
   e Row equalization:
   » Polymer addition:
   » Effluent polishing:

   For 1 and 2 mg/l effluent TP:
   e Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
   * Flow equalization:
   • Polymer addition:
   » Effluent polishing:
necessary
may be required
necessary
may be required
recommended
not required
may be required
not required
                                                  44

-------
                                       Design Synopsis 2:
                      Contact Stabilization Activated Sludge Systems
1. Chemical dose requirements:
   Required Effluent TP
M3+/Influent TP
 Ratio (weight)     Polymer Dose
mg/l
0.2
0.5
1
2

2.0-5.0
1.5-2.0
1.2-1.5
1.0-1.2
mg/l
0.2-1.0
0.1-0.5
0.1-0.2
0.1-0.2
2. Points of metal salt addition:

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
  Ahead of primary clarifier and  at end of contact tank.

  For 1 and 2 mg/l effluent TP:
  Ahead of primary clarifier or at end of contact tank.

3. Points of polymer addition:

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l eff. TP  (will be necessary):
  Ahead of both primary and secondary  clarifiers.

  For 1 mg/l eff. TP (will be necessary):
  Ahead of primary or secondary clarifier.

  For 2 mg/l eff. TP (may be necessary):
  Ahead of primary or secondary clarifier.

4. Impact on overall secondary treatment process performance:
  When  phosphorus removal chemicals are  added to the secondary treatment  process,  metal  phosphate
  precipitates and other metal ion precipitates are formed and occluded into the activated sludge mass. This
  contributes an inert fraction to the MLSS, and wasting schedules for control of SRT may have to be altered.

  For 0.2 mg/l effluent TP:
  Process pH must be monitored since high dosages of metal salts can result in depressed pH values.

5. Impact on sludge settling:
  Sludge settling  rates are normally improved when metal salts are added to  primary  and/or  secondary
  clarifiers. Polymer addition is sometimes also necessary in conjunction with metal  salt addition to aid  in solids
  agglomeration and capture and prevent carry-over of inorganic solids to the secondary treatment process or
  fine floe particles to the final  effluent. Best results are attained when clarifiers are greater than 2.7 m (9 ft)
  deep.

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l  effluent TP:
  Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 20 m3/m2/d (500 gpd/sq ft).

  For 1 mg/l effluent TP:
  Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 24 m3/m2/d (600 gpd/sq ft).

  For 2 mg/l effluent TP:
  Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 32 m3/m2/d (800 gpd/sq ft).
                                                 45

-------
6. Impact on sludge quantities and characteristics:
  When chemicals are added prior to primary  clarifiers,  sludge yields  will increase due to the formation of
  insoluble metal hydroxides and the entrapment of BOD and suspended solids onto floes. Primary sludge will,
  therefore, contain a greater amount of organic matter since it is captured with the inorganic floes.

  Solids production also increases when chemicals are added to the secondary treatment process, but not to
  as great an extent. Waste secondary sludge will contain a higher fraction of inert solids than normal.

  For 0.2 mg/1 effluent TP:
  Increases in sludge production greater than 200 percent can be expected due to the extremely high dosages
  of chemicals necessary  to achieve this low effluent limit.  Actual increases, however, will depend on site-
  specific conditions.

  For 0.5 mg/I effluent TP:
  Increases in sludge production of 100 to 200  percent have been documented when chemicals are added to
  both  the  primary and secondary treatment  processes. Actual increases, however,  will depend  on site-
  specific conditions.

  For 1 and 2 mg/I effluent TP:
  Increases in sludge  production  of 60 to 100 percent have  been documented  when chemicals  are added to
  the primary treatment process, and 40 to 60 percent when chemicals are added to the secondary treatment
  process. Actual increases,  however, will depend on site-specific conditions.

7. Impact on sludge thickening:
  The increased sludge volumes resulting from chemical phosphorus removal will lead to both higher solids and
  hydraulic loading rates on gravity and flotation thickeners. Thickener design loading rates  may, therefore, be
  exceeded in plants that are at or near treatment capacity. Solids capture may  decrease when design loading
  rates are exceeded.

8. Impact on sludge handling/disposal facilities:
  The increase in sludge production may cause the design loading rates of sludge handling/disposal facilities to
  be exceeded if the plant  is at or near treatment capacity. Under these circumstances, sludge disposal
  facilities may not operate correctly and may need to be  reviewed and  upgraded to handle the additional
  quantities  and  types of sludges generated (e.g., conversion of  low-rate digesters to  high-rate digesters or
  a two-stage digestion  system to a single-stage digestion system).

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/I effluent TP:
  Anaerobic sludge digestion may be inhibited due to the high proportion of chemical sludge  resulting from high
  dosages of chemical.  Use of this method  of sludge stabilization should be avoided,  therefore, if  possible,
  where very low effluent phosphorus is required.

9. Impact on return sludge and sludge handling recycle streams:
  Return activated sludge will contain a higher fraction of inert solids when phosphorus removal chemicals are
  used in the secondary treatment process. As a result, higher return sludge rates will normally be required.

  The concentration of certain constituents in sludge handling recycle  streams  such as  nitrogen, phosphorus,
  and soluble  organics  may  also  increase when  chemical  phosphorus removal is imposed on an existing
  treatment plant. This factor needs to be considered in the overall retrofit design and is particularly important  if
  biological reactor capacity is marginal.

10. Impact of wastewater temperature:
  Phosphorus removal performance decreases in cold temperatures due to decreased settleability of chemical
  floes resulting from greater liquid viscosity and density. Increased chemical dosages and polymer use may be
  required.
                                                  46

-------
11. Effluent polishing requirements:

   For 0.2 mg/l effluent TP:
   Polymer addition to the primary and secondary clarifiers and tertiary filtration will be required.

   For 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
   Polymer addition to the primary and secondary clarifiers  will be required. Additional clarifier  capacity or
   tertiary filtration may be necessary.

   For 1 and 2 mg/l effluent TP:
   Effluent polishing should not be necessary.

12. Process flexibility recommendations:
  For 0.2 mg/l effluent TP:
  • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
  • Flow equalization:
  • Polymer addition:
  • Effluent polishing:
necessary
necessary
necessary
necessary
  In addition, pH control instrumentation and dosing of pH neutralizing chemicals may be required.
  For 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
  • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
  • Flow equalization:
  • Polymer addition:
  • Effluent polishing:

  For 1 and 2 mg/l effluent TP:
  • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
  • Flow equalization:
  • Polymer addition:
  • Effluent polishing:
necessary
may be required
necessary
may be required
recommended
not required
may be required
not required
                                                  47

-------
                                       Design Synopsis 3:
                           Pure Oxygen Activated Sludge Systems
1. Chemical dose requirements:
   Required Edluent TP
M3+/influentTP
 Ratio (weight)     Polymer Dose
mg/l
0.2
0.5
1
2

2.0-5.0
1.5-2.0
1.2-1.5
1.0-1.2
mg/l
0.2-1.0
0.1-0.5
0.1-0.2
0.1-0.2
2. Points of metal salt addition:

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
  Ahead of both primary and secondary clarifiers.

  For 1 and 2 mgil effluent TP:
  Ahead of primary or secondary clarifier.

3. Points of polymer addition:

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l eff. TP (will be necessary):
  Ahead of both primary and secondary clarifiers.

  For 1 mg/I eff. TP (will be necessary):
  Ahead of primary or secondary clarifier.

  For 2 mg/l eff. TP (may be necessary):
  Ahead of primary or secondary clarifier.

4. Impact on overall secondary treatment process performance:
  With a covered pure oxygen reactor, carbon dioxide resulting from biological oxidation is trapped in solution
  rather  than being air stripped from the mixed liquor. The chemicals used for phosphorus  removal  are also
  acidic. Depending  on wastewater alkalinity,  some provision for pH control may be necessary, therefore, to
  prevent  an  unacceptable  degree of pH  depression  and subsequent  interference with normal metabolic
  reactions.

  In addition,  when  phosphorus removal chemicals are added to the secondary  treatment process, metal
  phosphate precipitates and other metal ion  precipitates are formed and occluded into the, activated sludge
  mass.  This contributes an inert fraction to the MLSS, and wasting schedules for control of SRT may have to
  be altered.

  For 0.2 mg/l effluent TP:
  Process pH must be monitored since high dosages of metal salts  can result in depressed  pH values.

5. Impact on sludge settling:
  Sludge settling  rates are  normally improved when metal salts are added to primary and/or secondary
  clarifiers. Polymer addition is sometimes also necessary in conjunction with metal salt addition to aid in solids
  agglomeration and capture  and prevent carry-over of inorganic solids to the secondary treatment process or
  fine floe particles to  the final effluent. Best  results are attained when clarifiers are greater than 2.7 m (9 ft)
  deep.

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
  Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 20 m3/m2/d  (500 gpd/sq ft).
                                                 48

-------
  For 1 mg/1 effluent TP:
  Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 24 m3/m2/d (600 gpd/sq ft).

  For 2 mg/1 effluent TP:
  Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 32 m3/m2/d (800 gpd/sq ft).

6. Impact on sludge quantities and characteristics:
  When  chemicals are added prior to primary clarifiers,  sludge  yields will  increase due to  the formation of
  insoluble metal hydroxides and the entrapment of BOD and suspended solids onto floes. Primary sludge will,
  therefore, contain a greater amount of organic matter since it is captured with the inorganic floes.

  Solids production also increases when chemicals are added to the secondary treatment process, but not to
  as great an extent. Waste secondary sludge will contain a higher fraction of inert solids than normal.

  For 0.2 mg/1 effluent TP:
  Increases in sludge production greater than 200 percent can be expected due to the extremely high dosages
  of chemicals  necessary to achieve this low  effluent limit. Actual  increases, however, will depend  on site-
  specific conditions.

  For 0.5 mg/1 effluent TP:
  Increases in sludge production of 100 to 200 percent have been documented when chemicals are added to
  both  the  primary and  secondary treatment processes.  Actual increases,  however,  will  depend  on site-
  specific conditions.

  For 1  and 2 mg/1 effluent TP:
  Increases in  sludge production of 60 to 100  percent have been documented when chemicals are added to
  the primary treatment process, and 40 to 60  percent when chemicals are added to the secondary treatment
  process. Actual increases, however, will depend on site-specific conditions.

 7. Impact on sludge thickening:
  The increased sludge volumes resulting from  chemical phosphorus removal will lead to both higher solids and
  hydraulic loading rates on gravity and flotation thickeners. Thickener design  loading rates may, therefore, be
  exceeded in  plants that are at or  near treatment capacity. Solids capture may decrease when design loading
   rates are exceeded.

 8. Impact on sludge handling/disposal facilities:
   The increase in sludge production may cause the design loading rates of sludge handling/disposal facilities to
   be exceeded  if the plant is at  or near treatment capacity. Under these  circumstances,  sludge  disposal
   facilities may not operate correctly and may need to  be reviewed and  upgraded to  handle the additional
   quantities  and types of sludges generated (e.g.,  conversion of low-rate digesters to high-rate digesters or
   a two-stage  digestion system to a single-stage digestion system).

   For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/1 effluent TP:
   Anaerobic sludge digestion may be inhibited due to the high proportion of chemical  sludge resulting from high
   dosages of chemical. Use of this method of sludge stabilization  should  be avoided,  therefore, if possible,
   where very low effluent phosphorus is required.

 9. Impact on return sludge and sludge handling recycle streams:
   Return activated sludge will contain a higher fraction of inert solids when phosphorus removal chemicals are
   used in the secondary treatment process. As a result, higher  return sludge rates will normally be required.

   The concentration  of certain constituents in sludge handling recycle streams such as  nitrogen, phosphorus,
   and  soluble organics may  also  increase when chemical phosphorus removal is imposed on an existing
   treatment plant. This factor needs to be considered in the overall retrofit design and is particularly important  if
   biological reactor capacity is marginal.
                                                   49

-------
TO. Impact of wastewater temperature:
   Phosphorus removal performance decreases in cold temperatures due to decreased settleability of chemical
   floes resulting from greater liquid viscosity and density. Increased chemical dosages and polymer use may be
   required.

11. Effluent polishing requirements:

   For 0.2 mg/l effluent TP:
   Polymer addition to the primary and secondary clarifiers and tertiary filtration will be required.

   For 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
   Polymer addition to  the primary and secondary clarifiers will be required. Additional clarifier capacity or
   tertiary filtration may be necessary.

   For 1 and 2 mg/l effluent TP:
   Effluent polishing should not be necessary.

12. Process flexibility recommendations:
  For 0.2 mg/I effluent TP:
  * Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
  • Row equalization:
  • Polymer addition:
  • Effluent polishing:
necessary
necessary
necessary
necessary
  In addition, pH control instrumentation and dosing of pH neutralizing chemicals may be required.
  For 0.5 mg/I effluent TP:
  • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
  • Row equalization:
  * Polymer addition:
  • Effluent polishing:

  For 1 and 2 mg/l effluent TP:
  • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
  • Row equalization:
  • Polymer addition:
  • Effluent polishing:
necessary
may be required
necessary
may be required
recommended
not required
may be required
not required
                                                 50

-------
                                       Design Synopsis 4:
            Extended Aeration and Oxidation Ditch Activated Sludge Systems
1. Chemical dose requirements:



   Required Effluent TP
M3+/influent TP
 Ratio (weight)     Polymer Dose
mg/1
0.2
0.5
1
2

2.0-5.0
1.5-2.0
1.2-1.5
1.0-1.2
mg/l
0.2-1.0
0.1-0.5
0.1-0.2
0.1-0.2
2. Points of metal salt addition:

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/1 effluent TP:
  End of aeration tank and a polish dose to the tertiary filter.

  For 1 and 2 mg/1 effluent TP:
  End of aeration tank.

3. Points of polymer addition:

  For 0.2 mg/1 eff. TP (will be necessary):
  Ahead of secondary clarifier and a polish dose to tertiary filter.

  For 0.5 mg/1 eff. TP (will be necessary):
  Ahead of secondary clarifier.

  For 1 and 2 mg/1 eff. TP (may be necessary):
  Ahead of secondary clarifier.

4. Impact on overall secondary treatment process performance:
  Extended aeration  and oxidation ditch systems nitrify during at least part of the year. Acidic hydrogen ions are
  a byproduct of the nitrification process.  Depending on wastewater alkalinity,  some provision for pH control
  may  be necessary,  therefore, to prevent an  unacceptable degree  of  pH depression  and subsequent
  interference with normal metabolic reactions.

  In  addition,  when  phosphorus removal  chemicals are added  to the secondary  treatment process, metal
  phosphate precipitates and other  metal ion precipitates  are formed and  occluded into the activated sludge
  mass. This contributes an inert fraction to the MLSS, and wasting schedules for control of SRT may-have to
  be altered.

  For 0.2 mg/1 effluent TP:
  Process pH must be monitored since high dosages of metal salts can result in depressed  pH values.

5. Impact on sludge settling:
  Extended aeration and oxidation ditch  systems generally are  not preceded  by primary clarification. When
  metal salts are dosed to  or just ahead of secondary clarifiers in these systems, sludge  settling  rates are
  normally enhanced. Polymer addition may also  be necessary, however, to agglomerate fine floe particles.
  Best results are attained when secondary clarifiers are greater than 2.7 m (9 ft) ddep.

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/1  effluent TP:
  Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 20 m3/m2/d (500 gpd/sq ft).
                                                 51

-------
   For 1 mg/l effluent TP:
   Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 24 m3/m2/d (600 gpd/sq ft).

   For 2 mg/l effluent TP:
   Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 32 m3/m2/d (800 gpd/sq ft).

6. Impact on sludge quantities and characteristics:
   Chemicals added to the secondary treatment process will effect an increase in sludge production due to the
   formation of insoluble metal hydroxides and phosphates. Waste secondary  sludge will  contain a higher
   fraction of inert solids than normal.

   For 0.2 mg/1 effluent TP:
   Increases in waste secondary  sludge production greater than 200 percent can be expected due to the
   extremely high dosages of chemicals necessary to achieve this low effluent limit. Actual increases, however,
   will depend on site-specific conditions.

   For 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
   Increases in waste secondary sludge production of 100 to 200  percent have been reported when chemicals
   are added to the secondary treatment process in a plant that does have primary clarifiers. Actual increases,
   however, will depend on site-specific conditions.

   For 1 and 2 mg/l eff TP:
   Increases in waste  secondary sludge  production of 40 to 100 percent  have been  documented  when
   chemicals are added to the secondary  treatment process in a plant that does  not have  primary clarifiers.
   Actual increases, however, will  depend on site-specific conditions.

7. Impact on sludge thickening:
   The increased sludge volumes resulting from chemical phosphorus removal will lead to both higher solids and
   hydraulic loading rates on gravity and flotation thickeners. Thickener design loading rates may, therefore, be
   exceeded in plants that are at or near treatment capacity. Solids capture may decrease when design loading
   rates are exceeded.

8. Impact on sludge handling/disposal facilities:
   The increase in sludge production may cause the design loading rates of sludge handling/disposal facilities to
   be exceeded  if the  plant is at or near treatment capacity. Under these circumstances, sludge disposal
   facilities may  not operate correctly and may need to be reviewed and  upgraded to handle the additional
   quantities and types of sludges generated (e.g., conversion  of low-rate digesters to high-rate digesters  or
   a  two-stage digestion system to a single-stage digestion system).

   For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
   Anaerobic sludge digestion may be inhibited due to the high proportion of chemical sludge resulting from high
   dosages of chemical. Use  of this  method of sludge stabilization should  be avoided, therefore,  if possible,
   where very  low effluent phosphorus is required.

9. Impact on return sludge and sludge handling recycle streams:
   Return activated sludge will contain a higher fraction of inert solids when phosphorus removal chemicals are
   used in the secondary treatment process. As a result, higher return sludge rates will normally be required.

   The concentration of certain constituents in sludge handling recycle streams such as nitrogen, phosphorus,
   and soluble organics may also increase when chemical phosphorus removal  is  imposed on an  existing
   treatment plant. This factor needs to be considered in the overall retrofit design and is particularly important if
   biological reactor capacity is marginal.
                                                  52

-------
10. Impact of wastewater temperature:
   Phosphorus removal performance decreases in cold temperatures due to decreased settleability of chemical
   floes resulting from greater liquid viscosity and density. Increased chemical dosages and polymer use may be
   required.

11. Effluent polishing requirements:

   For 0.2 mg/l effluent TP:
   Tertiary filtration with polish doses of metal salt and polymer to the filter will be necessary.

   For 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
   Tertiary filtration with a polish dose of metal salt to the filter may be necessary.

   For 1 and 2 mg/l effluent TP:
   Effluent polishing should not be necessary.

12. Process flexibility recommendations:
   For 0.2 mg/l effluent TP:
   • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
   • Flow equalization:
   • Polymer addition:
   • Effluent polishing:
necessary
may be required
necessary
necessary
   In addition, pH control instrumentation and dosing of pH neutralizing chemicals may be required.
   For 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
   • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
   • Flow equalization:
   • Polymer addition:
   • Effluent polishing:

   For 1 and 2 mg/l effluent TP:
   • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
   • Flow equalization:
   • Polymer addition:
   • Effluent polishing:
may be required
not required
necessary
may be required
not required
not required
may be required
not required
                                                   53

-------
                                       Design Synopsis 5:
                     Two-Stage Nitrification  Activated Sludge Systems
1. Chemical dose requirements:


   Required Effluent TP
M3+/Influent TP
 Ratio (weight)    Polymer Dose
mg/l
0.2
0.5
1
2

2.0-5.0
1.5-2.0
1.2-1.5
1.0-1.2
mg/l
0.2-1.0
0.1-0.5
0.1-0.2
0.1-0.2
2. Points of metal salt addition:

   For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
   Ahead of either primary or intermediate clarifier with a polish dose to the second-stage nitrification reactor.

   For 1 and 2 mg/l effluent TP:
   Ahead of either primary or intermediate clarifier.

3. Points of polymer addition:

   For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l eff. TP (will be necessary):
   Ahead of either primary or intermediate clarifier with a polish dose to the second-stage nitrification clarifier.

   For 1 and 2 mg/l eff. TP (will be necessary):
   Ahead of either primary or intermediate clarifier.

4. Impact on overall secondary treatment process performance:
   Acidic hydrogen ions are a byproduct  of the nitrification process. Depending on wastewater alkalinity, some
   provision for  pH control may be necssary, therefore, to prevent an unacceptable degree of pH depression
   and subsequent interference with normal metabolic reactions.

   In addition, when  phosphorus removal  chemicals are added to the  secondary treatment process, metal
   phosphate precipitates and other metal ion precipitates are formed and occluded  into the activated sludge
   mass. This contributes an inert fraction to the MLSS, and wasting schedules for control of SRT may have to
   be altered.

   For 0.2 mg/l  effluent TP:
   Process pH must be monitored since high dosages of metal salts can result in depressed pH values.

5. Impact on sludge settling:
   Sludge  settling  rates are normally improved when metal salts  are  added  to primary  and/or secondary
   clarifiers. Polymer addition is sometimes also necessary in conjunction with metal salt addition to aid in solids
   agglomeration and capture and prevent carry-over of inorganic solids to the secondary treatment process or
   fine floe particles to  the final effluent.  Best results are attained when clarifiers are greater than 2.7  m (9 ft)
   deep.

   For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
   Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 20 m3/m2/d (500 gpd/sq ft).

   For 1 mg/l effluent TP:
   Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 24 m3/m2/d (600 gpd/sq ft).
                                                 54

-------
  For 2 mg/I effluent TP:
  Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 32 m-Vm^/d (800 gpd/sq ft).

6. Impact on sludge quantities and characteristics:                                               .
  When  chemicals are added prior to primary clarifiers, sludge  yields will  increase due to the formation of
  insoluble metal hydroxides and the entrapment of BOD and suspended solids onto floes. Primary sludge will,
  therefore, contain a greater amount of organic matter since it is captured with the inorganic floes.

  Solids production also increases when chemicals  are added to the secondary treatment process, but not to
  as great an extent. Waste secondary sludge will contain a higher fraction of inert solids than normal.

  For 0.2 mg/I effluent TP:
  Increases in sludge production greater than 200 percent can be expected due to the extremely high dosages
  of chemicals  necessary to achieve  this low effluent limit. Actual increases, however, will depend  on site-
  specific conditions.

  For 0.5 mg/I effluent TP:
  Increases in sludge  production of 100 to 200 percent have been documented when chemicals are added to
  both  the  primary and  secondary treatment processes. Actual  increases, however,  will depend  on site-
  specific conditions.

   For 1  and 2 mg/I effluent TP:
   Increases  in sludge production of 60 to 100 percent have been  documented  when chemicals are added to
  the primary treatment process, and 40 to 60 percent when chemicals are added to the secondary treatment
   process. Actual increases, however, will depend on site-specific  conditions,

 7. Impact on sludge thickening:
   The increased sludge volumes resulting from chemical phosphorus removal will lead to both higher solids and
   hydraulic loading rates on gravity and flotation thickeners. Thickener design loading rates may, therefore, be
   exceeded in plants that are at or near treatment capacity. Solids  capture may decrease when design loading
   rates are exceeded.

 8. Impact on sludge handling/disposal facilities:
   The increase in sludge production may  cause the design loading  rates of sludge handling/disposal facilities to
   be exceeded if the plant is at  or  near treatment capacity. Under these circumstances,  sludge disposal
   facilities may not operate correctly  and may need to be reviewed and  upgraded to handle the additional
   quantities and types of sludges  generated  (e.g., conversion of  low-rate  digesters to  high-rate  digesters or
   a two-stage  digestion system to a  single-stage digestion system).

   For 0.2 and  0.5 mg/1 effluent TP:
   Anaerobic sludge digestion may be inhibited due to the high proportion of chemical sludge resulting from high
   dosages of chemical. Use of this method of sludge stabilization should be avoided,  therefore, if  possible,
   where very low effluent phosphorus  is required.

 9. Impact on return sludge and sludge handling  recycle streams:
   Return activated sludge will  contain a higher fraction of inert solids when phosphorus removal chemicals are
   used in the secondary treatment process. As a result, higher return sludge rates will normally be required.

   The concentration of certain constituents in sludge handling recycle streams such as nitrogen,  phosphorus,
   and soluble  organics may  also increase  when  chemical  phosphorus removal is imposed on  an existing
   treatment plant. This factor needs to be considered in the overall retrofit design and is particularly important if
   biological reactor capacity is marginal.
                                                   55

-------
10. Impact of wastewater temperature:
   Phosphorus removal performance decreases in cold temperatures due to decreased settleability of chemical
   floes resulting from greater liquid viscosity and density. Increased chemical dosages and polymer use may be
   required.

11. Effluent polishing requirements:

   For 0.2 mg/l effluent TP:
   Metal  salt and  polymer addition  to  the second-stage nitrification reactor and second-stage  nitrification
   clarifior, respectively, will be required. Tertiary filtration will be required.

   For 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
   Metal  salt and  polymer addition  to  the second-stage nitrification reactor and second-stage  nitrification
   clarifier, respectively, will be required. Tertiary filtration may be necessary.

   For 1 and 2 mg/I effluent  TP:
   Effluent polishing should not be necessary.

12. Process flexibility recommendations:
  For 0.2 mg/l effluent TP:
  • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
  • Flow equalization:
  • Polymer addition:
  • Effluent polishing:
necessary
may be required
necessary
necessary
  In addition, pH control instrumentation and dosing of pH neutralizing chemicals may be required.
  For 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
  • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
  • Flow equalization:
  • Polymer addition:
  • Effluent polishing:

  For 1 and 2 mg/l effluent TP:
  • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
  • Flow equalization:
  • Polymer addition*.
  • Effluent polishing:
necessary
may be required
necessary
may be required
recommended
not required
may be required
not required
                                                  56

-------
                                        Design Synopsis 6:
                              High-Rate  Trickling Filter  Systems
1. Chemical dose requirements:


                         M3+/Influent TP
   Required Effluent TP
Ratio (weight)    Polymer Dose
mg/l
0.2
0.5
1
2

2.0-5.0
1.5-2.0
1.2-1.5
1.0-1.2
mg/l
0.2-1.0
0.1-0.5
0.1-0.2
0.1-0.2
2. Points of metal salt addition:

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
  Ahead of both primary and secondary clarifiers, as well as to retrofit bioreactor.

  For 1 mg/l effluent TP:
  Ahead of both primary and secondary clarifiers.

  For 2 mg/l effluent TP:
  Ahead of primary clarifier.

3. Points of polymer addition:

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l eff. TP (will be necessary):
  Ahead of both primary and secondary clarifiers, as well as to retrofit bioreactor.

  For 1  mg/l eff. TP (will be necessary):
  Ahead of both primary and secondary clarifiers.

  For 2  mg/l eff. TP (will be necessary):
  Ahead of primary clarifier.

4. Impact on overall secondary treatment process performance:
  The trickling filter media should be  protected from the effects of metal salts as  much  as possible.  When
  these  chemicals are added to the primary clarifier, inorganic solids may carry over to the tricking filter. This
  may result  in the production of a biofilm with a higher inert  fraction than desirable and  interference with
  normal metabolic reactions. Polymer should be used to minimize the carry-over of inorganic solids from the
  primary clarifier to the trickling filter.

   For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
   Process pH must be monitored since high dosages of metal salts can result in depressed pH values.

5  Impact on sludge settling:
   Sludge settling rates are normally  improved when metal salts  are added to primary and/or  secondary
  clarifiers. Polymer addition is sometimes also necessary in conjunction with metal salt addition to aid in solids
   agglomeration and capture and prevent carry-over of inorganic solids, to the secondary treatment process or
  fine floe particles  to the final effluent.  Best results are attained when clarifiers are greater  than 2.7 m (9 ft)
   deep.

   For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
   Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 20 m3/m2/d (500  gpd/sq ft).

   For 1  mg/l effluent TP:
   Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 24 m3/m2/d (600  gpd/sq ft).
                                                  57

-------
   For 2 mg/I effluent TP:
   Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 32 m3/m2/d (800 gpd/sq ft).

6. Impact on sludge quantities and characteristics:
   When chemicals are added prior to primary clarifiers,  sludge yields will  increase due to  the formation of
   insoluble metal hydroxides and the entrapment of BOD and suspended solids onto floes. Primary sludge will,
   therefore, contain a greater amount of organic matter since it is captured with the inorganic floes.

   Solids production also increases when chemicals are added to the secondary treatment process, but not to
   as great an extent. Waste secondary sludge will contain a higher fraction of inert solids than normal.

   For 0.2 mg/1 effluent TP:
   Increases in sludge production greater than 200 percent can be expected due to the extremely high dosages
   of chemicals necessary  to achieve this low effluent limit. Actual  increases,  however, will  depend on  site-
   specific conditions.

   For 0.5 mg/I effluent TP:
   Increases in sludge production of 100 to 200 percent have been documented when chemicals are added to
   both the  primary  and secondary  treatment  processes.  Actual increases,  however, will depend on  site-
   specific conditions.

   For 1 and 2 mg/l effluent TP:
   Increases in sludge production  of 60 to 100 percent have been documented when chemicals are added to
   the primary treatment process, and 40 to 60 percent when chemicals are added to the secondary treatment
   process. Actual increases, however,  will depend on site-specific conditions.

7. Impact on sludge thickening:
   The increased sludge volumes resulting from chemical phosphorus removal will lead to both higher solids and
   hydraulic loading rates on gravity and flotation thickeners. Thickener  design loading rates may, therefore, be
   exceeded in plants that are at or near treatment capacity. Solids capture may decrease when design loading
   rates are exceeded.

8. Impact on sludge handling/disposal facilities:
   The increase in sludge production may cause the design loading rates of sludge handling/disposal facilities to
   be exceeded  if the plant  is at or near treatment  capacity.  Under these circumstances,  sludge disposal
   facilities may not operate  correctly and may need  to be reviewed  and upgraded to handle the additional
   quantities and types of sludges generated (e.g., conversion of low-rate digesters to high-rate digesters or
   a two-stage digestion system to a single-stage digestion system).

   For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/I effluent TP:
   Anaerobic sludge digestion may be inhibited due to the high proportion of chemical sludge resulting from high
   dosages of chemical. Use of this  method of sludge stabilization should be  avoided, therefore,  if possible,
   where very low effluent phosphorus is required.

9. Impact on return  sludge and sludge handling recycle streams:
   Settled sludge from the secondary  clarifier is normally not returned  to and recycled  through  a high-rate
   trickling filter bioreactor.

   The concentration  of certain constituents in sludge handling recycle  streams  such as nitrogen, phosphorus,
   and soluble organics may increase when chemical  phosphorus removal is imposed on an existing treatment:
   plant. This factor needs to be considered in the overall retrofit design and is particularly important if biological
   reactor capacity is marginal.
                                                  58

-------
to. Impact of wastewater temperature:                                                       «•,'••
   Phosphorus removal performance decreases in cold temperatures due to decreased settleability or cnemicai
   floes resulting from greater liquid viscosity and  density. Increased chemical dosages and polymer use may be
   required.

11. Effluent polishing requirements:

   For 0.2 mg/l effluent TP:
   Construction of a second-stage bioreactor and clarifier, or expansion of the trickling filter system,  as well as
   tertiary filtration will be required. Addition of metal salt and polymer both after the trickling filter and to the
   second-stage bioreactor, if utilized, will also be required.

   For 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
   Construction of a second-stage bioreactor and clarifier, or expansion of the trickling filter system, may be
   required. Addition of metal salt and polymer both after the trickling filter and to the second-stage bioreactor,
   if utilized, may also be required.

   For 1  mg/l effluent TP:
   Addition of metal salt and polymer after the trickling filter will be required.

   For 2.0 mg/l effluent TP:
   Effluent polishing should not be necessary.

12. Process flexibility recommendations:
   For 0.2 mg/l effluent TP:
   • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
   • Flow equalization:
   » Polymer addition:
   • Effluent polishing:
necessary
may be required
necessary
necessary
   In addition, pH control instrumentation and dosing of pH neutralizing chemicals may be required.
   For 0.5 and 1 mg/l effluent TP:
   • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
   • Flow equalization:
   • Polymer addition:
   • Effluent polishing:

   For 2 mg/l effluent TP:
   • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
   • Flow equalization:
   • Polymer addition:
   • Effluent polishing:
necessary
may be required
necessary
may be required
recommended
not required
necessary
not required
                                                    59

-------
                                       Design Synopsis 7:
                           Standard-Rate Trickling  Filter  Systems
1. Chemical dose requirements:


   Required Effluent TP
M3+/infIuentTP
 Ratio (weight)    Polymer Dose
mg/I
0.2
0.5
1
2

2.0-5.0
1.5-2.0
1.2-1.5
1.0-1.2
mg/I
0.2-1.0
0.1-0.5
0.1-0.2
0.1-0.2
2. Points of metal salt addition:

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/I effluent TP:
  Ahead of both primary and secondary clarifiers.

  For 1 and 2 mg/I effluent TP:
  Ahead of primary or secondary clarifier.

3. Points of polymer addition:

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/I eff. TP (will be necessary):
  Ahead of both primary and secondary clarifiers.

  For 1 mg/I eff. TP (will be necessary):
  Ahead of primary or secondary clarifier.

  For 2 mg/I eff. TP (may be necessary):
  Ahead of primary or secondary clarifier.

4. Impact on overall secondary treatment process performance:
  The trickling filter media should be protected from the effects of  metal salts as much as possible. When
  these chemicals are  added to the primary clarifier, inorganic solids  may carry over to the trickling filter. This
  may result in  the production of a biofilm with a higher inert  fraction than desirable and interference with
  normal metabolic reactions.  Polymer should be used to minimize the carry-over of inorganic solids from the
  primary clarifier to the trickling filter.

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/I effluent TP:
  Process pH must be  monitored since high dosages of metal salts can result in depressed pH values.

5. Impact on sludge settling:
  Sludge  settling  rates are normally improved when metal salts are  added to primary and/or secondary
  clarifiers. Polymer addition is sometimes also necessary in conjunction with  metal salt addition to aid in solids
  agglomeration and capture and prevent carry-over of inorganic solids to the secondary treatment process or
  fine floe particles to  the final effluent.  Best results are attained when clarifiers are greater than 2.7 m (9 ft)
  deep.

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/I effluent TP:
  Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 20 m3/m2/d (500 gpd/sq ft).

  For 1 mg/l effluent TP:
  Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 24 m3/m2/d (600 gpd/sq ft).
                                                 60

-------
  For 2 mg/1 effluent TP:
  Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 32 nrvm^/d (800 gpd/sq ft).

6. Impact on sludge quantities and characteristics:
  When  chemicals are added prior to primary clarifiers,  sludge  yields will  increase due to the formation of
  insoluble metal hydroxides and the entrapment of BOD and suspended solids onto floes. Primary  sludge will,
  therefore, contain a greater amount of organic matter since it is captured with the inorganic floes.

  Solids production also increases when chemicals  are added to the secondary treatment process, but not to
  as great an extent. Waste secondary sludge will contain a higher fraction of inert solids than normal.

  For 0.2 mg/1 effluent TP:
  Increases in sludge production greater than 200 percent can be expected due to the extremely high dosages
  of chemicals necessary to achieve this low effluent limit. Actual increases, however, will depend  on site-
  specific conditions.

  For 0.5 mg/1 effluent TP:
  Increases in sludge production  of 100 to 200 percent have been documented when chemicals are added to
  both  the  primary and  secondary treatment processes.  Actual  increases, however,  will depend  on site-
  specific conditions.

  For 1  and 2 mg/1 effluent TP:
  Increases in sludge production of 60 to 100 percent have been documented  when chemicals are added to
  the primary treatment process,  and 40 to 60 percent when chemicals are added to the secondary treatment
  process. Actual increases, however, will depend on site-specific  conditions.

 7. Impact on sludge thickening:
  The increased sludge volumes resulting from chemical phosphorus removal will lead to both higher solids and
   hydraulic loading rates on gravity and flotation thickeners. Thickener design loading rates may, therefore, be
   exceeded in plants that are at or near treatment capacity. Solids capture may decrease when design loading
   rates are exceeded.

 8. Impact on sludge handling/disposal facilities:
   The increase in sludge production may  cause the design loading rates of sludge handling/disposal facilities to
   be exceeded  if the plant is at  or  near treatment capacity. Under these circumstances,  sludge  disposal
   facilities may not operate correctly  and may need to be reviewed and  upgraded to  handle the additional
   quantities  and types of sludges generated  (e.g., conversion of low-rate  digesters to  high-rate digesters or
   a two-stage digestion system  to a single-stage digestion system).

   For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/1 effluent  TP:
   Anaerobic sludge digestion may be inhibited due to the high proportion of chemical sludge resulting from high
   dosages  of chemical. Use of this method of sludge stabilization should be avoided,  therefore, if  possible,
   where very low effluent phosphorus is required.

 9. Impact on return sludge and sludge  handling recycle streams:
   Settled sludge from the secondary clarifier is normally not returned  to and recycled through a standard-rate
   trickling filter bioreactor.

   The concentration of certain constituents in sludge handling recycle streams such as  nitrogen, phosphorus,
   and soluble organics may increase when chemical phosphorus removal is imposed on an existing treatment
   plant. This factor needs to be considered in the overall retrofit design and is particularly important if biological
   reactor capacity is marginal.
                                                   61

-------
10. Impact of wastewater temperature:
   Phosphorus removal performance decreases in cold temperatures due to decreased settleability of chemical
  floes resulting from greater liquid viscosity and density. Increased chemical dosages and polymer use may be
  required.

11. Effluent polishing requirements:

   For 0.2 mg/I effluent TP:
   Polymer addition to the secondary clarifier and tertiary filtration will be required.

   For 0.5 mg/I effluent TP:
   Polymer addition to the secondary clarifier will be required.

   For 1 and 2 mg/1 effluent TP:
   Effluent polishing should not be necessary.

12. Process flexibility recommendations:
  For 0.2 mg/l effluent TP:
  • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
  • Row equalization:
  • Polymer addition:
  • Effluent polishing:
necessary
may be required
necessary
necessary
  In addition, pH control instrumentation and dosing of pH neutralizing chemicals may be required.
  For 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
  • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
  • Flow equalization:
  • Polymer addition:
  • Effluent polishing:

  For 1 and 2 mg/l effluent TP:
  • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
  • Row equalization:
  • Polymer addition:
  • Effluent polishing:
necessary
may be required
necessary
may be required
may be required
not required
necessary
not required
                                                 62

-------
                                       Design Synopsis 8:
                                          RBC Systems
1. Chemical dose requirements:


                        M3+/lnfluentTP
   Required Effluent TP
Ratio (weight)    Polymer Dose
mg/l
0.2
0.5
1
2

2.0-5.0
1.5-2.0
1.2-1.5
1.0-1.2
mg/l
0.2-1.0
0.1-0.5
0.1-0.2
0.1-0.2
2. Points of metal salt addition:

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
  Ahead of both primary and secondary clarifiers.

  For 1 and 2 mg/l effluent TP:
  Ahead of primary or secondary clarifier.

3. Points of polymer addition:

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l eff. TP (will be necessary):
  Ahead of both primary and secondary clarifiers.

  For 1 mg/l eff. TP (will be necessary):
  Ahead of primary or secondary clarifier.

  For 2 mg/l eff. TP (may be necessary):
  Ahead of primary or secondary clarifier.

4. Impact on overall secondary treatment process performance:
  The RBC  media should be protected from  the effects of metal salts as much as  possible. When these
  chemicals are added to the primary clarifier, inorganic solids may carry over to the RBC media. This may
  result in the  production of  a biofilm with a higher inert fraction than desirable and  interference with normal
  metabolic  reactions.  Polymer should be used to minimize the carry-over of inorganic solids from the primary
  clarifier to  the RBC media.

   For 0.2 and  0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
   Process pH must be monitored since high dosages of metal salts can result in depressed pH values.

5. Impact on sludge settling:
   Sludge  settling rates  are  normally  improved when  metal  salts are added to  primary  and/or  secondary
   clarifiers. Polymer addition is sometimes also necessary in conjunction with metal salt addition to aid  in solids
   agglomeration and capture and prevent carry-over of  inorganic solids to the secondary treatment process or
   fine floe particles to the final effluent. Best results are attained when clarifiers are  greater than 2.7 m (9 ft)
   deep.

   For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
   Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 20 m3/m2/d (500 gpd/sq ft).

   For 1 mg/l effluent TP:
   Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 24 m3/m2/d (600 gpd/sq ft).
                                                  63

-------
  For 2 mg/I effluent TP:
  Secondary clarifier overflow rate at peak sustained flow should not exceed 32 m3/m2/d (800 gpd/sq ft).

6. Impact on sludge quantities and characteristics:
  When chemicals are added prior to primary clarifiers,  sludge  yields will  increase due  to the formation  of
  insoluble metal hydroxides and the entrapment of BOD and suspended solids onto floes. Primary sludge will,
  therefore, contain a greater amount of organic matter since it is captured with the inorganic floes.

  Solids production also increases when  chemicals are added to the secondary treatment process, but not to
  as great an extent Waste secondary sludge will contain  a higher fraction of inert solids than normal.

  For 0.2 mg/I effluent TP:
  Increases in sludge production greater than 200 percent can be expected due to the extremely high dosages
  of chemicals necessary  to achieve this low effluent limit. Actual increases, however,  will depend on  site-
  specific conditions.

  For 0.5 mg/I effluent TP:
  Increases in sludge production of 100 to 200 percent have been documented when chemicals are added to
  both  the  primary and secondary  treatment  processes.  Actual increases,  however,  will depend  on  site-
  specific conditions.

  For 1 and 2 mg/1 effluent TP:
  Increases in sludge production  of 60 to 100 percent have been documented when chemicals are added to
  the primary treatment process, and 40  to 60 percent when chemicals are added to the secondary treatment
  process. Actual increases, however, will depend on  site-specific conditions.

7. Impact on sludge thickening:
  The increased sludge volumes resulting from chemical phosphorus removal will  lead to both higher solids and
  hydraulic loading rates on gravity and flotation thickeners. Thickener  design loading rates may, therefore, be
  exceeded in plants that are at or near treatment capacity. Solids capture may decrease when design loading
  rates are exceeded.

8. Impact on sludge handling/disposal facilities:
  The increase in sludge production may  cause the design loading rates of sludge handling/disposal facilities to
  be  exceeded  if the plant is at or near treatment capacity. Under these circumstances,  sludge disposal
  facilities may not operate correctly and may need to  be reviewed  and upgraded to handle the additional
  quantities and  types of sludges generated (e.g., conversion of low-rate digesters to high-rate digesters  or
  a two-stage digestion  system to a single-stage digestion system).

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
  Anaerobic sludge digestion may be inhibited due to the high proportion of chemical sludge resulting from high
  dosages of chemical.  Use  of this  method of sludge stabilization should be avoided,  therefore,  if possible,
  where very low effluent phosphorus is required.

9. Impact on return sludge and sludge  handling recycle streams:
  Settled sludge from  the secondary clarifier is normally not returned to and recycled through an RBC
  bioreactor.

  The concentration of certain constituents in sludge handling recycle  streams such as nitrogen, phosphorus,
  and soluble organics may increase when chemical phosphorus removal is imposed on an existing treatment
  plant. This factor needs to be considered in the overall retrofit design and is particularly important if biological
  reactor capacity is marginal.
                                                  64

-------
to. Impact of wastewater temperature:
   Phosphorus removal performance decreases in cold temperatures due to decreased settleability of chemical
   floes resulting from greater liquid viscosity and density. Increased chemical dosages and polymer use may be
   required.

11. Effluent polishing requirements:

   For 0.2 mg/l effluent TP:
   Polymer addition to the secondary clarifier and tertiary filtration will be required.

   For 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
   Polymer addition to the secondary clarifier will be required.

   For 1 and 2 mg/l effluent TP:
   Effluent polishing should not be necessary.

12. Process flexibility recommendations:
   For 0.2 mg/l effluent TP:
   • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
   • Flow equalization:
   • Polymer addition:
   • Effluent polishing:
necessary
may be required
necessary
necessary
   In addition, pH control instrumentation and dosing of pH neutralizing chemicals may be required.
   For 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
   • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
   9 Flow equalization:
   • Polymer addition:
   • Effluent polishing:

   For 1  and 2 mg/l effluent TP:
   • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
   • Flow equalization:
   • Polymer addition:
   • Effluent polishing:
necessary
may be required
necessary
may be required
may be required
not required
necessary
not required
                                                  65

-------
1. Chemical dose requirements:
                                      Design Synopsis 9:
                                        Lagoon Systems
   Roquirod Effluent TP
M3+/lnfluentTP
 Ratio (weight)    Polymer Dose
mg/l
0.2
0.5
1
2

2.0-5.0
1.5-2.0
1.2-1.5
1.0-1.2
mg/l
0.2-1.0
0.1-0.5
0.1-0.2
0.1-0.2
2. Points of metal salt addition:

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
  Retrofit tertiary chemical treatment system.

  For 1 and 2 mg/I effluent TP:
  Ahead of first and last cells;  if unaerated, provide mixing chamber.

3. Points of polymer addition:

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l eff. TP (may be necessary):
  Retrofit tertiary chemical treatment system.

  For 1 and 2 tng/1 effluent TP:
  Not required.

4. Impact on overall secondary treatment process performance:
  Dosing phosphorus  removal chemicals directly to the lagoon creates the concern of imparting a high  inert
  fraction to the active organisms that may decrease the capability for normal metabolic reactions.

  For 0.2 and 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
  Process pH must be monitored  since high dosages of metal salts can result in depressed pH values.

5. Impact on sludge settling:
  Clarifiers are not normally used  in a lagoon treatment system.

6. Impact on sludge quantities and characteristics:
  Solids separation or effluent clarification is not normally practiced in lagoon treatment systems. If chemicals
  are added directly to the lagoon, it is expected that an accumulation of inert solids would eventually occur
  that may require removal at  some point in time.

7. Impact on sludge thickening:
  Thickeners are  not normally used in conjunction with lagoon treatment systems.

8. Impact on sludge handling/disposal facilities:
  Sludge handling/disposal facilities are not normally necessary for lagoon treatment systems.

9. Impact on return sludge and  sludge handling recycle streams:
  Return sludge and sludge handling recycle streams are not normally a factor in lagoon treatment systems.
                                                66

-------
10. Impact of waste water temperature:
   Phosphorus removal performance decreases in cold temperatures due to decreased settleability of chemical
   floes resulting from greater liquid viscosity and density. Increased chemical dosages and polymer use may be
   required.

11. Effluent polishing requirements:

   For 0.2 mg/l effluent TP:
   Tertiary chemical treatment (consisting of a flocculation tank and a clarifier) and filtration will be necessary.

   For 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
   Tertiary  chemical treatment  (consisting of a  flocculation tank and  a clarifier) and filtration will likely be
   required.

   For 1 and 2 mg/l effluent TP:
   Effluent polishing should not be necessary.
12. Process flexibility recommendations:

   For 0.2 mg/l effluent TP:
   • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
   • Flow equalization:
   • Polymer addition:
   • Effluent polishing:
necessary
not required
may be required
necessary
   In addition, pH control instrumentation and dosing of pH neutralizing chemicals may be required.
   For 0.5 mg/l effluent TP:
   • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
   • Flow equalization:
   • Polymer addition:
   • Effluent polishing:

   For 1 and 2 mgll effluent TP:
   • Multiple metal salt and polymer addition points:
   • Flow equalization:
   • Polymer addition:
   • Effluent polishing:
necessary
not required
may be required
necessary
necessary
not required
not required
not required
                                                   67

-------

-------
                                             Chapters
                         Hardware Design and O&M Considerations for
             Chemical Phosphorus Removal in Small to Medium Plants (< 10 mgd)
 5.1 Introduction

 This  chapter  presents  information  on  the
 characteristics and  properties of chemicals used for
 phosphorus removal,  suppliers  of chemicals to the
 Chesapeake Bay  area, chemical costs  for  the
 Chesapeake Bay area, chemical storage and feeding
 facilities, typical chemical addition system  layouts,
 staffing requirements  and sampling  and analytical
 needs for chemical addition, and  safety  precautions
 and OSHA requirements for chemical addition. This
 information  has  been  derived from  extensive
 experience with the design and operation of chemical
 addition systems  in the  Great  Lakes  region.
 Modifications  have  been  incorporated,  where
 appropriate, to  make the  information relevant to
 treatment plants in the CBDB.

 The intent of this chapter is to assist engineers in the
 CBDB to design efficient site-specific chemical feed
 systems without "reinventing the  wheel." It is also
 anticipated  that  the information contained in  this
 chapter will aid plant operators  in  the  CBDB to
 minimize problems associated with chemical addition
 operational  continuity and  system  maintenance,
 thereby reducing downtime, waste of chemicals,  and
 sludge handling difficulties.


 5.2 Aluminum Compounds
 The  principal  aluminum  compounds  that  are
 commercially available and  suitable  for phosphorus
 precipitation are alum and sodium aluminate. Both are
 available in  either liquid or dry forms. Alum is acidic in
 nature, while sodium aluminate is alkaline. This may
 be  an important factor  in choosing between  them.
 Aluminum chloride  should also be considered and is
 discussed herein.

 5.2.1 Dry Alum

 5.2.1.1 Properties and Availability
The commercial  dry alum most used in wastewater
treatment  has  the  approximate chemical formula
 [Al2(SO4)3«14H20]  and a molecular weight of 594.
The pH varies between 3.0 and 3.5 in aqueous alum
 solutions having concentrations between 1 and  10
 percent.  Commercially available  grades and  their
 corresponding bulk  densities  and angles of repose
 are given in Table 5-1.
Table 5-1.   Available Grades of Dry Alum

 Grade             Bulk Density	Angle of Repose

Lump
Ground
Rice
Powdered
Ib/cu ft
62 -68
60-71
57-61
38 -45
0
varies
43
38
65
Each grade has a minimum aluminum  content of 17
percent, expressed as A^Oa-  This corresponds to a
9-percent  concentration as aluminum.  Viscosity  and
solution crystallization temperatures  are  included in
the subsequent section on liquid alum.

The solubility  of commercial  dry alum  at various
temperatures is listed in Table 5-2.


Table 5-2.   Solubility of Alum at Various Temperatures

       Temperature                Solubility
°F
32
50
68
86
104
Ib/gal
6.03
6.56
7.28
8.45
10.16
Dry alum is not corrosive unless it absorbs moisture
from the air, such as during prolonged  exposure to
humid atmospheres. Therefore, precautions should be
taken to ensure storage space is free of moisture.

Alum is typically shipped in 45-kg (100-lb) bags or
in bulk  (minimum of 18,150 kg or 40,000 Ib) by truck.
                                                69

-------
Bag  shipments may  be ordered on wood pallets.
Information  on  suppliers of  dry  alum to  the
Chesapeake Bay  area is given in Table 5-3.

5.2.1.2 General Design Considerations
Utilities usually use ground and rice alum because of
their superior flow characteristics. These grades have
less tendency to  lump  or arch  in storage and,
therefore, provide more consistent  feeding qualities.
Hopper  agitation is  seldom  required  with  these
grades, and, in fact, may be detrimental to feeding by
causing packing of the contents of the bin.

Alum dust is  present in the ground grade and will
cause minor irritation of eyes and respiratory tract. A
respirator will protect against  alum  dust.  Alum dust
should   be thoroughly  flushed  from  the  eyes
immediately and  washed  from the  skin with  water.
Gloves should be worn to protect the hands. Because
of minor irritation in  handling and  the  possibility  of
alum dust causing rusting of adjacent machinery, dust
removal  equipment is desirable.

5.2.1.3 Storage
A typical storage and feeding  system for dry alum is
shown in  Figure  5-1. Bulk alum can  be stored  in
mild steel or concrete bins with  dust collector vents
located in, above, or adjacent to the equipment room.
Recommended storage capacity is about 30 days.
Dry alum in  bulk can be transferred  with  screw
conveyors, pneumatic conveyors, or bucket elevators
made  of  mild steel.  Pneumatic conveyor  elbows
should   have a  reinforced backing to  withstand
abrasion.

Bags and drums  of alum  should be stored in a dry
location. Bag or drum  loaded hoppers should have
storage  capacity  for 8 hours at the  nominal maximum
feed rate so personnel are not required  to charge the
hopper more than once per shift. Converging  hopper
sections should have a minimum wall slope of 60° to
prevent  arching.

 Bulk storage hoppers  should  have a discharge bin
gate so feeding  equipment  may be  isolated for
servicing. The  bin  gate  should be followed by  a
flexible connection and a  transition  hopper chute or a
 hopper  that acts as a conditioning  chamber over the
 feeder.

 5.2,1.4 Feeding Equipment
 The feed system includes all components required for
 preparation of the chemical solution. Capacities and
 configurations should be selected  to fulfill individual
 system  requirements. Three basic types  of chemical
 feed equipment are used: volumetric, belt gravimetric,
 and loss-in-weight gravimetric.  Volumetric  feeders
 are usually  used where  low initial cost and lower
 delivery  capacities are the  basis of  selection.
 Volumetric feeder mechanisms are  usually exposed to
 corrosive vapors from  the  dissolving chamber.
Manufacturers normally control this problem by use of
an electric heater to keep the feeder housing dry or
by using plastic components in the exposed areas.

Volumetric  dry  feeders are  generally of the screw
type.  Two  designs of screw feed  mechanism  are
available.  Both allow  even  withdrawal  across  the
bottom of the feeder hopper to  prevent  dead zones.
One screw design is the variable pitch type  with the
pitch  expanding  evenly to the discharge point. The
second  screw  design  is  the constant pitch-
reciprocating type. This  type has each  half of the
screw turned in opposite directions so the turning and
reciprocating motion  alternately fills one half of the
screw while the other half is discharging. The variable
pitch  screw  has  one  point  of  discharge, while the
constant pitch-reciprocating screw has two points of
discharge,  one at each end  of the  screw. The
accuracy of  volumetric feeders is influenced by the
character of material being fed and ranges between 1
percent for  free-flowing  materials to 7  percent  for
cohesive materials. This accuracy is volumetric and is
not related to accuracy by weight (gravimetric).

Where the  greatest accuracy and more economical
use of chemical  is desired, the loss-in- weight type
feeder should be selected.  This feeder  is  suited  to
low and  medium feed  rates with  a maximum  of
approximately 1,500 kg (4,000 lb)/h.  The unit consists
of a material hopper and feeding mechanism mounted
on enclosed scales. Continuous comparison of actual
hopper  weight with   set hopper weight  prevents
cumulative  errors. Accuracy of the loss-in-weight
feeder is near 1  percent by weight of the set rate.

 Belt-type  gravimetric feeders  span  the  capacity
 ranges  of  volumetric and loss-in-weight feeders
 and can be sized for  most applications in watewater
 treatment. Initial  expense falls  between that for the
 volumetric  feeder and the loss-in-weight feeder.
 Belt-type gravimetric  feeders consist of a basic belt
 feeder incorporating a weighing and  control system.
 Feed rates  can be  varied by  changing either  the
 weight per unit length of belt,  belt speed, or both.
 Controllers in general use are mechanical, pneumatic,
 electric,  and  mechanical-vibrating.  Accuracy
 specified for belt-type gravimetric feeders  should  be
 within 1  percent of  the set rate.  This equipment
 normally  includes mild steel hoppers, stainless  steel
 mechanism components, and  rubber surfaced  feed
 belts.

 Because alum  solution is  corrosive,  dissolving  or
 solution chambers should be constructed of type 316
 stainless steel,  fiberglass reinforced plastic  (FRP), or
 plastics   (polyvinyl  chloride,  polyethylene,
 polypropylene, and   similar materials). Dissolvers
 should be sized for preparation of the desired solution
 strength. The most  dilute  solution strength  usually
 recommended  is 0.06  kg  of  alum/I (0.5  Ib/gal)  of
 water,  or  a  6-percent solution.  The dissolving
                                                   70

-------
Table 5-3.   Dry Alum Suppliers to the Chesapeake Bay Area

 Name _         .  Address
                                                        Telephone
                                                                                  1986 Price Quotations*
  Manley-Regan Chemicals
  Delta Chemicals
  Coyne Chemicals
                         East Emmaus Street
                         P. O. Box 391
                         Middletown, PA 17057


                         12601 Cannery Avenue
                         Baltimore, MD 21226
                         3015 State Road
                         Croyden, PA 19020
                                                      (717)994-7471
                                                      (301)354-0100
                                                      (215) 785-3000
100-lb bags:
   20 bags-$16.75/100 Ib
   50 bags - $15.50/100 Ib
   100 bags-$14.90/100 Ib
100-lb bags:
   400 bags (minimum order)
   $185/ton ($9.25/100 Ib)
40,000-lb hopper truck:
   $165/ton ($8.25/100 Ib)
100-Jb bags:
   100 bags-$14.60/100 Ib
   240 bags - $12.10/100 Ib

40,000-lb hopper truck:
   $242Aon ($12.10/100 Ib)
   1 Call for applicable freight charges, if any. Generally, prices include freight up to varying distances from the point of manufacture.
 chamber is designed for a minimum detention time of
 5  minutes  at the maximum feed rate.  Because
 excessive dilution  may be detrimental to coagulation,
 eductors or float valves that would ordinarily be used
 ahead  of centrifugal pumps are  not  recommended.
 Dissolvers should be equipped with water meters and
 mechanical  mixers so  the water-to-alum  ratio may
 be properly established and controlled.


 5.2.1.5 Piping and Accessories
 Pipe made FRP or plastic is recommended for alum
 solution.  Care  must be taken to provide  adequate
 support for these piping systems,  with close attention
 given to  spans between supports  so objectionable
 deflection will not occur. Lined steel pipe is generally
 tougher and more rigid, but  the  cost of providing a
 near perfect lining may detract from its suitability.

 Solution flow by gravity to the point of discharge  is
 desirable. When pumping  is  necessary, little  or  no
 dilution  is  required.  When  metering pumps  or
 proportioning  weir  tanks are  used, return  of excess
 flow to a  holding tank'should be considered. Metering
 pumps are discussed in the section on liquid alum.

 Valves  used in solution  lines should be plastic, type
 316 stainless steel, or rubber-lined iron or steel.

 5.2.1.6 Pacing and Control
 Volumetric  and gravimetric  feeders  are  usually
 adaptable to operation from any standard instrument
 control  and pacing signals. When solution  must be
 pumped, consideration should  be  given to the use of
 holding  tanks  between the dry feed system and feed
 pumps; solution water supply should be controlled to
 prevent excessive  dilution. The dry feeders may be
 started and stopped from tank level probes. Variable
control  metering pumps  can  transfer alum  stock
solution to  the point  of application without further
dilution.
                                                      Means should be provided for calibration of chemical
                                                      feeders.  Volumetric feeders may  be  mounted  on
                                                      platform scales. Belt feeders should include a sample
                                                      chute  and  box to check actual delivery  with  set
                                                      delivery.

                                                      Gravimetric  feeders  are  usually  furnished  with
                                                      totalizers only. Remote instrumentation is frequently
                                                      used  with  gravimetric equipment,  but seldom used
                                                      with volumetric equipment.

                                                      5.2.2 Liquid Alum

                                                      5.2.2.1 Properties and Availability
                                                      Liquid  alum  is  shipped  in  insulated  tank  cars  or
                                                      trucks.  During  the winter,  it is  heated  prior  to
                                                      shipment  so  crystallization  will  not  occur during
                                                      transit. Liquid alum is shipped at a solution strength of
                                                      about 4.37 percent as aluminum, about 8.3 percent
                                                      as AI2O3,  or 49 percent as A12(SO4)3»14H2O. This
                                                      solution has  a density of  1.33 kg/I  (11.1  Ib/gal)  at
                                                      60 °F and  contains  about  0.65 kg of dry alum/I  (5.4
                                                      Ib/gal) of liquid, or 17 percent A^Oa. This solution will
                                                      begin to crystallize at 30°F and crystallizes at 18°F.

                                                      Crystallization  temperatures  of  other  solution
                                                      strengths are  given in Table 5-4.  The viscosity  of
                                                      various alum solutions  is given in Figure 5-2.

                                                      Liquid alum is typically  delivered  in truck lots  of
                                                      11,400 to  18,900 I  (3,000 to 5,000  gal). Information
                                                      on suppliers of liquid alum to  the  Chesapeake Bay
                                                      area is presented in Table 5-5.

                                                      Since  liquid alum  is  an intermediate compound  in
                                                      production of dry alum, the  liquid  form costs less.
                                                      However,  liquid alum costs more to transport since it
                                                      is nearly  half  water by  weight.  Therefore,  a  cost
                                                      tradeoff point  can be  established  when exact
                                                      chemical costs and local freight rates are determined.
                                                      Liquid  alum will generally  be more economical  than
                                                   71

-------
Figure 5-1.  Dry feed system alternatives.
  Dust
Collector
               Fill  Pipe
              (Pneumatic)
                                                                                        Dust
                                                                                       Collector
                                                                             Screen
                                                                              with
                                                                             Breaker
                              Flexible
                             Connection
                                                                                                  Bag
                                                                                                  /Fill
                                                                                          Day Hopper for
                                                                                          Dry Chemical
                                                                                            from Bags
                                                                                            or Drums
                                                                                          LL
                                        Alternative Supplies Depending on Storage
                                                                                              JU
                                  Control Solenoid
                                  Valve    Valve
                              Water
                              Supply
                                                                                  Pump to. Application
                                                                                  ___€>
 dry alum if the point of use is within 100 miles of the
 manufacturing plant; ease of handling,  storing,  and
 feeding liquid alum  extend its practical transport limit
 to 200 miles or more.

 5.2.2.2 General Design Considerations
 Bulk unloading facilities usually must be  provided at
 the  treatment   plant.  Railroad  tank  cars  are
 constructed  for top unloading and, therefore, require
 an  air supply system  and  flexible connectors to
 pneumatically displace the alum from the  car. U.S.
 Department  of Transportation regulations concerning
 chemical tank car unloading  should  be observed.
 Tank truck  unloading is usually  accomplished by
 gravity or by a truck-mounted  pump.

  No  particular industrial hazards are encountered  in
  handling liquid alum.  However, a  face  shield  and
 gloves should  be  worn  around  leaking equipment.
                                                    The eyes or skin should be flushed and washed upon
                                                    contact with  liquid alum.  Liquid alum becomes  very
                                                    slick upon evaporation, and, therefore, spillage should
                                                    be avoided.

                                                    5.2.2.3 Storage
                                                    Liquid alum is stored without dilution  at the shipping
                                                    concentration. Storage tanks may be open if indoors,
                                                    but must be closed  and vented if outdoors. Outdoor
                                                    tanks  should also be heated, if necessary, to  keep
                                                    the temperature above 25° F to prevent crystallization.
                                                    Storage  tanks  should  be constructed  of  type 316
                                                    stainless steel, FRP, steel lined with rubber, polyvinyl
                                                    chloride, or lead; see subsequent  section for details.
                                                    Liquid  alum  can  be  stored  indefinitely without
                                                    deterioration.

                                                    Storage tanks should be sized according to maximum
                                                    feed  rate, shipping  time  required,  and quantity of
                                                     72

-------
 Table 5-4.   Crystallization Temperatures of Liquid Alum

                           Temperature of Crystallization
percent
5.19
6.42
6.67
6.91
7.16
7.40
7.66
7.92
8.19
8.46
8.74
°F
26
21
19
17
15
13
12
14
17
20
28
 shipment. Tanks should generally be sized for 1-1/2
 times  the quantity  of  shipments. A 10-day  to  2-
 week  supply should  be  provided to  allow  for
 unforeseen snipping delays.

 5.2.2.4 Feeding Equipment
 Various  types of gravity or  pressure  feeding and
 metering  units are  available. Figures 5-3  and 5-4
 illustrate  commonly-used  feed  systems.  The
 rotodip-type  feeder  or  rotameter is  often  used  for
 gravity feed and the metering pump for pressure feed
 systems.

 The pressure or  head  available at the  point  of
 application frequently determines the  feeding system
 to be used. The rotodip feeder can be supplied from
 overhead storage by gravity with  the  use  of  an
 internal level  control valve,  as shown in Figure 5-3.
 It  may also be supplied by a centrifugal pump. The
 latter arrangement requires an excess flow return line
 to  the storage  tank, as indicated  in Figure 5-4.
 Centrifugal pumps should be  direct-connected but
 not close-coupled because  of possible leakage into
 the motor, and  should  be constructed of type 316
 stainless steel, FRP, or plastic.

 Metering pumps currently available allow a wide range
 of capacity compared with the rotodip and rotameter
 systems. Hydraulic diaphragm-type  pumps are
 preferable to other type pumps and  should  be
 protected with an internal or external relief valve.  A
 backpressure  valve  is usually required in the pump
 discharge to  provide efficient  check  valve action.
 Materials of  construction for  feeding  equipment
 should be as  recommended by  the manufacturer for
the service but, depending on the type of system, will
generally  include  type 316 stainless  steel,  FRP,
plastics, and rubbber.

5.2.2.5 Piping and Accessories
Piping  systems for liquid alum should  be constructed
of  FRP, plastics (subject to  temperature limits), type
 316 stainless steel, or lead. Piping and valves used
 for alum solutions are also discussed in the preceding
 section on dry alum.

 5.2.2.6 Pacing and Control
 The feeding systems described above  are volumetric,
 and the feeders generally available  can be adapted to
 receive standard  instrument  pacing  signals. The
 signals can  be  used to vary motor speed, variable-
 speed transmission setting, stroke  speed, and  stroke
 length,  where  applicable.  A totalizer  is  usually
 furnished  with  a  rotodip feeder,   and  remote
 instruments  are  available.  Instrumentation  is  rarely
 used with rotameters and metering pumps.

 5.2.3 Dry Sodium Aluminate

 5.2.3.1 Properties and Availability
 Dry sodium  aluminate, Na2Al2O4,  is shipped  in 23-
 kg (50-lb) bags  and has a bulk density ranging from
 640 to 800 kg/m.3  (40 to 50 Ib/cu ft). The  AI2C>3
 content ranges  from 41 to 46 percent. Dry sodium
 aluminate is noncorrosive,  and the  pH  of a 1-percent
 solution  is  about  11.9.  Manufacturers should be
 consulted for more precise specifications of their
 product.

 Dry sodium aluminate is available in the Chesapeake
 Bay area from the supplier listed in Table 5-6.

 5.2.3.2 General  Design Considerations
 Requirements for dry sodium aluminate feed systems
 are  generally similar  to  those  for dry aluminum
 sulfate. Dry sodium aluminate is not available in bulk
 quantities.  Therefore,  the  small,  day-type  hoppers
 with manual  filling arrangements as shown in Figure
 5-1 are  used. Precautionary measures for  handling
 sodium aluminate are  similar to  those for strong
 alkalies,  such as caustic  soda.  Contact with  skin,
 eyes, and clothing should be avoided. Aluminate dust
 or solution spray should not be breathed.

 5.2.3.3 Storage
 Dry sodium  aluminate is stored as received, in  bags,
 and  at optimum  conditions of  60 to 90°F; the
 recommended storage  limit is 6  months.  Hopper
 material of  mild  steel  is completely adequate.  This
 chemical may or may not be free flowing, depending
 on  the  manufacturer and  grade  used. Therefore,
 hopper agitation  may be required.  Sodium aluminate
 deteriorates  on exposure to the atmosphere, and care
 should be taken to avoid tearing of bags.

 5.2.3.4 Feeding  Equipment
 Materials of construction for dissolving chambers may
be mild steel or stainless steel, and  selection may be
influenced by conformity  with adjacent equipment.
Equipment  similar to that  shown  in Figure  5-1 is
applicable.  Standard practice for  the free-flowing
grade of sodium aluminate calls for dissolvers  sized
for  0.06 kg/I (0.5  Ib/gal)  or  6-percent  solution
                                                  73

-------
Flflure 5-2.   Viscosity of alum solutions (courtesy of Allied Chemical Co.).
                0.1
                   30
                   100

                    Temperature, °F
                                                                     150
                                                                                                    220
 Table 5-5.   Liquid Alum Suppliers to the Chesapeake Bay Area
  Name                      	Address	Telephone
                                                           1986 Price Quotations*
  Mantoy-Rogan Chemicals




  Delta Chemicals

  Coyne Chemicals
East Emmaus Street
P. O. Box 391
Middleton, PA 17057
12601 Cannery Avenue
Baltimore, MD 21226
3015 State Road
Croyden, PA 19020
(717)944-7471          $l45/ton of dry alum.
                      A 4,600-gal tank truck contains 25,000
                      Ib(i2.5 ton) of dry alum.
                      Cost per truck - $1,813.
                      Cost per gal - $0.40
(301) 354-0100          $l45/ton of dry alum.

(215) 785-3000          $l33/ton of dry alum.
    Call for applicable freight charges, if any. Generally, prices include freight up to varying distances from the point of manufacture.
  strength with a dissolver detention time  of 5 minutes
  at the maximum feed rate.

  After  dissolving  dry  sodium  aluminate in  the
  preparation  of batch  solutions, agitation  should  be
                                minimized or eliminated to prevent deterioration of the
                                solution.  Air  agitation  is  not recommended,  and
                                solution  tanks  should  be  covered  to  prevent
                                carbonation  of the solution.
                                                          74

-------
 Figure 5-3.  Liquid chemical feed system alternatives  for
            elevated storage.
 Figure 5-4.  Liquid chemical feed  system  alternatives  for
            ground storage.
        Elevated
        Chemical
        Storage
        Tank
                                         (gravity  ±
                                         feed)    T
                         Rotary Dipper Feeder

                    a. Rotary dipper feeder


Recirculation
Ground
Chemical
Storage
Tank

JS

r

.
Rotary Dipper
Feeder

To Process
(gravity
feed)
                                                                           a. Rotary dipper feeder
        Elevated
        Chemical
        Storage
        Tank
           Rotameter (or mag meter)
Control
Valve
l_I>s<-l
t->vl

To Process
(gravity |
feed)
                Rotameter (or Mag Meter)

                   b. Rotameter with control valve
                                     Control
                                     Valve
                                 I—Xh-
To Process
(pressure
feed)
Elevated
Chemical
Storage
Tank




Relief
Valve
X Back
T Valve
1 i^, ^i
(*3 ^
v .TV





Pressure
To Procesd
(pressure ±
fp,aH\ T
                   Centrifugal Feed Pump

      b.  Centrifugal pump with rotameter and control valve
                                                                                      Relief
                                                                                      Valve
                     Metering Pump
                   c. Metering pump
Ground
Chemical
Storage
Tank
,
i
_IS)
M t ' D

c. Metering pump
Back Pressure A
Valve
To Process
(pressure
feed)

5.2.3.5 Piping and Accessories
Materials for piping  and  transporting  dry  sodium
aluminate solution may be mild steel, iron, type 304
stainless  steel, concrete,  or plastics.  The  use  of
copper, copper alloys, and rubber should be avoided.
5.2.3.6 Pacing and Control
Pacing and control fundamentals are similar to those
described for dry alum. The amount of dilution is not
a  consideration  in  the  use of  sodium aluminate.
Therefore, the use of float valves to satisfy centrifugal
pump suction  and  the  use  of  eductors  are
permissible.
5.2.4 Liquid Sodium Aluminate

5.2.4.1 Properties and Availability
Liquid  sodium  aluminate  is  available  in  the
Chesapeake Bay area  from the  suppliers  listed  in
Table 5-7.  There  is  considerable  variety in the
composition  of liquid  sodium-aluminate  from the
manufacturers  listed. The A^Oa content varies from
4.9 to 26.7 percent. The lower solution strengths are
usually  more  expensive because  of  the cost  of
transporting the solution water. Because of the variety
of solution strengths available, the manufacturers
should be  contacted for more specific information on
density, viscosity, and cost. Liquid sodium  aluminate
                                                    75

-------
Tablo 5-6.    Dry Sodium Alumlnate Supplier to the Chesapeake Bay Area

 Name                    	Address	Telephone
                                                        1986 Price Quotations
 Nalco Chemical
170 Forbes Road
Braintree, MA 02184
                                                      (617) 944-7471
                      50-lb bags:
                         120 bags or less - $0.50/lb
                         > 120 bags - $0.45/lb
                      Freight not included.
Table 5-7.    Liquid Sodium Aluminate Suppliers to the Chesapeake Bay Area

 Name                            Address	Telephone
                                                       1986 Price Quotations*
 Nalco Chemical
2901 Butterfield Road
Oak Brook, IL 60521
 Vinings Chemicals
 Coyno Chemicals
P. O. Box 773
Richboro. PA 18954
3015 State Road
Croyden, PA 19020
(312) 887-7500        Nalco " 1" (12.8 Ib/gal):
                       12-59 30-gal drums - $0.45/lb
                       > 59 30-gal drums - $0.36/lb
                       Bulk, 3,000-gal tank truck - $0.20/lb
                    Nalco "2" (12.1 Ib/gal):
                       12-59 30-gal drums - $0.38/lb
                       >59 30-gal drums - $0.34/lb
                       Bulk, 3,000-gal tank truck - $0.l8/lb

(215) 322-5871        Vinings "45":
                       $0.20/lb in drums
                       $0.l4/lb in tank trucks
                    Vinings "38":
                       $0.i95/lb in drums
                       $0.135/lb in tank trucks
(215) 785-3000        Vinings "38":
                       $0.l65/lb in tank trucks
                    (Coyne does not supply Vinings "45" due to
                    freezing problems.)
  " Call (or applicable freight charges, if any. Generally, prices include freight up to varying distances from the point of manufacture.
 is  typically  available  in  114-1 (30-gal) drums  and
 11,400-1  (3,000-gal)  tank trucks.

 5.2.4.2 General Design Considerations
 Because  of  the  alkaline  nature  of  liquid  sodium
 aluminate, it should not be used in contact with brass,
 copper, aluminum, or rubber. Liquid sodium aluminate
 is a strong alkali, and the same precautions should be
 exercised in handling it as in handling caustic soda.

 5.2.4.3 Storage
 Liquid sodium aluminate is  usually  stored at  the
 shipping concentration, either in the shipping drums
 or in  mild steel tanks.  Storage tanks may be located
 indoors or outdoors; however, outdoor tanks should
 be  provided with facilities for indirect  heating. The
 maximum recommended length of storage is 2 to 3
 months. Bulk shipments can be  unloaded by gravity,
 pumping, or air  pressure.  If air  is used,  however, it
 should  first  be  passed through lime-caustic soda
 breathers to remove carbon  dioxide.  To  avoid this,
 some treatment  plants do  not allow shipments to be
 air unloaded. Steam injection  facilities are required at
 the unloading site.

 5,2.4.4 Feeding Equipment
 Feeding  equipment  and  systems as  described  for
 liquid alum generally apply to liquid sodium aluminate
                               except  with  changes  of  requirements  regarding
                               dilution  and materials of construction as described
                               above.

                               Liquid  sodium  aluminate may be  fed  at shipping
                               strength  or diluted  to  a stable 5-  to  10-percent
                               solution.  Stable solutions  are prepared  by  direct
                               addition of low  hardness water and  mild agitation. Air
                               agitation is not recommended.

                               5.2.4.5 Piping and Accessories
                               Piping requirements are  the  same  as  previously
                               indicated for solutions of dry sodium aluminate.

                               5.2.4.6 Pacing and  Control
                               System pacing and control  requirements  are  the
                               same as described for liquid alum.

                               5.2.5 Aluminum Chloride
                               Aluminum chloride is available in the Chesapeake Bay
                               area from the supplier listed in Table 5-8.

                               Much of  the aluminum  chloride  produced is in  the
                               form  of  semi-pure  anhydrous crystals  with  an  off-
                               white color.  This  product is derived  from direct
                               chlorination of  scrap aluminum and has  a molecular
                               weight of  133.3 and purities near 99 percent. In some
                               instances, purities may  drop to 96 percent, which  is
                                                      76

-------
Table 5-8.    Aluminum Chloride Supplier to the Chesapeake Bay Area

 Name	Address	Telephone
                                                       1986 Price Quotations*
 Pearsall Chemical
 Div. of Witco Corp.
P. O. Box 42817
Houston, TX 77242
(800)231-3452         Bulk:
                       40,000 Ib - $0.48/lb delivered

                     50-lb bags:
                       < 100 bags-$0.61/Ib
                       100-479 bags - $0.60/lb
                          FOB Philipsburg, NJ

                       >479 bags - $0.59/lb delivered
  * Call for applicable freight charges, if any. Generally, prices include freight up to varying distances from the point of manufacture.
satisfactory  for wastewater  treatment if analysis
shows  other  compounds  present are  acceptable.
Another solid  form is produced by crystallization from
hydrochloric  acid in the form of a hexahydrate,  in
which six molecules of water attach to each molecule
of aluminum chloride.

Containers for shipping and storing should be similar
to those used for dry and  liquid  alum. Handling and
feeding requirements  are also similar to those  used
with  alum.  Designers  should  check  with  local
producers for further details.


5.3 Iron Compounds
The principal  iron compounds that are  commercially
available  and suitable  for  phosphorus   precipitation
are liquid ferric chloride, ferrous chloride (waste pickle
liquor), ferric sulfate, and ferrous sulfate.

5.3.7 Liquid Ferric Chloride

5.3.1.1 Properties and Availability
Liquid ferric chloride is a corrosive, dark brown, oily-
appearing solution having a typical  unit  weight
between 1.3 and 1.5 kg/I (11.2 and 12.4 Ib/gal), or 35
to 45 percent FeCla.  The  ferric  chloride content of
these solutions is 0.47 to 0.67  kg/I (3.95  to  5.58
Ib/gal). Shipping concentrations vary from summer to
winter  due  to the  relatively high  crystallization
temperature  of the  more  concentrated solutions  as
shown  in Figure 5-5.  The   pH  of a  1-percent
solution is 2.0.

The  molecular  weight of  ferric  chloride is 162.22.
Viscosities of ferric chloride  solutions  at various
temperatures  are presented in Figure 5-6.

Liquid ferric  chloride is  shipped in  11,400-  to
15,100-1 (3000-  to  4,000-ga!) bulk truckload  lots.
Information on suppliers of  liquid ferric chloride to the
Chesapeake  Bay area are provided in Table 5-9.

Tank trucks are normally unloaded pneumatically, and
operating  procedures  must be closely  followed  to
avoid spills and accidents.  The safety vent cap and
assembly (painted  red) should be removed prior to
                             Figure 5-5.  Freezing point  curve  for commercial  ferric
                                        chloride solutions.
                               Temperature, °F

                                  80 i—


                                  60


                                  40


                                  20
                                  -20
                            Water Utility Grade
                                 -40
                                                  I
                                   J
                                      20         30           40

                                               Percent by Weight in Water
                                                 50
                             opening the unloading connection to depressurize the
                             tank truck.

                             5.3.1.2 General Design Consideration
                             Ferric  chloride solutions are  corrosive  to  many
                             common materials and cause stains that are difficult
                             to remove. Areas  subject  to  staining should  be
                             protected  with resistant paint or rubber mats.

                             Normal precautions  should  be  employed  when
                             cleaning ferric chloride handling equipment. Workmen
                             should wear rubber gloves, a  rubber apron,, and
                             goggles or a face shield. If  ferric chloride  comes in
                             contact with the eyes or skin, flush with copious
                             quantities  of running water  and call  a physician.  If
                             ferric chloride is ingested, induce vomiting and  call a
                             physician.

                             5.3.1.3 Storage
                             Ferric  chloride solution can be stored as  shipped.
                             Storage tanks  should have  a  free  vent or vacuum
                             relief valve.  Tanks  may be constructed  of  FRP,
                                                    77

-------
Figure 5-6.  Viscosity vs. composition of ferric chloride solutions at various temperatures.
   100i

    80

    60

    50

    40


    30



    20


|   15



«   10

>     8


I     6
£
                1
                               (Absolute Viscosity) =  (Kinematic Viscosity) x (Density)

                                      Centipoises =  Centistokes x Gm/cc
                              I^.-*T
                                         10
                                                     20
                                                30

                                          i, percent
                                                                            40
                                                                                        50
 Table 5-9.    Liquid Ferric Chloride Suppliers to the Chesapeake Bay Area
  Name                             Address	     Telephone
                                                                       1986 Price Quotations"
  Mantoy-Rogan Chemicals
  Coyne Chemicals
            East Emmaus Street
            P. O. Box 391
            Middletown, PA 17057
            3015 State Road
            Croyden, PA 19020
(717)994-7471          $235/ton
                      A 4,600-gal tank truck contains 17,204
                      Ib of Fe3 + (@ 3.74 Ib/gal). Tank Truck is,
                      therefore, $235/ton x 8.6 tons * 4,600
                      gal  = $0.44/gal.
(215) 785-3000          32-percent Fea+ - $222/dry ton.
    Call for applicable freight charges, if any. Generally, prices include freight up to varying distances from the point of manufacture.
 rubber-lined  steel,  or  plastic-lined  steel.  Resin
 impregnated  carbon  or graphite  are  also  suitable
 materials for storage containers.

 It may be necessary in most instances to house liquid
 ferric chloride tanks in  heated areas or provide tank
                                            heaters or insulation to prevent crystallization.  Ferric
                                            chloride can be stored for long periods of time without
                                            deterioration. The total storage  capacity  should  be
                                            1-1/2 times the  largest anticipated shipment  and
                                            should  provide at least  a  10-day to 2-week  supply
                                            of the chemical at the design average dose.
                                                         78

-------
 15.3.1.4 Feeding Equipment
 Feeding equipment and systems described for liquid
 alum  generally apply  to  ferric  chloride  except for
 materials of construction  and the use of glass tube
 rotameters.

 It may not be  desirable to dilute the ferric chloride
 solution from its shipping concentration to a weaker
 feed solution because of possible hydrolysis.  Ferric
 chloride  solutions  may  be   transferred  from
 underground  storage to day  tanks with  impervious
 graphite  or  rubber-lined,  self-priming  centrifugal
 pumps having  Teflon  rotary  and  stationary seals.
 Because  of a tendency for liquid ferric  chloride to
 stain or deposit, glass tube  rotameters should not be
 used for metering  this solution.  Rotodip feeders  and
 diaphragm metering  pumps are  often used for ferric
 chloride and should be constructed of materials such
 as rubber-lined steel and  plastics.

 5.3.1.5 Piping and Accessories
 Materials  for  piping  and  transporting ferric  chloride
 should be rubber  or Saran-lined steel,  hard rubber,
 FRP,  or plastics.  Valving should  consist  of rubber-
 or  resin-lined diaphragm  valves,  Saran-lined valves
 with Teflon diaphragms,  rubber  sleeved  pinch-type
 valves, or plastic ball valves. Gasket material for large
 openings  such as  manholes in storage tanks should
 be soft rubber;  all  other gaskets  should be graphite-
 impregnated blue asbestos, Teflon, or vinyl.

 5.3.1.6 Pacing and Control
 System pacing and control requirements are similar to
 those discussed previously for liquid alum.

 5.3.2 Ferrous Chloride (Waste Pickle Liquor)

 5.3.2.1 Properties  and Availability
 Ferrous chloride, FeCIa, is available as a liquid in  the
 form of waste pickle liquor from steel processing. The
 liquor weighs between 1.2 and 1.3 kg/I (9.9 and 10.4
 Ib/gal)  and contains 20 to 25 percent ferrous chloride
 or about  10  percent available  iron.  A  22-percent
 solution of ferrous  chloride  will  crystallize  at a
 temperature of  -4°F.  The molecular  weight of
 ferrous chloride is  126.76. Free acid in waste pickle
 liquor  can vary from 1 to  10 percent and usually
 averages about 1.0 to 1.5 percent.  Ferrous chloride is
 slightly less corrosive than  ferric chloride.

 Ferrous chloride is available in the Chesapeake  Bay
area in 15,100-1 (4000-gal)  truckload lots  from the
supplier listed in Table 5-10.

5.3.2.2 General Design Considerations
Since ferrous chloride or waste pickle  liquor may not
be  available  on  a continuous basis,  storage and
feeding equipment should  be suitable for  handling
ferric chloride.  Therefore,  the  ferric chloride  section
should be referred to for storage and handling details.
 5.3.3 Ferric Sulfate

 5.3.3.1 Properties and Availability
 Ferric sulfate, Fe2(SO4)3«H2O, is marketed as a dry,
 partially  hydrated  product  with  seven  water
 molecules. Typical properties are presented in Table
 5-11.

 Ferric sulfate is typically shipped in 45-kg  (100-lb)
 moisture-proof paper bags. Ferric sulfate is available
 in the Cheapeake  Bay area from the suppliers given
 in  Table 5-12.

 General  precautions should  be observed  when
 handling ferric sulfate, such as wearing goggles and
 dust masks,  and  areas  of the body that  come  in
 contact  with  the  dust or vapor  should be  washed
 promptly.
 5.3.3.2 General Design Considerations
 Aeration of ferric sulfate should be held to a minimum
 because  of the  hygroscopic  nature  of  the  material,
 particularly in  damp atmosperes.  Mixing  of  ferric
 sulfate and quicklime  in  conveying and  dust  vent
 systems should be avoided as caking and excessive
 heating can result. The presence of ferric sulfate and
 lime in combination has been known to  destroy cloth
 bags in pneumatic unloading devices. Because ferric
 sulfate in the  presence of  moisture will  stain,
 precautions similar  to  those discussed for  ferric
 chloride should be observed.
5.3.3.3 Storage
Ferric sulfate is usually stored in the dry state in the
shipping bags.
5.3.3.4 Feeding Equipment
Feed solutions are usually made up at  a water-to-
chemica! ratio of 2:1 to 8:1 (on a weight basis)  with
the usual ratio being 4:1  with a 20-minute detention
time. Care must  be taken not to dilute ferric sulfate
solutions to less than 1 percent to prevent hydrolysis
and  deposition of ferric hydroxide.  Ferric sulfate  is
actively corrosive in  solution, and  dissolving  and
transporting equipment should be fabricated of type
316  stainless steel, rubber,  plastics, ceramics, or
lead.

Dry feeding requirements  are  similar to those for dry
alum except that belt feeders are rarely used because
of their open-type construction. Closed construction,
as found  in  the  volumetric and  loss-in-weight type
feeders, generally exposes a  minimum of operating
components  to the vapor  and thereby  minimizes
maintenance. A water  jet  vapor remover should be
provided  at the  dissolver  to  protect  both  the
machinery and operator.
                                                  79

-------
Table 5-10.  Ferrous Chloride Supplier to the Chesapeake Bay Area
                      	Address	   Telephone
                                                       1986 Price Quotations
 Byproducts Management
1150 Junction
Schereville, IN 46375
(219)322-2560          $0.26/lb of Fe2 + = $0.31/gal
                     4,800-gal truck = 48,000 Ib/truck @ 12
                     percent Fe2 +  == 5,760 IbFe2*/truck =
                     $l,500/truck.
                     Prices include delivery to Chesapeake
                     Bay area.
Table 5-11.   Properties of Ferric Sulfate
 Molecular Weight
 Bu!k Density, Ib/cu ft
 Water Soluble Iron as Fe3+. percent
 Water Soluble Fe3 +, percent
 Insdubtes Total, percent
 Free Acid, percent
 Moisture © 105°C, percent
                526

               56-60

                21.5

                19.5

                 2.0

                 2.5

                 2.0
 5.3.3.5 Pipe and Accessories
 Piping  systems for ferric sulfate  should  be  FRP,
 plastics,  type 316  stainless steel, rubber,  glass,  or
 ceramics.
   5.3.4.2 General Design Considerations
   The granular form of ferrrous  sulfate has  the best
   feeding characteristics, and gravimetric or volumetric
   feeding equipment may be used.

   The  optimum  chemical-to-water   ratio  for
   continuous dissolving is 0.06 kg/I (0.5  Ib/gal), or a 65-
   percent solution with a detention time of 5 minutes in
   the dissolving tank. Mechanical agitation should  be
   provided in the dissolver to assure complete solution.
   Lead, rubber, iron,  plastics,  and type 304 stainless
   steel  can  be used  as construction materials for
   handling solutions of ferrous sulfate.

   Storage,  feeding, and transporting  systems probably
   should be suitable  for  handling ferric sulfate  as an
   alternative to ferrous sulfate.
 5.3.3.6 Pacing and Control
 System  pacing and  control
 discussed for dry alum.

 5.3.4 Ferrous Sulfate

 5.3.4.1 Properties and Availability
 Ferrous sulfate or copperas is a byproduct of steel
 pickling  and  is produced  as  granules,  crystals,
 powder, and lumps.  The most common commercial
 form of ferrous  sulfate  is  FeSO4»7H20  with  a
 molecular  weight of 278  and containing  55 to 58
 percent FeSO4 and 20 to 21 percent Fe. The product
 has  a bulk density of 990 to 1,060 kg/m3  (62 to 66
 Ib/cu ft). When dissolved, ferrous sulfate  is  acidic.
 The composition  of ferrous  sulfate  may  be quite
 variable and should be established by consulting the
 nearest manufacturers.

 Ferrous sulfate is  available in  bags and  in  the
 Chesapeake  Bay  area  in  18,200-1 (4,800-gal)
 truckload lots from the supplier given in Table 5-13.

 Dry ferrous sulfate  cakes at storage temperatures
 above 68° F,  is efflorescent in dry air, and oxidizes
 and hydrates further in moist air.

 General precautions  similar to those for ferric sulfate
 with respect  to dust and handling  acidic solutions
 should be observed  when  working  with  ferrous
 'sulfate. Mixing quicklime and ferrous sulfate produces
 high temperatures and the possibility of fire.
       are the  same as    5.4 Polyelectrolytes
                              5.4.1 Dry Polymers

                              5.4.1.1 Properties and Availability
                              Types  of polymers  vary widely  in  characteristics.
                              Manufacturers  should  be  consulted for properties,
                              availability, and cost of the polymer being considered.
                              Some polymer suppliers  available  to the Chesapeake
                              Bay area are given in Table 5-14.

                              5.4.1.2 General Design  Considerations
                              Dry polymer and water must be blended and mixed to
                              obtain  a recommended  solution for efficient action.
                              Solution  concentrations  vary from  a  fraction  of  a
                              percent  to  1  percent or  more.  Preparation of  the
                              stock solution  involves  wetting  of the dry  material
                              and  usually  an aging  period prior to  application.
                              Solutions can  be  very viscous,  and  close attention
                              should be paid to piping size and length and  pump
                              selections.  Metered solution is  usually  diluted just
                              prior to  injection  into the  process to  obtain  better
                              dispersion at the point of application.

                              5.4.1.3 Storage
                              General  practice for storage of bagged dry chemicals
                              should be observed. The bags should  be stored in a
                              dry, cool, low  humidity area and used  in proper
                              rotation, i.e., first in, first out. Solutions are generally
                              stored in type 316  stainless steel, FRP,  or plastic-
                              lined tanks.
                                                     80

-------
 Table 5-12.  Ferric Suifate Suppliers to the Chesapeake Bay Area
  Name	Address      	     Telephone
                                                        1986 Price Quotations*
  Manley-Regan Chemicals
 Coyne Chemicals
East Emmaus Street
P. O. Box 391
Middletown, PA 17057


3015 State Road
Croydon, PA 19020
(717) 994-7471
(215)785-3000
100-lb bags:
  20 bags - $15.30/100 Ib
  60 bags-$14.05/100 Ib
  100 bags - $13.55/100 Ib
$19.75/100 Ib
  * Call for applicable freight charges, if any. Generally, prices include freight up to varying distances from the point of manufacture.
Table 5-13.  Ferrous Suifate Supplier to the Chesapeake Bay Area

 Name	Address	Telephone
                                                         1986 Price Quotations
 Byproducts Management
1150 Junction
Schereville, IN 46375
(219) 322-2560         $0.3l/lb of Fe2 + = $0.20/gal
                     4,800-gal truck = 48,000 Ib/truck @ 6.5
                     percent Fe2*  = 3,120 Ib Pe2*/truck =
                     $970Aruck.
                     Prices include delivery to Chesapeake
                     Bay area
Table 5-14.  Polymer Suppliers to the Chesapeake Bay Area
Name
Pollu-Tech
Nalco
Hercules
Calgon
American Cyanimid
Dow
DuBois Chemicals
Div. W. R. Grace and Co.
Address
853 2nd Street Pike
Brownstone 2
Suite B-200
Richboro, PA 18954
2901 Butterfield
Oakbrook, IL 60521
910 Market Street
Wilmington, DE 19899
P. O. Box 1346
Pittsburgh, PA 15230
Berdan Avenue
Wayne, NJ 07470
1603 Santa Rosa Road
Richmond, VA 23288
3630 E. Kemper Road
Sharonville, OH 45241
Telephone
(215)357-1821
(312) 887-7500
(302) 575-6500
(412) 777-8000
(201)831-2000
(904) 288-1601
(513) 762-6000
1986 Price Quotations
Prices vary widely depending on the
nature of the product and amount required.
Prices typically range from $1.00 to
$3.00/lb. Call for freight charges.





5.4.1.4 Feeding Equipment
Two types of systems  are frequently  combined to
feed  polymers. The  solution  preparation  system
includes a manual  or automatic blending system with
the polymer dispensed by hand or by a dry feeder to
a wetting  jet and  then to a  mixing-aging tank at  a
controlled  ratio. The  aged polymer is transported to a
holding  tank  where metering  pumps or  rotodip
feeders  dispense  the  polymer  to  the  process. A
schematic of  such a system is  shown in Figure 5-7.
It is generally advisable to keep the holding or storage
time of polymer  solutions to a minimum, 1 to 3 days
or less, to prevent deterioration of the product.

5.4.1.5 Piping and Accessories
Selection must be  made after  determination  of  the
polymer; however, type 316 stainless steel or plastics
are generally used.
                              5.4.1.6 Pacing and Control
                              Controls  as described  for  liquid alum  apply to  the
                              control of dispensing feeders  for  polymer solutions.
                              The solution preparation system may be an automatic
                              batching  system, as  illustrated by  the  schematic in
                              Figure  5-8,  that fills  the  holding tank  with  aged
                              polymer as required by level probes.  Such a system
                              is  usually provided  only at large plants.   Unitized
                              solution preparation  units are  available, but  have a
                              limited capacity.

                              5.4.2 Liquid Polymers

                              5.4.2.1  Properties and  Availability
                              As with  dry  polymers, a  wide  variety of  products
                              exists and manufacturers  should  be consulted  for
                              specific information. See Table 5-14 for Chesapeake
                              Bay area suppliers.
                                                     81

-------
                              Figure 5-7.   Manual dry polymer feed system.
                                                   Hose
                                                                      Eductor
1
Y






1
	 ft"
ii
1 1
!!>
n
n
n
n
/






\
\
                                        Scale
                                 Relief
                                 Valve
                                 Point of
                                Application
                                                         Metering
                 Backpressure
                    Valve
Figure 5-8.   Automatic dry polymer feed system.
                    Solenoid
                     Valve
            Hot
           Water
            Pressure
            Regulator
                                        Dispenser
Control
 Valve
                                      Point of
                                     Application
                                                      Solution
                                                      Feeders
                             Transfer Pumpl     I
                                         T'
                                                                                             Mixing-Aging
                                                                                                 Tank
Level
Probe
                                                     Holding
                                                      Tank
                                                          82

-------
5.4.2.2 General Design Considerations
Liquid systems differ from the dry systems only in the
equipment to blend the polymer with water to prepare
the solution.  Liquid solution preparation is  usually a
hand-batching  operation with manual filling  of  a
mixing-aging tank with water and polymer.

5.4.2.3 Feeding Equipment
Liquid polymers need no aging, and simple dilution is
the only requirement for feeding. The dosage of liquid
polymers  may  be accurately controlled by metering
pumps or rotodip feeders.

The remainder of the feed system is generally the
same as described for dry polymers.


5.5 Design of Chemical  Feed Systems
5.5.1 Chemical Feed Systems
Chemical  feed  systems must be flexibly designed to
provide  for a high degree of reliability in view  of the
many contingencies  that may affect their operation.
Thorough wastewater characterization in terms of flow
extremes  and chemical  requirements should precede
the design of the chemical  feed system. The design
of the chemical feed  system  must take into account
the form  of each chemical desired for feeding, the
particular  physical and chemical characteristics of the
chemical,  maximum waste flows, and the operational
reliability of the feeding devices.

The capacity  of a  chemical feed system  is  an
important  consideration  in both storage and feeding.
Storage capacity  design must take into account the
advantage of quantity purchase vs. the disadvantage
of construction cost and chemical deterioration with
time. Potential delivery delays and chemical use rates
are necessary  factors in the  total picture.  Storage
tanks or bins for solid chemicals must be  designed
with proper consideration of the angle of repose of
the chemical  and  its  necessary  environmental
requirements, such as temperature and humidity. Size
and slope of feeding lines  are important along with
their materials  of construction with  respect  to  the
corrosiveness of the chemicals.

5.5.2 Chemical Feeders
The chemicals added to  wastewater to remove
phosphorus are either in liquid or solid form: Those in
solid form are usually converted to solution or slurry
form prior to introduction into the wastewater stream;
however,  some chemicals are fed  in a dry form. In
either case, some type of solids  feeder  is  usually
required. Chemical feeders  are available in  a variety
of types  because  of  wide  ranges  in  chemical
characteristics,  feed  rates,  and degree of  accuracy
required. Liquid feeding is somewhat more restrictive,
depending mainly on  liquid volume and viscosity.

Chemical  feeders must accommodate  the  minimum
and  maximum feeding  rates required.  Manually
controlled feeders typically have a range of 20:1, but
this range can be increased  to about 100:1 with dual
control  systems. Chemical  feeder  control  can  be
manual, automatically proportioned to flow,  dependent
on some form of process feedback,  or a combination
of any  two of  these.  More  sophisticated  control
systems are feasible if proper sensors are available. If
manual control systems are specified with  the
possibility of future  automation, the  feeders selected
should  be  amenable  to this conversion  with  a
minimum of expense. An example would be a feeder
with an external motor that could easily be replaced
with a variable speed motor or  drive  when automation
is installed. Standby  or  backup  units  should  be
included for each type of  feeder  used.  Reliability
calculations will  be  necessary  in larger plants with a
greater  multiplicity of these units.  Points of chemical
addition and piping to  them  should be  capable of
handling all possible changes  in dosing  patterns to
provide proper flexibility of  operation.  Designed
flexibility in hoppers,  tanks, chemical  feeders,  and
solution lines is the  key to maximum benefits  at least
cost.

5.5.2.1 Liquid Feeders
Liquid feeders are generally  furnished  in the form of
metering pumps or orifices. Usually these metering
pumps  are of  the positive displacement  variety,
plunger type, or diaphragm type. The choice of liquid
feeder  is  highly   dependent on  the  viscosity,
corrosivity, solubility, suction and discharge  heads,
and  internal pressure-relief  requirements.  Some
examples  are  shown  in Figures  5-9  and 5-10. In
some cases, control valves and rotameters  may be all
that  is  required. In other cases, such as polymer
feeding, progressive cavity  pumps are  used  with
appropriate controls. More complete descriptions of
liquid feeder  requirements can  be  found  in  the
literature and in manufacturer's  catalogs.

5.5.2.2 Dry Feeders
Solids characteristics vary greatly, and the choice of
feeder must be considered  carefully,  particularly in
the smaller-sized facility where a  single feeder may
be  used for more  than one  chemical.  Generally,
provisions should be made to keep all chemicals cool
and dry. Dryness is very  important, as hygroscopic
(water absorbing) chemicals  may  become  lumpy,
viscous, or even rock hard; other chemicals with less
affinity for water  may become sticky from moisture on
the paniculate  surfaces, causing increased arching in
hoppers. In either  case,  moisture will  affect  the
density  of  the  chemical and  may  result  in  under-
feed.  Dust removal equipment should be used  at
shoveling  locations,  bucket elevators,  hoppers, and
feeders for neatness, corrosion  prevention, and safety
reasons. Collected chemical  dust may  often be
reused.

The simplest method for feeding solid chemicals is by
hand. Chemicals may be  preweighed  or  simply
                                                 83

-------
Figure 5-9.   Plunger-type metering pump (courtesy of Wallace & Tiernan).
                                                                                  Discharge Valve
                                                       Plunger
                                                                                      Suction Valve
Figure 5-10.  Diaphragm-type metering pump (courtesy of Wallace & Tiernan).
  Rale ol Feed Indicator

   Anti-Syphon Valve



                4
      Discharge Valve




           Diaphrag

 Head and Front Cover

                •

        Suction Valve


    Reservoir Chamber


        Return Spring
Stroke-Adjustment Shalt



Ball Bearing


Push Rod


Eccentric Needling
Bearing

Ball Bearing


Aluminum Housing


Input Shaft and Worm



Fiber Glass Base
Gear Driven
Oil Pump
                                                            84

-------
shoveled or poured by the bagful  into a  dissolving
tank. This method is limited to very small wastewater
plants, or to chemicals used in very weak solutions.
Also, dry chemicals can be drawn into the  dissolving
tank by means of an eductor.

Because of the  many factors,  such  as moisture
content, grades,  and  compressibility,  that can affect
chemical  density  (weight-to-volume  ratio),
volumetric feeding of solids is normally restricted  to
smaller wastewater plants, specific types of chemicals
that are  reliably  constant in  composition, and  low
rates   of feed.  Within these  restrictions,  several
volumetric types  are  available. Accuracy  of  feed  is
usually limited to  plus or minus 2 percent by weight,
but may be as high as plus or minus 5 percent.

One type of volumetric dry feeder uses a continuous
belt of specific width  moving from under the hopper
to the  dissolving tank. A mechanical gate mechanism
regulates the depth of material on the belt, and the
rate of feed  is governed by the speed of the  belt
and/or the height of the  gate opening. The hopper
normally  is equipped  with  a vibratory mechanism  to
reduce arching. This type of feeder is not  suited for
easily fluidized chemicals.

Another type  employs  a screw  or helix  from  the
bottom of the hopper through a tube opening slightly
larger than the diameter of the screw or helix. Rate of
feed is governed by the speed of the screw  or helix
rotation.  Some   screw-type  designs  are self-
cleaning, while others  are subject  to clogging.  A
typical screw feeder is shown  in Figure 5-11.

Most remaining types of volumetric feeders generally
fall into  the  positive  displacement category.  All
designs incorporate some form of moving cavity  of'a
specific or variable size.  In operation, the chemical
falls by gravity into the cavity and  is more or less  fully
enclosed and separated from the hopper's  feed.  The
size of the cavity and  the  rate  at which the cavity
moves and  is discharged  govern  the amount  of
material fed.  One unique design is the progressive
cavity  metering  pump, a  non-reciprocating type.
Positive displacement feeders often utilize air injection
to enhance flowability of the chemical.

The basic drawback of volumetric feeder  design,  its
inability to compensate for changes in the density  of
materials, can be  overcome  by including a gravimetric
or  loss-in-weight controller.  This  modification
allows  for weighing of the chemical as it is fed.  The
beam balance type, shown in Figure 5-12,  measures
the actual  mass  of chemical.  This is considerably
more accurate, particularly over a long period  of time,
than the  less  common  spring-loaded  gravimetric
designs.  Gravimetric  feeders  are used where feed
accuracy of about plus or minus 1 percent is required
for economy  (as  in large-scale operations) or when
chemicals are  used in small, precise  quantities.  It
should be noted,  however,  that  even  gravimetric
feeders cannot compensate for weight added to the
chemical  by  excess  moisture.  Many  volumetric
feeders  can  be  converted to  a  loss-in-weight
function by  placing the entire feeder on  a platform
scale .that is tared to neutralize  the weight  of the
feeder.

Good housekeeping and the  need for accurate feed
rates dictate that the gravimetric feeder be shut down
and  thoroughly cleaned on a regular basis. Although
many of  these  feeders have  automatic  or semi-
automatic devices  that compensate to some degree
for accumulated solids on the weighing mechanism,
accuracy is affected, particularly on humid days when
hygroscopic  chemicals are fed.  In some cases, built-
up chemicals can actually jam the equipment.

5.5.2.3 Dissoivers
Most feeders,  regardless of type, discharge their
material to a small dissolving tank that is equipped
with  a nozzle  system  and/or  mechanical agitator
depending on the solubility of the chemical being fed.
Solid chemicals, such as polymers, can be carefully
spread into a vortex spray or washdown jet of water
immediately before entering the  dissolver.  It  is
essential that  the  surface of each particle become
thoroughly wetted  before  entering the feed  tank  to
ensure accurate dispersal  and to  avoid  clumping,
settling, or floating.

A dissolver  for  a  dry chemical feeder  is  unlike a
chemical  feeding  mechanism,  which  by  simple
adjustment and change of speed can  vary  its output
tenfold. The  dissolver must be designed for the job to
be done. A dissolver suitable  for a rate of 4.5  kg (10
lb)/hr may not be suitable for dissolving at a rate of 45
kg (100 lb)/hr. As  a general rule,  dissolvers may be
oversized, but  dissolvers for commercial ferric  sulfate
do not  perform well  if greatly oversized due to a
hydrolysis reaction  with water.

It is essential  that specifications  for dry  chemical
feeders include specifications  on dissolver capacity. A
number of factors need to be  considered in designing
dissolvers of proper capacity. These include detention
times and water  requirements,  as  well  as other
factors specific to individual chemicals.

The  capacity of a dissolver  is based on  detention
time, which is directly related to the wettability (or rate
of solution) of  the  chemical. Therefore, the dissolver
must be  large enough to provide the necessary
detention for both the chemical and the water at the
maximum  rate of feed. At lower  rates of  feed, the
strength   of  solution  or  suspension leaving  the
dissolver will be less, but the detention time will be
approximately  the  same unless the water  supply  to
the  dissolver is reduced. When the water  supply  to
any dissolver is controlled for the purpose of forming
a constant  strength  solution,  mixing  within  the
                                                  85

-------
Figure 5-11.  Screw feeder (courtesy of Wallace & Tiernan).
    Control Box
         Motor
                                                                           Optional
                                                                           Hopper
                                                                            Hopper Agitating Plate
       Goar Reducer
            Agitator
                                                                            Rotating Feed Screw
                                                                                        Optional Feeder
                                                                                        Downspout and Tank
dissolver must  be accomplished  by  mechanical
means because sufficient power will not be available
from  the  mixing jets at low rates of flow. Hot water
dissolvers are also available to minimize the required
tankage.

5.5.2.4 Chemical Feeders Summary
The  foregoing descriptions give some  indication of
the wide variety of materials that may be handled.
Because  of this variety,  a facility may contain  any
number of different types of feeders with combined or
multiple  materials  capability.  Ancillary  equipment to
the feeder also varies  according to the  material to be
handled.  Liquid feeders encompass a limited number
of  design principles  that  account for  density  and
viscosity  ranges.  Solids feeders,  relatively  speaking,
vary  considerably due to the wide range of physical
and  chemical  characteristics, feed rates, and  the
degree of precision and repeatability required. Table
5-15  describes several types  of  chemical feeders
commonly used in wastewater treatment.

5.5.3 Sizing Chemical Feed System Components
Components of  the chemical feed system must be
sized so that chemicals can be applied at the required
rates  and so  that  manpower  required to  receive,
transfer,  and mix chemicals is kept to a minimum.
The chemical feed system consists of storage tanks
or bins, day tanks or hoppers,  liquid or dry feeders,
and the necessary transfer systems.

Chemical storage  facilities  are  sized  so  that a
capacity  equal to  approximately 30 days of storage is
available at average  chemical rates  of application.
Chapter  4  provides details on chemical usage  rate
calculations. Bulk facilities for smaller plants  must
have  a capacity  great enough to  hold  1-1/2 times
the minimum shipment of chemical.

At smaller wastewater plants where  chemicals  are
mixed in a batch, or with  polymer systems, day tanks
are normally provided. Day tanks act as aging vessels
for polymer systems and  allow the operator to visually
judge the amount of chemical fed during a shift or
24-hour period. Day tanks are typically sized to  hold
a  24-hour supply of chemical at the maximum rate
of chemical application.

At larger wastewater plants where dry chemicals can
be stored in bulk, hoppers are  usually located above
                                                   86

-------
Figure 5-12.  Beam balance-type gravimetric feeder (courtesy of Wallace & Tiernan).
                                                              Vertical Gate
                                                                        Flexures
         Traction
         Roll
                                Weighbelt
                                       i^ Counter
                                         Weights »iBeam
  Idler Roll-' /   ,*

  -**,    | £^3
     "^^••4   ~--J
the dry chemical  feeders  to  provide  a continuous
supply of chemical  to the feeder. The  chemical
hopper is  generally a part of the  bulk storage bin. If
the bulk storage bin cannot be located above the dry
chemical feeders,  it  may be necessary  to provide a
day hopper  with a pneumatic conveying  system to
transfer dry  chemical from bulk storage to the day
hopper. The day hopper should be large  enough to
hold a minimum of 8 hours of chemical at maximum
feed  rates.  A  24-hour capacity  at  the  rate  of
maximum  supply is  preferable. Smaller dry feeders
and dissolvers  typically have integral hoppers  large
enough to hold 1-1/2 bags  of chemical.

Both  liquid and dry  feeders must be sized so that
they are capable of delivering both the maximum and
minimum chemical dosages. In some cases, it may
be necessary to provide multiple pumps or feeders to
span the required chemical feed rates.

5.5.4 Optimum Feed  Points  and  Feed  Point
Flexibility
Phosphorus  removal  chemicals  can be  added  at
many different points in the  wastewater treatment
process.  It is best to design feed point flexibility into
the chemical feed system. Provisions should be made
to feed chemicals ahead of primary clarification  as
well as ahead  of secondary  clarification.  With the
required pipework  in  place, the necessary feed point
or combination of feed points can be used to attain
the desired  level of  treatment  in the most efficient
manner.

Addition of metal salts ahead of primary clarification
typically results in a  greater usage of chemical than
would  be the case  if added  ahead of or  to  the
secondary system.  Suspended  solids and BOD
reduction  in primary  clarification are enhanced with
the  addition of  metal  salts.   This  enhanced
performance leads  to  the production  of  greater
volumes  of  primary  sludge, but  also improves  the
treatment  process efficiency by reducing the  load to
the secondary system.

Metal salts  added ahead of or  to  the secondary
system can be  utilized more  efficiently, particularly
with the  activated sludge process.  With addition
ahead  of or to the  secondary  system,  final  clarifier
performance  is  improved  and,  in the case  of  the
activated sludge  process, a large fraction of the metal
salt is returned to the head of the aeration tank with
the return sludge. See Chapter 2 for a more detailed
discussion of chemical feed application points.

5.5.5  Room  Layouts for  Chemical  Storage,
Preparation, and Pumping
Typical room layouts  for storage, solution preparation,
and  pumping of ferric chloride  and  polymer  are
                                                  87

-------
Table 5-15.  Types of Chemical Feeders


 Type of Feeder	
                                                         Limitations
                      Use
  Capacity
                                                                 Range
 D»y Feeder:
  Volumetric
    Oscillating plate
    Oscillating throat (universal)
    Rotating disc
    Rotating cylinder (star)  -
    Screw
    Ribbon
    Belt
  Gravimetric
    Continuous-belt and scale
    Loss in weight
 Solution Feeder.
  Nonoositive Displacement
    Decanter (lowering pipe)
    Orifice
    Rotameter (calibrated valve)
   Positive Displacement
    Rotating dipper

   Proportioning Pump
    Diaphragm
    Piston
Any material, granules or powder.
Any material, any particle size.
Most materials including NaF, granules, or powder
Any material;, granules or powder.
Dry, free-flowing material, powder or granular.
Dry, free-flowing material, powder, granular, or lumps.
Dry, free-flowing material up to 1.5-in size, powder or
granular.
Dry, free-flowing, granular material or floodable material.
Most materials, powder, granular, or lumps.
Most solutions or light slurries.
Most solutions.
Clear solutions.
    Loss in weight (tank control valve)    Most solutions.
Most solutions or slurries.
Most solutions, special unit for 5-percent slurries.*
Most solutions, light slurries.
                                                                                    cu ft/hr
 0.01 - 35
0.002 -100
 0.01 - 1.0
 8 - 2,000
    or
 7.2 -  300
 0.05 - 18
0.002-0.16
0.1 - 3,000
  0.02 to 2
 0.02 to 80
 0.01 to 10
  0.16 to 5
0.005 to 0.16
     or
 0.01 to 20
0.002 to 0.20
                                                   0.1 to 30
0.00+to 0.15
 0.01 to 170
40 to 1
40101
20101
10101
  or
100 to 1
20101
10 to 1
10101
  or
100 to 1
100 to 1
100 to1
100 to 1
 10 to 1
 10to1
                                                                 30to1


                                                                 100 to 1
100 to 1
 20to1
  " Uses special heads and valves for slurries.

 presented  in  Figures 5-13  through  5-22.  The
 figures cover the range of 0.004 to 0.44  m3/s (0.1 to
 10 mgd); 6 to 10 mg/l and 3 to 6 mg/l influent TP; and
 0.2, 0.5,  1.0, and 2.0 mg/l effluent TP. These layouts
 are suitable for conceptual  design applications and
 observe all regulatory requirements.

 (Note: For alum, the storage volume requirements are
 approximately  50  percent  more than  for  ferric
 chloride.   However,  due  to standard storage  tank
 sizes, this does not always  translate  into larger tank
 requirements. Also,  an anti-siphon  leg should  be
 installed  downstream of the feed pump for alum or
 ferric chloride when the application point is below the
 level of the day tank.)
 As  indicated previously in Chapter 2,  a  theoretical
 model  being developed  from  research  currently  in
 progress  (1,2) predicts  that  metal  ion   dose
 requirements to attain low effluent TP concentrations
 of  <1   mg/l  are  independent of  influent TP
 concentration. Published  data confirming this model
 are lacking at this time. In the absence of  such  data,
 the room layouts  in  Figures  5-13  through  5-22
 were developed  on the basis of  conventional  metal
 ion-to-influent  TP dose  relationships  for  all four
 effluent TP limitations considered in this  document. If
                       the above theory (1,2) is eventually verified, separate
                       room layouts would  not be appropriate for the 0.5-
                       and  0.2-mg/l  TP  effluent limits.  Accordingly,  a
                       portion of Figure  5-13  (0.2-mg/l effluent TP limit at
                       influent TP  of  3-6 mg/l and  plant flow of  1  mgd)
                       would become identical  to Figure  5-15  (0.2-mg/l
                       effluent TP limit at influent TP of 6-10 mg/l and plant
                       flow  of  1  mgd).  Similarly, Figure  5-16  (0.5-mg/l
                       effluent TP limit at influent TP of 3-6 mg/l and plant
                       flow of 5  mgd) would become  identical to Figure 5-
                       19 (0.5-mg/l effluent  TP limit at influent TP of  6-10
                       mg/l and plant flow of 5 mgd).

                       5.6 Chemical Equipment  Suppliers
                       The various manufacturers and local Chesapeake Bay
                       Area representatives of chemical feed equipment (dry
                       chemical  feeders,  chemical feed pumps, polymer
                       preparation systems, and chemical storage  tanks) are
                       listed  in  Tables 5-16 through 5-19.

                       5.7  Staffing Requirements for  Chemical
                       Addition
                       A  treatment plant  that  is retrofitted  to  remove
                       phosphorus by   chemical  addition will  require
                       additional  man-hours  to  operate and maintain  the
                                                     88

-------
                                 I*
                                                                                      LU
                                                                                        •5,  oa ej eg
                                                                                        E  ocio
                                                                                    Q.
                                                                                    0.
                      O
O

I
O

E"
S
Q.
o <5

If
LL Q-
  CO
u>
                                                         89

-------
                     .0 <5
                      oiuu
                             - r - - .
                      en
                      I*
                      o S
                      oo
90

-------
to

o
o
£
S
E
                                                                                               Q.
                                                                                               O.
                                                                                               .2 =:
                                                                                                 ~
                                                                                                        oj
                                                                                                        d
                                                                                                   1,   o
                                                                                                   £   S
                                                                                                 a.
                              K
o
co

1"

<
!<§
O m
o £
'E -S-
m O
I£Q-
2
3
O>
                                                                                               03W
                                                                                               00
                                                                                               u. a.
                                                                91

-------
                                                                  [1,
                                                                I"
                                                                Rs!
                                                                3 =
&  CO
(9

I
                                                                O o
*
                                                                COW

                                                                OO
PI
                                           92

-------
                                                                                                            It
                                                                                                        _
                                                                                                        Q.
                                                                                                        Q.
                                                                                                         « c
                                                                                                           "
                                                                                                              O)   °
                                                                                                              £   S
                                                                                                             73
                                                                                                              C3)
                                                                                                         O
                                                                                                         CO
                                                                                                         QJ -^=
                                                                                                         •O  13

                                                                                                         I?
                                                                                                         o  &
                                                                                                         U.O-

8                                                                                                           CO
                                                                                                           O
                                                                                                         LL. Q.
in

I
O)
u.
                                                                       93

-------
                                      a §
                                      Q.
                                      O.
                                     « Q-
                                      31-
                                      o) c

                                     £

                                           o>   co
                                           .§.   co
                                           9>   m
                                      o
                                     a>
                                       "
                                       -
                                      (U'g
                                     B =
                                       •  -
                                     O &
                                      o E
                                     '^
                                       ) W
94

-------
i
V
I
Q)
10

I

O)
                                                                                      oj
                                                                                      Q.
                                                                                      O.
                                                                                              o
                                                                                              «—

                                                                                              (O
_
o
CO

"I
fil
|c§
O fe
                                                                                      C/JW
                                                                                      OO
                                                           95

-------
I"
                              w c\j e\i| w
                              o o o o
                       .2!
                        o
                       CO
                         -
                       n-
                       |
-------
                             °
                                  li)  «?«(
                                i
                              o
97

-------
                                                           ST!
K
                                                           o te
                                                           S p
                                                           u. fl-
                                                           cot
                               98

-------
Table 5-16.  Dry Chemical Feeder Suppliers

 Name
     Main Office
Chesapeake Bay Area Representative
 BIF, a unit of General
 Signal
1600 Division Road ,*
West Warwick, Rl 02893
(401)885-1000
 Wallace & Tiernan Div.
 Pennwalt Corp.
25 Main Street
Belleville, NJ 07109
(201) 759-8000
T. E. Byerly Co., Inc.
262 M Cedar Lane
Suite 5
Vienna, VA 22180
(703) 849-8170

Pyrz Water Supply Co., Inc.
P. O. Box 1271
43 Becker Road
North Wales, PA 19454
(215)699-9550

Tri-Star
300 Vine Street
P. O. Box 255
Middletown, PA 17057
(717)944-1234

Wallace & Tiernan
The Woods, Suite 511
985 Old Eagle School Road
Wayne,  PA 19087
(215)687-4930

Wallace & Tiernan
Suite 210
11501 Georgia Road
Wheaton, MD 20902
(301)933-2110
chemical feed systems. Plants that use ferric chloride
rather than alum will require more man-hours due to
the corrosiveness of ferric chloride. The approximate
number of man-hours required per year  to operate
and maintain chemical feed systems for different size
plants up to 0.44 m,3/s (10 mgd) are  summarized in
Table 5-20.


5.8 Sludge Considerations
The application of metallic salts at various points in a
wastewater treatment  plant  creates  new  and
additional  sludges. Depending  on   the point  of
chemical  addition,  increased  amounts  of primary
and/or secondary sludges will be generated. The ratio
of  primary  to secondary sludge will be  affected  by
chemical  usage.  For example,  if a  mineral salt is
added to the primary settling tank, floe production and
solids capture  will  increase;  since  more primary
sludge will  be  produced,  the  primary  sludge-to-
secondary sludge  ratio  will  increase.  The additional
solids loading resulting from  chemical sludges must
be considered in the design  of sludge handling and
treatment facilities.  Metallic salts usage can result in
as much  as a 200-percent increase in sludge  solids
for disposal over  that produced  in strict biological
treatment, depending on dosage and feed points.

Sludges  generated  in  wastewater   treatment
processes  to which phosphorus removal chemicals
are added may be handled and  disposed of by any of
the  conventional  methods.  However,  sludge
                      conditioning  characteristics will change according to
                      the  chemical content of the  sludge.  The gelatinous
                      properties  of  aluminum  hydroxide  floe  result in
                      somewhat lower filter yields when alum is present in a
                      sludge. A typical comparison  is presented  in  Table
                      5-21, where total sludge production and filter  yields
                      are  given for a conventional activated  sludge process
                      operating with a) no  chemical  treatment and b) alum
                      addition to the aeration tanks.


                      As shown in Table 5-21, the use of alum may result
                      in a 50-percent  increase in sludge solids produced
                      per  volume  of wastewater  treated.  The use of ferric
                      chloride or  other iron salts  will result  in  a  similar
                      increase in sludge solids as discussed in Chapter 3.
                      Dewaterability as measured by vacuum filter yield  is
                      typically lower with alum sludge as compared to ferric
                      chloride sludge.  Other  data  indicate  no significant
                      handling  or  conditioning problems  for sludges from
                      processes incorporating ferric chloride.

                      The handling of  sludges containing products of
                      chemical coagulation poses no special problems. The
                      design engineer  must be aware,  however,  of the
                      greater solids production that results  from  chemical
                      usage and the impact of  the greater solids loading on
                      handling and conditioning unit processes. The varying
                      characteristics of the different chemical sludges  also
                      are  a factor in the design of  conditioning equipment.
                      Laboratory filterability tests can be  useful in  this
                      respect.
                                                   99

-------
Table 5-17.  Chemical Feed Pump Suppliers
 Name                                 Main Office
                                         Chesapeake Bay Area Representative
 BIF, a unit of General
 Signal
1600 Division Road
West Warwick, Rl 02893
(401) 885-1000
 Wallaco & Tiernan Div.
 PonnwaH Corp,
25 Main Street
Belleville, NJ 07109
(201) 759-8000
 Robbins & Meyers
409 Plymouth Road
Plymouth, Ml 48170
(313) 459-4336
 Milton Roy Co,
 Flow Control Division
203 Ivyland Road
Ivyland, PA 18974
(215)441-0800
T. E. Byerly Co., Inc.
262 M Cedar Lane
Suite 5
Vienna, VA 22180
(703)849-8170

Pyrz Water Supply Co., Inc.
P. O. Box 1271
43 Becker Road
North Wales, PA 19454
(215) 699-9550

Tri-Star
300 Vine Street
P. O. Box 25S
Middletown, PA 17057
(717)944-1234

Wallace & Tiernan
The Woods, Suite 511
985 Old Eagle  School Road
Wayne,  PA 19087
(215)687-4930

Wallace & Tiernan
Suite 210
11501 Georgia Road
Wheaton, MO 20902
(301)933-2110

Robbins & Meyers
102 North Main, Suite 101
Bell Aire, MD 21014-3542
(301)879-9566

Robbins & Meyers
108 WillowbrooK Lane
West Chester,  PA 19382-5592
(215)693-2331

Geiger Pump
8851 Kelso Drive
Baltimore,  MD  21221
(301)682-2600

Milton Roy Pumps
2500 Maryland Avenue
Willow Grove,  PA 19090
(215)657-7770
5.9 Laboratory Requirements

The estimated  sampling and analytical  needs for
phosphorus  removal  by  chemical  addition  to
mainstream processes are shown in Table 5-22.

5.10 Safety and OSHA Requirements for
Chemical Addition

5.10.1 Ferric  Chloride
5.10.1.1 General
Common  sense  safety precautions  should be
observed   around  storage  tanks.  Washing  of
contaminated  areas from spills that occur at delivery
time  is recommended.  Brown  stains  occur  rapidly
                      following a spillage. Containment  walls around the
                      tanks will confine  the tank contents  in case of
                      leakage. Containment areas should be kept clean and
                      dewatered at all times.

                      Ferric chloride is  a  reddish-brown solution varying in
                      strength from 35 to  45  percent, by weight,  depending
                      on time  of shipment.  Precautions for handling the
                      chemical should be followed as  given below.  Water
                      hoses, emergency showers, and  eye washes should
                      be located within 15 m (50 ft) of the ferric chloride
                      unloading station  and  storage tank(s) and near the
                      ferric chloride pumps.

                      The  following discussion also  applies  to ferrous
                      chloride and ferrous sulfate.
                                                   100

-------
 Table 5-18.  Polymer Preparation Systems
 Name
                                            Main Office
                                                                                     Chesapeake Bay Area Representative
 BIF, a unit of General
 Signal
 1600 Division Road
 West Warwick, Rl 02893
 (401)885-1000
 Wallace & Tiernan Div.
 Pennwalt Corp.
25 Main Street
Belleville, NJ 07109
(201)759-8000
 Stranco "Polyblend"
P. O. Box 389
Bradley, IL 60915-0389
(815)932-8154
 T. E. Byerly Co., Inc.
 262 M Cedar Lane
 Suite 5
 Vienna, VA22180
 (703) 849-8170

 Pyrz Water Supply Co., Inc.
 P. O. Box 1271
 43 Becker Road
 North Wales, PA 19454
 (215)699-9550

 Tri-Star
 300 Vine Street
 P. O. Box 255
 Middletown, PA 17057
 (717)944-1234

 Wallace & Tiernan
 The Woods, Suite 511
 985 Old Eagle School Road
 Wayne, PA 19087
 (215)687-4930

 Wallace & Tiernan
 Suite 210
 11501  Georgia Road
 Wheaton, MD 20902
 (301)933-2110

 Heyward, Inc.
 717  East Blvd.
 Charlotte, NC 28203
 (704) 372-5805

 Riordan Materials Corp.
 1413 Ormsby Place
 Crofton, MD21114
 (301)858-0609
Table 5-19.   Chemical Storage Tanks

 Name
                                           Main Office
                                                                                    Chesapeake Bay Area Representative
 Owens - Corning
 Fiberglas
Fiberglas Tower
Toledo, OH 43659
(419) 248-7000
 Process Equipment Corp.
500 Reed Street
fielding, Ml 48809
(616)794-1230
900 W. Valley Road
Suite 1101
Wayne, PA 19087
(215)688-9306

7501 Forbes Blvd.
Suite 102
Seabrook, MD 20770
(301)390-6900

Rodem, Inc.
5095 Crookshank Road
Cincinnati, OH 45238
(513) 922-6140

Whitney Packaging, Inc.
50 Kearny Road
Needham, MA 02194
(617)444-5050
                                                         101

-------
Table 5-20.  Manpower Required to Operate and Maintain Chemical Feed Systems
                                                                            Alum (man-hr/yr)
Plant Design
Flow (mgd)
< 0.1
0.1 - 1.0
1 -5
5-10
Operation
150 - 300
300 - 460
460-1,100
1,100-1,700
Maintenance
50 - 100
100 - 140
140 - 360
360 - 540
Total
200 - 400
400 - 600
600- 1,460
1,460-2,240
Operation
110 -220
220 - 320
320 - 800
800 - 1,200
Maintenance
35 - 70
70 - 100
100 - 250
250 - 380
Total
145 - 290
290 - 420
420 - 1,050
1,050 - 1,580
Table S-21.  Comparison of Filter Yields With and Without
           Alum Addition
Metal Salt
None
Alum
Dose
mg/l
-
150
Feed
Sludge
% solids
6.2
5.7
Sludge
Solids
Produced
tons/Mgal
0.8
1.2
Vacuum
Filter
Yield
Ib/hr/sq ft
5.2
4.6
 5.10.1.2 Precautions for Handling Ferric Chloride.
 1.  Protective Equipment for Eyes. Wear suitable eye
    protection such as  chemical worker's  goggles or
    their equivalent. All emergency  showers and eye
    washes should be tested once a day.

 2.  Hazards  to  Eyes. Eyes contaminated with ferric
    chloride may rapidly become irritated; prolonged or
    permanent impairment of vision  or even total loss
    of sight may occur. Dilution of ferric cloride to 20
    percent or less tends to reduce the  intensity of
    effect Tests  indicate that such  concentrations
    may cause mild conjunctiva! irritation and  possibly
    some transient corneal injury.

 3.  First Aid for Eye  Contact. In cases of  splashes of
    liquid  ferric  chloride into  the  eyes,  flush
    immediately and  thoroughly with large  amounts of
    water for 20 to 30  minutes and then rinse with a
    weak solution  of  sodium bicarbonate or boric acid.
    Consult a physician, preferably  an eye specialist,
    immediately. Chemical  burns  to the eye  must be
    treated promptly. Repeatedly flooding the  eye with
    water within seconds after contact with a chemical
    is the most effective  way to prevent permanent
    damage.  In the  opinion of medical experts, if a
    victim can reach an eyewash station within  10 to
    15  seconds,  his chances  of recovering with no
    permanent damage to the eyes are excellent. After
    15  seconds,  the chances of  recovery  decline
    rapidly.

 4. Protective Equipment for  Skin. Most people  are
    not sensitive to ferric chloride and need wear only
    regular work  clothing  with whatever protection is
    desired to minimize staining, e.g.,  rubber or plastic
    sleeves,  apron,  and  gloves.  Since ferric chloride
    deteriorates leather rapidly, people working with
   ferric chloride should wear rubber shoes or regular
   work  shoes with  rubber soles  and  heels and
   waterproofed leather uppers.

5. Hazard to  Skin. When  in  contact  with  the skin,
   ferric  chloride solution may cause blistering and
   superficial  burns  unless washed  off promptly.
   Such  contact  will  also  stain the skin. Repeated
   prolonged skin contact with strong solutions may
   cause superficial burns,  especially if  confined to
   the skin  as  might occur when  contaminated
   clothing or shoes are worn.

6. First Aid for Skin  Contact. Remove contaminated
   clothing  and wash affected  skin with soap  and
   plenty of water until the  wash water is essentially
   colorless. A physician  should  be consulted if any
   irritation or injury to the skin develops.

7. Ingestion  Hazard.  If  large  amounts  of  ferric
   chloride are swallowed, it may cause burns to the
   mucous  membranes and  severe irritation  of the
   gastrointestinal tract.

8. First  Aid  for Ingestion. If large  amounts of ferric
   chloride  are swallowed,  a physician should  be
   called immediately. While the physician is  on the
   way,  the patient should be induced to vomit.

9. Spills. Spills  should  be  neutralized with  caustic
   soda or lime and the  areas flushed with water.
   Adequate diking and drainage should  be provided
   at unloading and storage areas to prevent spills or
   leaks from harming  surrounding equipment and
   facilities. To prevent spills and splashing, tank cars
   and  trucks containing  ferric  chloride  solution
   should never be  moved unless all openings  are
   secured and lines drained arid disconnected.

 5.10.2 Polymer
 There are so many types of polymers on the  market
 that the operator should obtain complete instructions
 from the  supplier as  to the safe handling  of  the
 particular brand product being used. Polymers can  be
 purchased in either liquid or  dry powder form and  in
 various size containers.

 In general, polymers are not considered to be toxic,
 but it is well to avoid unnecessary contact with either
                                                    102

-------
Table 5-22. Estimated Sampling and Analytical Needs for Phosphorus Removal by Chemical Addition
Measurement Plant Size ^m9d^ Test Frecluency Location of Sample Method of Sample
pH


Alkalinity

TSS


TBOD


Jar Test

Total Solids
Total Solidsi
Flowi
Total R1.2


Prtho P1


All


All

All


All


All

> 1
< 1
All
All


All


1/day


2/week

1/day


1/day


Spot Check

1/week
3/week
Record Continuously
3/week


3/week


Clarifier Influent
Clarifier Effluent

Clarifier Influent
Plant Effluent
Clarifier Influent
Clarifier Effluent

Clarifier Influent
Clarifier Effluent

Clarifier Influent

Sludge Underflow
Sludge Underflow
Sludge Underflow
Clarifier Influent
Clarifier Effluent
Plant Effluent
Clarifier Influent
Plant Effluent

24-hr Composite


24-hr Composite

24 -hr Composite


24-hr Composite


24-hr Composite

Grab Composite
Grab Composite
Record Continuously
24-hr Composite


24-hr Composite


Reason for Test
Process Control
Recordkeeping/Permit
Compliance
Recordkeeping/Permit
Compliance
Process Control
Recordkeeping/Permit
Compliance
Process Control
Recordkeeping/Permit
Compliance
Process Control
Cost Control
Process Control
Process Control
Process Control
Process Control
Recordkeeping/Permit
Compliance
Process Control
Recordkeeping/Permit
Compliance
  1 Suggested minimum.
  2 Or as prescribed by permit
the powder or liquid.  Goggles,  gloves, and  aprons
should be used to protect the skin and eyes. The use
of a face mask when handling the powder should be
required.

Anionic polyelectrolytes have a low acute oral toxicity.
Eye contact with either  the undiluted or  diluted
material may result in mild transistory  irritation. The
materials are not irritating to the skin.

Polymers, when in solution, are highly viscous and,
therefore, very slippery and dangerous to foot traffic  if
allowed to spill.

Handling polymers should  cause no health problems
if reasonable care, good housekeeping, and personal
cleanliness  are  practiced  to avoid skin and eye
contact.

5.70.3 OSHA Requirements
Detailed state OSHA requirements may  vary between
the Chesapeake  Bay area  states. However, as  a
minimum, the following guidelines are recommended.

1.  Provide a water hose, eyewash, and  shower within
   15m (50 ft) of any hazardous chemical unloading,
   storage, and feed  area.

2.  Provide a  spill containment  dike  around each
   storage tank. The dike containment volume should
   be equal to at least 150 percent of the volume of
   the storage tank.

3. Provide a means for removing water or chemicals
   from within each containment dike.

4. Provide  a  15-cm  (6-in)  high  concrete curb
   around all chemical  feed areas for containment of
   spillage.

5. Provide splash guards at all pumps.

6. Provide  spray shields  under  all  hazardous
   chemical piping crossing walkways or  passage
   ways.


5.11  References
1. Personal communication  from  R.I. Sedlak,  The
   Soap and Detergent Association, New York, NY,
   to  R.C. Brenner, U.S. EPA, Cincinnati, OH,  May
   20, 1987.

2. Personal communication  from  D.  Jenkins,
   University of  California,  Berkeley, CA, to  S.J.
   Kang, McNamee,  Porter and Seeley, Ann  Arbor,
   Ml, July 31, 1987.
                                                 103

-------

-------
                                             Chapter 6
                        Process and Hardware Design Considerations for
          Retrofitting Activated Sludge Plants with Biological Phosphorus Removal
 6.1 Introduction

 As discussed in  Chapters  2 and 3, two proprietary
 processes  are  considered  in  this  manual  for
 retrofitting selected  suspended  growth  activated
 sludge systems with  biological phosphorus removal:
 the  PhoStrip process  and  the A/O  (anaerobic/oxic)
 process. Although the major mechanism for removing
 phosphorus with  these processes is biological,  the
 PhoStrip process employs a sidestream to chemically
 precipitate biologically removed phosphorus, while the
 A/O  process  is  a  mainstream process  where
 phosphorus is removed in the waste activated sludge.

 Both processes can be retrofitted only  to activated
 sludge systems,  including  plug flow, complete  mix,
 contact stabilization,  pure  oxygen,  step aeration,
 extended  aeration,  and  two-stage  nitrification
 configurations. Activated sludge is alternately cycled
 through an  anaerobic stage where  phosphorus  is
 released and an aerobic stage where phosphorus-
 stripped  biomass  takes  up  phosphorus  at  an
 increased rate. Biological phosphorus removal is most
 applicable for treatment of wastewaters with relatively
 low  (3-6  mg/l) influent TP  concentrations.  The
 probability that chemical polishing will be required
 becomes greater  with   higher  influent  TP
 concentrations.

 Activated  sludge plants retrofitted  with  biological
 phosphorus  removal  may experience  improved
 settling  characteristics and  suspended  solids
 removals resulting from the  anaerobic/aerobic cycling
 of activated sludge. Additional  process  design  and
 operating  considerations  are  presented  below  for
 each process.
6.2 PhoStrip Process
Retrofit  with  the  PhoStrip  process  can  be
accomplished for any of the commonly used activated
sludge flow regimes given an  adequate  site  for
construction of a stripper tank, a precipitation tank or
reactor-clarifier for chemical precipitation,  and lime
handling facilities. The PhoStrip process is owned and
marketed  by  Biospherics  Incorporated,  4928
 Wyaconda Rd.,
 770-7700.
Rockville,  MD 20852-2496,  (301)
 6.2.1 Conditions Prerequisite to PhoStrip Retrofit
 The conditions  listed below  indicate  the operating
 ranges experienced to date for PhoStrip systems and
 should  be  considered prerequisite  operating
 conditions for retrofit.

  Influent TBOD =  70 to 300 mg/l
  Influent TP = 3 to 10 mg/l
  Secondary clarifier oxidized nitrogen = 3 to 30 mg/l
  Wastewater temperature = 10to30°C
  Aeration tank HOT = 4 to 10 hr
  MLSS = 600 to 5,000 mg/l
  F/M loading = 0.1 to 0.5 g TBOD/g MLVSS/d

 If a  PhoStrip retrofit is being  considered  for a plant
 where operating conditions within the range presented
 above cannot be achieved, a pilot study is warranted
 prior to full-scale design and construction.

 6.2.2 Design Considerations
 A generic PhoStrip process schematic including key
 sidestream  flow  rates  and  other information  is
 presented in Figure 6-1. For plants  that  are not
 operating at primary clarifier  design capacity,  a
 chemical precipitation tank can be substituted for the
 reactor-clarifier, the contents  of  which  would go  to
 the primary clarifier.

 As  shown  in  Figure 6-1, the range for the direct
 return activated  sludge  rate (0.2 to  0.5 times the
 influent  flow rate)  is that normally  observed for
 activated sludge  plants. In addition,  return sludge  is
 cycled through the stripper tank at 0.15 to 0.3 times
 the  influent flow  rate.  Anaerobic conditions  are
 maintained  in  the  stripper tank, with  a detention
 normally  between  8  and 12  hours. It  is here that
 phosphorus is  released in   a soluble form for
 subsequent chemical precipitation. A longer anaerobic
 stripper  detention  time  is required  when oxidized
 nitrogen  is  present. This is  because  denitrifying
 microorganisms  that convert nitrate  nitrogen  to
nitrogen  and oxygen under  anaerobic  conditions
compete  with  microorganisms  responsible  for
                                                105

-------
Figure 6-1.  PhoStrip process flow diagram.
      Influent (Q)    ^ Primary
                                                    Direct Sludge Recycle
                                                       (0.2 - 0.5 Q)
                   Primary Sludge
                                                                                           Effluent
                              Waste Activated
                                 Sludge  	
                                                                                   Phosphorus-
                                                                                  Enriched Sludge
                                                                                   (0.15 -0.3Q)
                                                                 Supernatant
                                                                (0.1 - 0.2 Q)
                                                            Stripper Underflow
                                                              (0.1 - 0.2 Q)
                                    Anaerobic
                                 Phosphorus Stripper
                                 (HRT = 8-12 hr)
                                              Chemical Sludge
                  Elutriation from any of:
                  (a) Stripper Underflow Recycle
                  (b) Primary Effluent
                  (c) Reactor-Clarifier Supernatant
 phosphorus  removal  for  the  readily  biodegradable
 substrate. In addition,  it has  been theorized that
 nitrate  nitrogen acts as a terminal  electron acceptor
 for  phosphate-accumulating  bacteria.  As  a result,
 sufficient anaerobic contact time must be provided for
 denitrification, i.e., removal of nitrate nitrogen, to be
 carried to completion  first and  then be followed by
 phosphorus  release.
 The volume of the stripper tank is determined by the
 sludge  flow into the stripper and  the  required
 anaerobic detention time. The stripper SOR, typically
 selected in accordance with gravity thickener designs
 at  16 to 24  m3/m2/d  (400  to  600 gpd/sq  ft),
 determines  the stripper surface area. The stripper
 volume divided by the surface area determines  the
 sludge blanket depth, and normally 0.9 to 1.2 m (3 to
 4 ft) is added to the depth for supernatant storage.
 Phosphorus release is encouraged in the stripper tank
 by  the elutriation of the sludge with a stream low in
 phosphorus  content  such  as  primary   effluent,
 secondary effluent, or lime precipitation tank overflow.
 The elutriation  flow rate is normally 50 to  100 percent
 of  the  stripper feed  rate.  Stripper tank  underflow
 recycle or digester supernatant recycle can also  be
 used  as elutriate sources. The higher organic content
 of these streams encourages phosphorus release.  As
 stated in Chapter 2, the choice and magnitude of the
 elutriation stream is a  site-specific selection based
 on operational  and wastewater composition criteria.
The  underflow rate  from the stripper  tank  typically
amounts to 0.1  to  0.2  times the plant influent flow
rate, and the sludge solids in this stream can double
in  concentration  through the  stripper's thickening
function.  The phosphorus-poor  biomass  in  the
underflow from the  stripper  tank is returned to the
activated sludge aeration tank to  insolubilize  primary
effluent phosphorus  via  the process of enhanced or
"luxury" biological uptake. F/M loading rates used are
typical of most activated sludge processes and can
range from  0.1  to  0.5  kg TBOD/kg MLVSS/d,
although it is noted that increased organic  loadings
lead  to  greater  phosphorus removal  through the
waste activated sludge resulting  from  increased
sludge yields.

Supernatant  from the anaerobic  stripper tank carries
high SP concentrations  in the range of 15 to  100 mg/l
and flows  continuously  to the chemical precipitation
tank  at a rate of 0.1 to 0.2 times the plant influent
flow. Here the phosphorus is chemically insolubilized
with lime at dosages of 100 to 200 mg/l to maintain  a
pH of 9.0 to 9.5. These dosages amount to  20 to 30
mg/l  of lime based on  plant influent flow. It is  noted
that lime becomes a much more  economical  chemical
for  use  in  phosphorus  precipitation  when the
phosphorus  stream  is concentrated  than  iron  or
aluminum  based  salts due to  the  differences  in
stoichiometries between those salts. Lime dosage  is
in general independent of phosphorus concentration
                                                    106

-------
and depends primarily on  the alkalinity of the water,
since  it will first react  with  alkalinity  to  precipitate
CaCOa  and then  precipitate phosphorus. Iron  and
aluminum salts must be applied on  roughly an equal
molar  basis to  phosphorus;  therefore,  the same
amount would be necessary whether the stream  was
small in flow and concentrated in phosphorus or  high
in flow and less concentrated.

Where  sufficient  primary clarifier capacity  exists, the
contents of the chemical  precipitation  tank (used  in
lieu of a reactor-clarifier) can  be  routed  there for
co-settling  with  primary  sludge.  Alternately,  the
precipitation tank contents can be clarified separately
with only clarifier overflow from the operation routed
to  the  primary  clarifier.  A typically-used  chemical
precipitation clarifier overflow rate is  approximately 50
m3/m2/d  (1,200  gpd/sq  ft). The   lime-phosphorus
sludge  is generally  disposed of  separately with  this
option.

A variation of the PhoStrip process called  PhoStrip II
was recently unveiled, but to date has not  been used
in a full-scale application. PhoStrip II makes use  of a
prestripper tank with 30 minutes of detention where
return  sludge and  a  BOD source  are mixed. This
mixture then flows to a down-sized stripper tank  with
4 to 8  hours of detention where elutriation is  not
required. Other design parameters are  similar to the
original PhoStrip process.

6.2.3 Attainability of Effluent Limits
Effluent  limits of 2  and 1  mg/l  TP  can be  reliably
attained using the PhoStrip process. An effluent TP
limit of 0.5 mg/l can  be met  if effluent suspended
solids are reliably controlled, but tertiary filtration may
be necessary. Achieving an effluent limit of 0.2 mg/l
TP may require a tertiary  chemical  polishing  step  in
addition  to tertiary filtration. Provisions  for metal  salt
addition to the aerator as well as just prior to filtration
should  also  be  made for achieving a 0.2-mg/l  TP
effluent limit.

6.2.4 Lime Handling
Lime used for the  PhoStrip  process is available   in
two forms:  quicklime  (CaO)  or   hydrated lime
[Ca(OH)2]. Quicklime contains about 90 percent CaO
and must first be hydrated or slaked to the Ca(OH)2
form prior to application to the wastewater. Hydrated
lime, a dry  powder, has  already been slaked  and
contains 72 to 74 percent CaO and 23  to 24 percent
water of hydration.  Slaking refers to the process of
adding water to quicklime to produce hydrated lime.

Lime is available in bulk by rail or truck, or in bags.  In
general,  bagged  hydrated  lime is recommended for
applications requiring less  than 450 kg  (1,000 lb)/d.
This would be the case for PhoStrip retrofits of less
than 0.18 m3/s  (4  mgd).  In bulk,  hydrated lime  is
recommended for applications up to 2,700 to  3,600
kg  (6,000 to  8,000 lb)/d, or PhoStrip retrofits up to  1
 m3/s (24  mgd).  Thus, quicklime  and  associated
 slaking  equipment would be cost-effective  only  for
 very large retrofit applications.

 Storage areas for both bulk and bagged lime must be
 kept covered and dry. Hydrated lime may be stored
 for up to 1 year,  while quicklime should not be stored
 more than 3 months.  Lime bags can be  stacked 20
 high, or higher when pallets are used. Bulk storage of
 lime is usually done in conventional steel  or concrete
 bins and  silos  with conical  bottoms.  Hydrated lime
 does not  flow as well as quicklime, and  tall storage
 bins with  height-to-diameter  ratios of  2.5  to 4 are
 recommended.  Vibrating bin  bottoms  or discharge
 chutes can help prevent arching or  bridging of the
 lime.

 Lime is normally  added to water to form a slurry prior
 to  being  applied  to  the wastewater.  For  small
 applications,  bagged hydrated  lime can   be added
 manually to a batch mixing tank to form  a slurry  for
 feeding to  the  chemical  precipitation  tank.  Bulk
 hydrated lime is  fed with a dry  chemical  feeder to a
 batch or continuous mixing tank for subsequent feed
 to  the chemical  precipitation  tank.  Bulk quicklime
 must be fed to a  slaker, where it is first hydrated. It is
 then  further diluted  in a  separate  tank prior to
 application.  Gravimetric  dry  chemical  feeders  are
 somewhat more costly than the volumetric type, but
 offer several advantages and  are  the preferred
 choice.

 Diaphragm pumps,  progressive cavity  pumps,  or
 dipper wheel feeders are used to  feed  the  lime
 solution, typically at a concentration of 5  percent. A
 recommended maximum solution concentration  is 1
 kg  lime to 17 I water  (1 Ib to  2 gal water),  and the
 solution tank detention time should be 5  minutes.

 Scaling  is  a major  problem in  pumps,  pipes, and
 valves. Piping distances should be minimized, and
 flow  should   be  by   gravity.   Sodium
 hexametaphosphate  can be added to dilution water
 and polymers can be used to inhibit scale formation.
 Troughs and  channels or flexible hose  are  preferred
 to rigid pipe  for  slurry transport. Provisions for  acid
 flushing and the  use of  "pigs"  should  be made  for
 lime slurry lines.


 6.3 A/O  Process
Although the A/O process is most easily retrofitted to
plug flow  activated  sludge  tanks, it  can also  be
adapted to most of the activated sludge flow regimes.
The ease of retrofit is determined by  the  ability to
delineate  and  convert a  portion  of  the  aeration
tankage to an  anaerobic zone. Anaerobic here is
defined  as the  absence of all DO  and  oxidized
nitrogen, while anoxic refers to the conditions where
DO is low or  absent but oxidized nitrogen  is present.
Space for construction of retrofit facilities  is normally
                                                  107

-------
not required for the A/O  process, and generally an
A/O retrofit is more easily accomplished than a retrofit
for PhoStrip.  The  A/O  process  is  owned  and
marketed by Air Products and  Chemicals,  Inc., P.O.
Box 538, Allentown,  PA 18105, (215) 481-4911.

6.3.1 AlO Operating Conditions
The ratio of influent SBOD to SP should be greater
than 10 to achieve  an effluent TP  concentration  of
1-2 mg/l, and highe. ratios are desirable since they
are more  conducive  in  achieving  the release  of
phosphorus in the  anaerobic stage. This minimum
ratio  is  necessary  to provide  sufficient  readily
biodegradable  substrate, to  produce enough cell
mass  to  trigger  the phosphorus  release/uptake
mechanisms,  and  to  ensure  the absence  of
exogenous electron  acceptors in the anerobic stage.
Additional operating conditions are as follow:

 Wastewater temperature  = 10 to 30°C
 Anaerobic detention time =  1 to 2 hr
 Anoxic (when requried) detention time = 1 hr
 Aerobic detention time =   2.5 hr without
                           nitrification, 6 hr with
                           nitrification
 MLSS = 2,000 mg/l in the summer; 3,500  mg/l in
          the winter
 F/M loading = 0.15 to 0.6 kg TBOD/kg MLVSS /d

If an A/O retrofit is being considered  for a plant  where
operating conditions  within  the  ranges  presented
cannot be achieved, a pilot study is warranted prior to
full-scale design and  construction.

6.3.2 Design  Considerations
Generic A/O flow diagrams for the cases without and
with  nitrification  are  illustrated  in  Figure  6-2. An
anoxic stage is normally required after the anaerobic
and prior to the aerobic stages when nitrification is a
process consideration. A flow scheme  consisting of
anaerobic, anoxic,  and  aerobic  stages  in series is
generally  referred  to  as  the  A2/O  process,  a
modification  of the  basic A/0  process  designed to
remove nitrogen and/or mitigate the negative effects
of nitrification on biological phosphorus release in the
anaerobic stage.

 In the A2/O  scheme, some  method  of  low-head
 pumping is required to recycle mixed liquor at  a rate
 of approximately 100 percent of the influent flow rate
 from the last aerobic  stage to the first anoxic  stage.
 The  anoxic  stage  serves to  denitrify  the  oxidized
 nitrogen, thereby preventing  competition with the
 microorganisms  responsible  for phosphorus leaching
 in the anaerobic stage.  While  the internal recycle
 does  not  prevent nitrate nitrogen from entering the
 anaerobic stage,  it does  reduce  the  nitrate
 concentration in the return sludge stream.

 The   A/O  process has  not  been  operated with
 nitrification on a full-scale  basis  at  total detention
times  less  than 8  hours, although studies  are
currently  underway  at lower  detention times.  If
sufficient  total detention time is available,  existing
tankage can be retrofitted with baffles to delineate the
anaerobic, aerobic, and, if necessary, anoxic stages.
It  is desirable to  maintain  plug  flow as much  as
possible to ensure good contact of microorganisms
with substrate.  For  this  reason,  three anaerobic
stages, four aerobic stages, and, if necessary, three
anoxic stages  are  normally  used.   The  exact
configuration  is a site-specific consideration. Excess
tankage may be available  at  some plants  such as
those  employing  the  extended aeration  process.  In
these cases, a portion of the tankage may be blocked
off and taken out of service.

A variety  of  baffle materials are available  including
concrete,  different types of woods and plyboard, and
plastic coated fabrics.  Open slots should be left at the
bottom of these  baffles to allow movement  of mixed
liquor. Where there are several  baffles in sequence,
the slots should  be constructed at alternating corners
to  enhance plug flow.  In  addition,  slots should be
provided  at the  top  of each baffle  to  prevent  the
buildup of scum.

Aeration devices in the anaerobic and anoxic stages
must be removed or prevented from operating since it
is extremely  important that air not be introduced to
these  stages. Aeration capacity  in the remaining
aerobic stages  may  be  insufficient, especially in
extended  aeration type systems where long  detention
times  are being retrofitted  to  shorter ones.  In  these
cases, aeration  devices  can  be moved  from
anaerobic stages to aerobic stages when possible, or
auxiliary aeration may be required. Oxygen demand in
the aerobic stages is similar to  that for  conventional
activated  sludge, or 1.5 kg Oa/kg TBOD removed. DO
concentrations  in excess of  2  mg/l  should  be
maintained at all times in the aerobic stages.

Some form of mixing  is required in the anaerobic and
anoxic stages. The mixing  must be such that oxygen
transfer through excessive exposure of liquid surface
to air is minimized. Submersible pumps  can be  used
in smaller tanks or stages. Vertical mechanical mixers
are appropriate  where the stage  length and width
dimensions are similar and the depth is shallow, since
 excessive shaft  vibration can occur when the shaft is
 long.  For stages that are  much longer than they are
 wide, or  for large,   deep  stages, side-mounted
 submerged propeller-type  mixers  are desirable.  The
 goal of the mixing is  simply to maintain  the  MLSS in
 suspension with less  than  a  10-percent variation  in
 concentration.  Mixing  power requirements in the
 anaerobic and anoxic zones can be estimated at 20
 kW/1,000 m3  (0.75  hp/1,000  cu  ft), although  this
 depends  heavily on tank configuration.

 The return activated  sludge rate is  typically between
 20  and 75 percent of the influent flow rate.  When
                                                   108

-------
 Figure 6-2.   A/O process flow diagrams.
         Influent
1 -- - »-

L
Anaerobic
Stages
Oxic
Stages

J Fin
"H Clari
Sludge Recycle
1
                                                                                           Effluent
                   Primary Sludge
                                                                              Waste Activated Sludge
                                                                               (Phosphorus-Rich)
                              A/O Schematic for Phosphorus Removal Without Nitrification
         Influent
                   Primary Sludge

1 A
L
Anaerobic
Stages
Anoxic
Stages
Oxic
Stages

iJ Fin
*l Clari
Sludge Recycle
^
                                                                                           Effluent
                                                                              Waste Activated Sludge
                                                                               (Phosphorus-Rich)
                                A/O Schematic for Phosphorus Removal With Nitrification
operating  at  the  lower end of this range,  it  is
important that appropriate  waiving  be  provided  to
accurately control return sludge rates for proportional
pacing  with low  influent flows.  The sludge  blanket
depth in the secondary clarifier should be maintained
at less  than 0.6  m (2 ft) to prevent development  of
anaerobic  conditions  and  subsequent  leakage  of
phosphorus into  the  secondary  effluent. Secondary
clarifier SORs can range between 24 and 26 m3/m2/d
(600 and 650 gpd/ sq ft).

The organic loading rate is an important consideration
in successful  operation  of  the A/O process.  Higher
organic loading rates  result in  higher sludge yields
and, therefore, greater removals of phosphorus since
the only exit for  phosphorus in  the A/O process  is
through the waste activated sludge. Although higher
rates have been successfully used, the recommended
volumetric  organic  loading  rate  for   concurrent
nitrification is 0.15 kg TBOD/kg MLVSS/d or 0.08 kg
SBOD/kg MLVSS/d. Higher volumetric organic  loading
rates up to 0.6 kg TBOD/kg  MLVSS/d may be  applied
when nitrification is not required.
When the  method of  sludge  handling  includes
anaerobic digestion or other operations where the
sludge is subjected to anaerobic conditions,  at least a
portion  of  the biologically-removed phosphorus will
be released in a soluble form. This can then find its
way back to the influent of the plant through recycle
streams.

The effects of recycle  streams  such  as  digester
supernatant,  sludge thickener  overflow,  and  filter
press or vacuum filter filtrates  on mainstream process
operation  and  performance must  also  be carefully
considered.  These streams may carry a large loading
of phosphorus back to the influent and  may  upset the
required  influent  BOD-to-phosphorus  ratio.
Segregation of the recycle streams may be necessary
in extreme cases.

6.3.3 Attainability of Effluent  Limits
An effluent limit of 2 mg/l TP should be attainable for
most wastewaters where an A/O retrofit is  used. An
effluent limit of 1 mg/l TP could be  attainable most of
the  time with the A/O process and  perhaps  all of the
                                                  109

-------
time at some locations. However,  a backup feed
system for dosing selected chemicals to the aerobic
zone is recommended for any necessary polishing.

In achieving effluent limits of 0.5 mg/l TP or less, the
influent  SBOD-to-SP  ratio  becomes  more
important, with a desired ratio of 20 to 25.  Provisions
for  chemical polishing in the aerobic zone would be
necessary to achieve  an effluent TP concentration of
0.5 mg/l, and a tertiary chemical polishing stage plus
tertiary  filtration  would  be required  to  achieve an
effluent TP concentration of 0.2 mg/l.
                                                  110

-------
                                            Chapter 7
    Compatibility of Chemical and Biological Phosphorus Removal with Nitrogen Control
7.1 introduction

At some locations in the CBDB, there may be a need
to  simultaneously  control  both nitrogen and
phosphorus  in  municipal  effluents.  Nitrogen control
requirements  may  be  contingent  on  several
environmental  impacts: provision for nitrification for
protection of the receiving  water  from  ammonium
nitrogen oxidation demand, protection of aquatic life
from ammonia  nitrogen toxicity, nitrogen removal to
prevent eutrophication of  the receiving water,  and/or
control of health hazards due to nitrate ions.

Requirements  for  dual  nutrient  control,  i.e.,
phosphorus removal  and  nitrification  or  nitrogen
removal,  can greatly affect the biological, chemical,
and engineering  considerations  of  retrofitting
wastewater treatment facilities.

7.2   Process   Considerations   for
Complying   with  Dual  Nutrient  Control
Requirements
When  a chemical or biological  phosphorus  removal
process must  be modified to  also  include  nitrogen
control, the impact of side reactions must be  carefully
evaluated. Topics discussed in  the following  sections
are essential  considerations for all  dual  nutrient
control processes.

7.2.1 Control of Process pH Value
Currently,  all nutrient  control processes  are  either
biological  processes  supplemented  by chemical
additions  or specially managed biological processes.
Therefore, control of process pH in the range  of 6.0
to 8.0 is necessary to  protect biomass from the toxic
effects of hydrogen ions.

As  noted in  Chapter 2, metallic  salts used for
chemical  removal of phosphorus are acidic in nature.
This acidity  is  due  to  the  hydrolysis of metal ions
when  added to water. For example, when aluminum
sulfate is added to wastewater  the following  reaction
occurs:

AI2(SO4)3 + 6H2O -» 2 AI(OH)3 + 3H2SO4  (7-1)

The sulfuric acid produced by this reaction consumes
a  portion  of the alkalinity  of the wastewater. If
Equation 7-1 is calculated on the basis of aluminum,
the acid produced is equivalent to 5.6 mg/l of calcium
carbonate alkalinity  for each 1  mg/l  of aluminum
added to the wastewater.

Similar calculations for ferric salts show that each 1
mg/l of ferric ion dosed to wastewater will consume
2.5 mg/l of calcium carbonate alkalinity. If the source
of  metallic  precipitant  selected  for phosphorus
removal is waste pickle liquor in  the form of ferrous
sulfate or ferric chloride, it should  be noted that these
products may also contain free acid, which will also
consume alkalinity in addition to the metal hydrolysis
reaction.

When a nitrified  effluent  must  be produced,  the
biological conversion of ammonium nitrogen to nitrate
nitrogen can also deplete alkalinity. The conversion is
a  sequential  two-step  biological  oxidation
accomplished by  two  specialized  microorganisms;
however, the overall  nitrification reaction can  be
viewed as follows:
NH4+ + 2C-2
                           + H2O + 2H + (7-2)
Calculated on  a nitrogen basis, for  each 1 mg/l of
ammonium nitrogen converted to nitrate nitrogen, the
amount of hydrogen ions produced will consume 7.1
mg/l of  calcium  carbonate alkalinity. This  depletion
can be severe. If, for instance, 20 mg/l of ammonium
nitrogen  were  oxidized,  the calcium  carbonate
alkalinity would be reduced by 142 mg/|. As a rule of
thumb, if a wastewater has a carbonate/bicarbonate
buffer system with a pH value between 7.0 and 8.5,
the concentration of ammonium nitrogen that can be
oxidized before the pH value  decreases below  6.0 is
about 0.1 of  the  wastewater  calcium  carbonate
alkalinity.

Another important  reaction   must  be taken into
account if a denitrification process  is instituted for
nitrogen  removal  requirements.  Biological
denitrification is a very  complex series of biochemical
reactions; however, for process control purposes, the
reaction can be considered to  occur as follows:
                    O2 + 0.5 N2 + OH'   (7-3)
For each nitrate ion converted to nitrogen  gas, one
hydrogen ion is consumed and one hydroxyl ion is
                                                111

-------
produced. This has the overall effect of increasing the
alkalinity of the wastewater. For each 1 mg/l of nitrate
nitrogen converted  to nitrogen gas,  3.5  mg/l of
calcium carbonate  alkalinity will  be  produced. In
certain process  configurations,  this alkalinity
production can partially offset the alkalinity depleting
reaction of nitrification  and assist  in  maintaining
control of process pH.

7.2.2 8/omass Environmental Management
The discussion  of biological phosphorus removal in
Chapter 2 describes the different environments that
the biomass  of these processes must cycle  through
for proper population selection. These environments
must be  managed  to  be  anaerobic,  anoxic,  and
aerobic.

When   nitrification  or nitrification/denitrification  is
coupled  with  biological phosphorus  removal,  it
becomes necessary  to  further  define  these
environments as follows:

1. An  anaerobic stage should not contain DO, and
   nitrate should not be present.

2. An   anoxic  stage should  not contain DO, but
   should contain nitrate.

3. An  aerobic stage should contain  at  least 1  mg/l
    DO and may contain nitrate. -

It has  been found that the presence of DO or nitrate
in the  anaerobic  stage of a  biological phosphorus
removal process will inhibit the release of intercellular
phosphorus. As long as either of these is present, the
microorganisms will utilize these oxygen  resources to
oxidize organics instead of sorbing organics and
releasing phosphorus.  Thus, phosphorus uptake  in
the subsequent aerobic stage may be prevented.

If a PhoStrip or A/O process must also  be retrofitted
to produce a nitrified  effluent,  the nitrate content of
the  return sludge flow into the side stream stripper
tank or main stream  anaerobic stage,  respectively,
would  have  to  be  taken  into account to  allow
adequate HRT for oxygen resources to be consumed
and phosphorus release to occur.

For nitrogen removal  processes, anoxic stages are
provided  for biological denitrification, which transforms
nitrate  nitrogen into nitrogen gas. The microorganisms
performing  this  transformation  are  facultative
organisms that can  metabolize substrate using either
DO or  oxygen from the nitrate  radical. If both DO and
nitrate are  present,  the  microorganisms  will
preferentially use DO.  Therefore, to ensure efficient
denitrification,  an  anoxic stage must be operated to
exclude DO.

Aerobic stages are  incorporated into all dual nutrient
 control  processes  for provision  of the  proper
environmental conditions for oxidation of organics and
nitrification.

If a  phosphorus  removal process, either  biological
combined with chemical or biological  by  itself,  must
also  achieve nitrification  or nitrogen removal via
denitrification, the dominant design and  operational
considerations become  the  selection  of SRT  and
management  of  the  several  environments  the
biomass  must  cycle through to  foster population
selection and achieve effluent limitations.

7.2.3 Engineering Aspects
Dual nutrient control  processes  offer situations  in
which attention  to engineering aspects of design and
operation becomes critical. Consideration should be
given to the following:

1. Reactor recycle flows
2. Mixing devices
3. Baffling between reactor stages
4. Clarifier mass  loading
5. Reuse of oxygen contained in the nitrate radical

All processes combining dual biological  phosphorus
removal  and denitrification for nitrogen removal  entail
recycling flows  between various reactor stages. While
these  can  be  low-head  pumping operations, the
magnitude of recycle flows can be up to four  times
the  influent flow. Power requirements for these
recycle flows should be  evaluated as  an operational
cost. Recycles between reactor stages with different
environmental conditions can interfere with attainment
of proper  reactor  stage  performance  such  as
introducing  DO from an aerobic stage into  an anoxic
stage. Also, the  effect of the  magnitude of recycle
flows on substrate residence time must be evaluated.

Mixing devices for anaerobic and anoxic stages can
be submerged pumps, impeller mixers, or very coarse
bubble,  low volume  aeration  devices. The  basic
design  requirement  is  supplying  enough  power  to
keep the biomass in  suspension, yet not creating a
turbulent surface that  will  cause  oxygen transfer to
occur.  Typically, the  power required  to  maintain
biomass in suspension is about  20 kW/1,000 m3 of
tank volume (0.75 hp/1,000 cu ft)  for mechanical
devices  and about 25 m3 air/1,000 m3 of tank volume
 (25  cu ft/1,000  cu ft) for aeration devices.

 Baffling  between reactor stages is necessary  to
 maintain proper  environmental conditions in  each
 stage and to prevent short circuiting.  Baffle walls can
 be constructed from concrete, treated wood, or heavy
 duty plastic curtains.  Material  selection should  be
 based on  site-specific details such as cost,  duration
 of the retrofit operation, and effluent requirements.

 Generally, a retrofit for dual nutrient control processes
 places  a  greater solids  load  on  an existing final
 clarifier. Either a chemical  or  biological phosphorus
                                                  112

-------
removal  process that must also achieve  nitrogen
control requires operating at a greater SRT. Chemical
and biological phosphorus removal processes can be
operated  at  SRTs  of 3 to  4  days, irrespective of
temperature  considerations. However, nitrification or
denitrification  requires  SRTs  of  6 to 8  days  for
summer  conditions  and 15  to  20  days under winter
conditions. This equates to  a greater mass of mixed
liquor in the reactor that must cycle  through the final
clarifier. The flux loading on the clarifier floor should
not exceed 120 kg/m2/d (25  Ib/sq ft/d).

Inspection of  Equation 7-3 indicates that during
biological denitrification,  not only  is  alkalinity
produced,  but oxygen  is  liberated from the nitrate
radical.  Depending on the process configuration
selected  for retrofit  and the  facility's operational staff
capability, this liberated oxygen can be a  resource.
The theoretical calculation  for  Equation 7-3 shows
that 67 percent of  the  oxygen in the nitrate radical
could  be  recovered for  use  in bio-oxidation  of
organics  in  wastewater. The following equation can
be used as a first approximation of the magnitude of
this recovered oxygen:

  (mg/l NOa'-N x 4.5 x 8.3 x mgd x 0.67 x $/wire hp-
  hr) T Ib Oa/wire hp-hr  (aeration efficiency)  = $/d
                                          (7-4)

In Equation 7-4, the value  of 4.5 is the oxygen factor
for  oxidation  of ammonium  nitrogen to  nitrate
nitrogen.
For a  0.48-m3/s (5-mgd)  facility  that  recovered  15
mg/l of  nitrate oxygen with  an oxygen transfer
efficiency  of  1.0 kg Oa/kWh  (1.65 Ib/wire hp-hr) and
an electrical  energy cost  of $0.10/kWh ($0.075/wire
hp-hr), the theoretical value  of the recovered oxygen
would be  $85/day.  This, of  course,  would  be offset
by  efficiency  factors  due to process configuration,
recycle pumping costs,  and  additional  operating
attention  for  process  control. At larger facilities that
are required  to nitrify or denitrify,  this source  of
oxygen should be evaluated in early retrofit decisions.

7.3   Dual  Process   Removal   and
Nitrification Processes
Aside from the items  noted  in the  previous sections,
mating of phosphorus removal  with  nitrification
requires consideration of HRT,  SRT,  the F/M loading
rate, and  oxygen supply.

7.3.7  Chemical  Phosphorus  Removal  and
Nitrification
Combined activated  sludge-chemical  phosphorus
removal processes that also  achieve nitrification  were
shown previously  in Figures  2-3  and 2-6.  One-
and  two-stage systems for  nitrification have  been
employed.  The  choice  between  the configurations
should be based on wastewater  temperature and
wastewater  quality. A  requirement for wintertime
 nitrification favors a two-stage system to reduce the
 total reactor detention time deriving from the ability to
 maintain a long SRT in the second stage. A two-
 stage system should also be selected  if the organic
 content of the  wastewater  is  high. The first-stage
 reactor  reduces  the organic loading to the nitrification
 stage, allowing  attainment  of  the  proper  SRT to
 achieve nitrification in that stage.

 In retrofit situations, spare aeration tankage or baffling
 of tankage may allow  implementation of two-stage
 treatment.  Existing  secondary clarifier  capacity may
 be the limiting factor in this decision.

 If  nitrification  is required only  during  the  summer
 months  and  the wastewater is of  usual municipal
 organic  strength, the retrofit choice would typically be
 single-stage nitrification. Reference 1 contains many
 examples  of  dual chemical phosphorus  removal  and
 nitrification employing a variety of options.

 7.3.2 Biological  Phosphorus  Removal  and
 Nitrification
 Flow  diagrams  of  biological phosphorus  removal
 utilizing the  PhoStrip  and  A/O processes were
 presented  previously  in  Figures 2-11  and 2-12,
 respectively. Achieving nitrification  with these
 processes  in  a retrofit  situation depends  on  the
 temperature and organic loading at which the facility
 has to nitrify. At cold temperatures,  both processes
 require a significant increase in SRT. Since the A/O
 process  depends  on  sludge  wasting  as  the
 phosphorus removal mechanism, it can  be  impacted
 by changes in SRT. The PhoStrip  process, with  a
 sidestream  chemical  operation,  would   not  be
 impacted to as great an extent.

 High  organic  loads would  favor  the A/O  process,
 since  this  process  depends  on  removal  of
 phosphorus  by  cellular synthesis.  However,  the
 organic  load  could  not  be  so  great  as to prevent
 achieving an SRT suitable for nitrification.

 Reference 2  describes a full-scale PhoStrip process
 that produced a nitrified effluent during the summer of
 1984. The  F/M loading  was  0.16  kg  TBOD/kg
 MLVSS/d, an SRT of 7 days  was maintained, and the
 aerator HRT was 4.6 hours.

 This same  reference provides data for  two  full-scale
 facilities utilizing  a process configuration similar to the
A/O  process. Nitrification  was  achieved  in  the
 summer of 1984. Winter nitrification capability was not
 monitored.  Based  on  the aerobic  portion  of  the
 bioreactors, the HRT varied between 6 and  15 hours
and the  F/M  loading  between 0.12 and  0.33 kg
TBOD/kg MLVSS/d. The SRT, based  on total reactor
volume,  ranged from 7 to 11 days.

 Reference 3  reports on  the  full-scale demonstration
of  a facility retrofitted for the A/O process to achieve
                                                 113

-------
biological phosphorus removal and  nitrification.  This
northern facility has  a  seasonal permit that requires
the monthly  average values of  effluent  ammonium
nitrogen and TP  never to exceed  3.2 and  1 mg/l,
respectively. The ammonium nitrogen  limitation
applies from  May 1 through September 30. Process
loadings and  operational  parameters  were not
provided, but the facility was meeting  the  permit
limitations.

The influence of nitrate  nitrogen  in  the  anaerobic
stages and the anaerobic  stripper,  as  discussed
previously,  was evident at all four of these facilities. A
direct relationship was  noted between SP and nitrate
nitrogen concentrations  in  the  plant  effluents.
Increases  in nitrate  nitrogen  were followed by
increases in SP. At 10 mg/l of nitrate nitrogen, the SP
content of the effluents was approximately 0.5 mg/l.

7.3.3 Oxygen Requirements for Nitrification
When  either a  biological-chemical or  biological
phosphorus removal  process must also be retrofitted
to achieve  nitrification,  oxygen supply capability  must
bo considered. Calculation  of the consumption  of
oxygen by biological nitrification, as given previously
in  Equation 7-2, shows that for each 1  mg  of
ammonium nitrogen  oxidized to  nitrate nitrogen, 4.5
mg of oxygen will be required. This is in addition to
the oxygen demand  for  carbonaceous oxidation and
the  oxygen  required for meeting  the endogenous
demand of biomass.

In  a retrofit situation,  the anticipated peak  oxygen
requirement  anticipated from  these  combined
demands should be evaluated against the capability of
the existing aeration  system to transfer this amount of
oxygen.

7.4 Dual  Phosphorus   Removal   and
Nitrogen Removal Processes
If  a facility must remove both phosphorus and
nitrogen  to meet effluent requirements,  the retrofit
decisions  will  have  to  be  carefully  tailored to the
numerical limits imposed. Numerous process options
are available  for  controlling both nitrogen and
phosphorus  with  a  wide  spectrum  of  overall
efficiencies.  An  effluent  specification that had
stringent limits, such as  0.2 mg/l  TP and 3 mg/l total
nitrogen, would dictate consideration of a multi-stage
biological  process  supplemented  with  chemical
additions. A less stringent effluent requirement, such
as 2 mg/l TP and 10 mg/l total nitrogen, would lead to
consideration of  managed  biological systems.
 Between these two  extremes are numerous options
that could be evaluated.

To effectively remove  both phosphorus and  nitrogen,
 any process must be  operated to control a  series of
 transformations. As  discussed in Chapter 2, influent
 phosphorus  forms   must be  converted  to
orthophosphate for efficient  insolubilization  by
chemicals or incorporation into cellular material.

For nitrogen removal to occur, the various unoxidized
forms  of  nitrogen  in  the influent  must  first  be
transformed into nitrate nitrogen. Then,  conditions
must  be arranged  for  biological  denitrification to
convert the nitrate  nitrogen to nitrogen gas. For this
conversion, microorganisms utilize hydrogen  bound in
organic materials to combine with oxygen  from  the
nitrate radical. This is an oxidation/reduction reaction
with water,  carbon dioxide, nitrogen gas, and hydroxyl
ions as end products. Using methanol as an example
of organic matter, the reaction is:

  6NO3" + 5CH3OH -» 7H2O + 5CO2 + 3N2  + 6OH'
                                          (7-5)

The velocity of this reaction is dependent on the type
of  organic  substrate provided.  Materials  such as
methanol are very  soluble in wastewater and readily
utilized by  acclimated denitrifying  organisms.  In
addition, the  chemical  is available in pure form and
can be dosed into a denitrification process in a known
ratio to nitrate nitrogen.

Managed  biological processes  depend on  different
types  of  organics.  Some  utilize organics (BOD)
present in influent wastewater; others rely on organics
liberated  by  endogenous  hydrolysis  of cellular
organics present in biomass. The quality and quantity
of  these organics  are  largely unknown and can be
highly variable. The extent of biological utilization of
these  materials  is also subject  to  variability.
Generally,  these  types of organics have slower
reaction velocities  than materials  such as methanol.
However, no  implicit cost is associated  with  these
in-plant sources of organics.

The  trade-off that  must  be  evaluated  between
externally added materials like methanol and in-plant
organics  is  the  cost  of  chemical  and dosing
equipment for the former vs. biological  reactor size
and recycle pumping costs for the latter, coupled with
the effluent  total  nitrogen residual  and  degree of
compliance required. Retrofitting for removal of both
nitrogen and phosphorus at any facility that  was near
design hydraulic  and  organic  loadings,  no  matter
which option  was chosen,  would no doubt involve
capital construction.

7.4.1  Phosphorus and  Nitrogen  Removal  with
Multi-Stage  Biological Processes  Supplemented
with  Chemicals
Many examples of multi-stage, chemically-assisted
processes are provided in References 1  and 4.  The
data  base  for this technology is well established from
both  design and operational standpoints. The array of
process  options  is  large   because  various
combinations of  suspended and attached growth
biological processes,  operated  in series, have  been
                                                  114

-------
constructed.  The  most  complex  are  systems  with
separate  reactors for  carbonaceous  oxidation,
nitrification, and  denitrification,  each  with its  own
clarifier.  Other configurations combine carbonaceous
oxidation and nitrification in a single reactor and have
a separate stage for denitrification. The denitrification
reactor  has  been  designed   both  as  a  post-
denitrification  and  a  pre-denitrification process.  In
some systems, where an attached growth process is
included in the design, the provision for clarification
after this process may not be necessary.

Such a diversity  of process  options exists for these
systems that recitation  of  all  possibilities is not
possible. One example will be discussed to illustrate
this control technology. Reference 5 provides data on
two  municipal facilities  that were  designed  and
operated to comply with final effluent limitations  of 5
mg/l TBOD, 5 mg/l TSS,  1 mg/l TP, and 3 mg/l  total
nitrogen.   Both  employ  multi-stage  treatment.  A
schematic  of one of  the  facilities is given in  Figure
7-1 .

Influent flow  of 0.09  m3/s (2 mgd) is degritted and
routed to  a flow equalization tank.  Plant  personnel
consider  equalization  an  essential  feature to
stabilizing downstream  HRT,   SORs,  chemical
dosages, and filter  application rates.  Flow is pumped
at a constant rate to the first-stage,  complete mix
activated  sludge-clarifier  system. This   is  a
carbonaceous oxidation  process  that  reduces the
organic load on subsequent processes. Metal  salt is
dosed  to  the first-stage  reactor  to insolubilize the
major  fraction of  influent  phosphorus,  which  is
removed in the waste  activated sludge.

Second-stage  rotating biological  contactors provide
attached   growth  nitrification  of the  first-stage
activated sludge effluent.  Since the organic load to
the contactors is very  low and nitrifiers have a low net
cell yield, there is  little solids production in this unit
operation  and,  therefore,  no  need to  provide
clarification.

Nitrified effluent passes  to a third-stage, plug flow,
suspended growth denitrification reactor that receives
a dose of methanol  in  proportion  to  the nitrate
nitrogen content.  Mixing  is provided by  submerged,
low-speed  impeller mixers  to prevent  turbulence.
Nitrogen  is  removed as  nitrogen  gas  by  the
denitrification reaction.  Any  nitrogen  gas  bubbles
adhering to sludge particles  are  scrubbed from the
reactor  flow as it  passes through a  flash aeration
chamber. A small dose of metal salt is added to this
chamber to insolubilize any remaining SP,  which  is
then removed via the  third-stage waste sludge
stream.

At the  final clarifier,  polymer  dosing capability  is
provided on an as-needed  basis  in the event  that
sludge settleability  problems are  encountered.  The
clarifier overflow  is further polished by dual media,
gravity  flow filters  to  ensure compliance with  the
stringent effluent standards.

Waste  activated sludge  and  waste  denitrification
sludges are digested  aerobically. Decanting is done
on  a batch basis. Insolubilized metal  phosphate,
precipitated in  the sludges, does not  resolubilize
during  aerobic  digestion. After conditioning,  the
digested sludge is applied to agricultural land.

On a yearly basis,  using  monthly average data,  the
facility  achieves compliance  with  the  1-mg/l  TP
limitation 90 percent of the time and complies with
the 3-mg/l  total  nitrogen requirement 95  percent of
the time.

7.4.2 Phosphorus and  Nitrogen  Removal with
Managed Biological Systems
Currently, no large  reservoir  of full-scale  operational
experience is available with biological processes that
cycle biomass  through managed environments  to
achieve  both nitrogen and  phosphorus  removal  to
meet prescribed effluent limitations.

Reference  3 states that three  full-scale facilities
(Lansdale,  PA;  Reedy  Creek, FL; and  DePere,  Wl)
practicing dual  biological  phosphorus  removal and
nitrification  did exhibit  significant degrees of overall
nitrogen removal. This  was attributed to unintentional
denitrification of  nitrate nitrogen  in recycle  streams
entering anaerobic zones of the processes.

A large  number of process configurations  have been
evaluated for  biological phosphorus and nitrogen
removal, many  only   in  laboratory  or  pilot-scale
studies. The three  that have received  considerable
attention   in   the   United   States  are   the
Anaerobic/Anoxic/Oxic (A2O) process, the  Bardenpho
process, and a  modified  PhoStrip process. These
processes  will  be presented  and  discussed  in
subsequent sections.

As  noted in  Chapter  2,  for biological  phosphorus
removal, the wastewater  should  have  a SBOD-to-
SP ratio of at least 10 to  15. With the dual process
approach,  incorporating denitrification, the  ratio  of
TBOD to total  Kjeldahl  nitrogen (TKN) also becomes
important. Reference 6 recommends that the ratio of
TBOD  to TKN be 5  to  10. It  is  important with
managed nutrient control  processes,  which are  not
provided with supplemental organic  compounds, that
the influent wastewater  contain enough organic matter
to  enable the denitrification reaction between nitrate
and  organics to  occur. If the TBOD-to-TKN  ratio
were lower, greater concentrations of nitrate  nitrogen
would appear in the final effluent.

It should be noted in  the  following process flow
diagrams that all of   these  dual control systems
recover  some of the oxygen contained in  the nitrate
                                                 115

-------
Figure 7-1.   Multi-stage biological process supplemented with chemicals for combined nitrogen and phosphorus removal.
Metal Salt Motet
Storage Purr
i__j"'i
Dogrittod
Wastowater ^
Eq.
— \
— \
Flow
jalizc
Methanol 	
infl Storage! 1 , v
p i__j W
_w/lRt-PtaOp 1 fel fSlnrifier \ 	 *,
I AS y l 7 "
/ >
ition T

2nd-
Stage
RBC


!
t
3rd-Stage
Suspended
Growth
Denitrification
Poly
Stor<


Return Slu

ner. 	 , __
aae i i 	 j
i i "
•*
Flash j,
Aeration *"
d_ge


f
i
/^
» Final
V Clarifier
^-—r---'

                      Return
                      Sludge
[_        	^3?t?_?Jyf!9§ Streams	
                                To Head
                                 Works •
                                            Decant
               Wastewater

               Sludge

               Chemicals
                                    Digested
                                    Sludge
                                               - To Land
                                                                 Final
                                                                Effluent
radical via recycle of internal  streams into an anoxic
stage. Also important to note  is the fact that the last
reactor stage in all these systems is an aerobic (oxic)
stage  where  nitrification  occurs.  Theoretically,  this
indicates  that unless high internal  recycle rates and
extensive  baffling  are  employed  along  with  long
HRTs, these systems cannot achieve as low a final
effluent nitrate  nitrogen  content  as a  multi-stage
system with  a chemically  supplemented terminal
denitrification reactor.
Both biological nitrification and biological denitrification
transformations  are  affected  by  wastewater
temperature.  Data  on temperature  coefficients for
multi-stage systems from  pilot-  and  full-scale
studies are included in  Reference  1.  However,
temperature data  for dual biological systems  in  a
variety of options are not extensive.
In dual biological  phosphorus and nitrogen  removal
applications, the biomass has to be managed to
balance two opposing microbial population selection
objectives. Biological  phosphorus  removal is
dependent on excess sludge production by a group of
organisms that  can survive extremes  of  DO
concentration.  Increased rates  of  sludge  production
are favored by a short SRT.

Since denitrification must be preceded by nitrification,
conditions for  survival of nitrifiers must be provided.
                        These organisms require an aerobic environment and
                        have a low growth rate, which mandates a long SRT.

                        At the present time, due  to the lack of  a large data
                        base on  the influence of  wastewater  quality  and
                        component ratios, the magnitude of internal recycle
                        streams  necessary  to  achieve  a  given  effluent
                        residual, temperature effects on dual processes, and
                        the need to balance  SRT, it is recommended that any
                        retrofit  for these  systems be  guided by  pilot  plant
                        studies.
                        7.4.2.7 Phosphorus and Nitrogen Removal with
                        the A2/O Process
                        The A2/O process configuration is presented in Figure
                        7-2. It is similar to the A/O  process (Figure 2-12),
                        except that an anoxic stage is inserted  between the
                        anaerobic stage and the oxic stage.

                        The system must be designed and operated to obtain
                        phosphorus  leaching  in  the anaerobic stage  and
                        subsequent biological cellular uptake in  the following
                        aerobic  stage.  The SRT of  the  biomass must be
                        selected to ensure a steady-state population of
                        nitrifiers at the  design  temperature.  The  detention
                        time  of the aerobic  stage must  be  sufficient to
                        accomplish nitrification  and organic  oxidation  in  this,
                        the only aerated portion of the process.
                                                  116

-------
Figure 7-2.  Schematic of an activated sludge system retrofitted for the A2/O process.
Polymer Me
Storage P
i — -i ^^
1 ' (
1 !•--»
1 1 f~*
i 	 1 t 	
Degritted
Wastewater
'
i i ."
i r f
i 	 1 L.
tering
jmp
J
t
A


^/ Pfjnfiarv i h^
k. V Clar
i
Primary i
-\
ifier I *
r
Sludge
L

Anaerobic
Stage




Anoxic
Stage
Return Sludge


Recycle
Aerob
Stag
'




ic i J Final \ Effluent ^
rl Clarifier 1 w
" ^^~\
'
TF
Waste
Activated
Sludge

Final
Effluent
TP
mg/l
2
1
0.5
0.2
Probable Need
for
Chemical Addition

None
Occasional
Continuous polish dose
Continuous polish dose
Final
Clarifier
SOR"
gpf/sq ft
800
600
500
500
* at peak sustained flow
                                                                   Approximate final nitrogen concentrations (mg/l):
                                                                      Organic-N:
                                                                      NH4-N:
                                                                      NO2-N:
                                                                      NO3-N:
                                   3.5
                                   1
                                   0.1
                                   6
Nitrified mixed liquor is recycled to the anoxic  stage
where biological  denitrification occurs in response to
organics  (BOD)  entering  this  stage  from  the
anaerobic  stage. By recycling mixed  liquor  from the
aerobic to the anoxic stage for  denitrification,  the
negative influence  of nitrate  nitrogen  on phosphorus
leaching   in  the  anaerobic stage  is somewhat
alleviated,  as  only nitrate contained  in the  return
sludge enters the anaerobic stage. Thus, in  the A2/0
process, denitrification  can occur  in both  the  anoxic
and anaerobic stages.

The  influent  to  the anaerobic  stage must contain
organics for two  purposes: first, to serve as  substrate
to  be  sorbed  by  the  phosphorus-accumulating
organisms, and,   second,  to  serve as  organic
substrate  for  anaerobic stage denitrification  of  return
sludge  nitrate, which in turn reduces the  negative
influence of nitrate on  phosphorus leaching. Enough
organic  material must pass through  the anaerobic
stage to the anoxic stage, however, so that  reduction
of nitrate  in the  recycle mixed liquor  is not  inhibited.
Consideration  may be given to bypassing  all  or  a
portion of the raw  wastewater  around the primary
Clarifier to increase the organic concentration entering
the anaerobic stage if the influent wastewater has a
low organic content.

Depending on the magnitude  of  the two recycle
streams, the  A2/O process recovers some fraction of
the oxygen content of the nitrate radical. Additionally,
the denitrification  reactions in the  anaerobic  and
anoxic  stages will create alkalinity  to help  offset
downstream  alkalinity loss  due  to  nitrification  and
metal salt addition, if required.

Operational  control  must  be  utilized  to manage
reactor influent organic concentration, select the rates
of the  two recycle  streams,  and maintain  proper
environmental conditions within each  stage  and
appropriate sludge wasting schedules. It  should be
noted that as the magnitude of these internal recycles
increases,  the  more  closely  the  bioreactor
approaches a complete mix  process, with increasing
loss of environmental control of the separate stages.
The effect of  in-plant  recycles,  such  as  sludge
processing and handling supernatants or filtrates,
needs  to be evaluated regarding their  impact on
organic, phosphorus, and nitrogen  loadings received
by the bioreactor.
                                                   117

-------
To  achieve an effluent TP concentration of 2 mg/l
with the A2/O process, metal  salt addition  would
probably not be  needed. To  achieve 1 mg/l might
require  occasional polish dosing. To  achieve  0.5 or
0.2 mg/l would probably require  continuous  polish
dosing.

7.4.2.2  Phosphorus  and  Nitrogen  Removal with
the Bardenpho Process
Inspection  of Figure 7-3 shows that  the Bardenpho
process  has a similar configuration to the  A2/O
process; however,  it is segmented  into a greater
number of stages.

The lead  stage is an  anaerobic  stage  where
phosphorus leaching from  the microorganisms must
occur. This is followed  by four  alternate stages that
are  managed to  provide  anoxic  and  aerobic
environments. The first anoxic stage is the site of the
major denitrification reaction. In  the  first aerobic
stage, biological phosphorus cellular uptake, oxidation
of ammonium  nitrogen, and  oxidation of organics
occur.

The subsequent  anoxic and  aerobic  stages are
essentially  polishing stages to  provide low effluent
residual total nitrogen and efficient organic  removal.
Any denitrification occurring in the second  anoxic
stage is due to the endogenous oxygen demand of
the mixed  liquor since there is no  direct  input of
organics to this stage. Thus, three locations exist in
the  Bardenpho  system where denitrification  can
occur: the  anaerobic, first anoxic, and  second  anoxic
stages.  Nitrification and organic oxidation can occur in
the two  aerobic stages.

As  with  the A2/O process, the Bardenpho process
has an  interstage recycle  between the first aerobic
and anoxic stages for denitrification and reduction of
the  influence  of nitrate nitrogen on phosphorus
leaching in the anaerobic stage. The anaerobic stage
receives only nitrate contained in the return sludge.

The highly  baffled configuration approaching plug flow
and the presence  of the  two internal recycles are
conducive  to  the reuse of oxygen from the  nitrate
radical.  Operating and  environmental  constraints for
managing biological phosphorus and nitrogen removal
discussed  in the  section for the A2/O process apply
equally  well to the Bardenpho process. Likewise, the
influence  of  in-plant  recycle streams  must  be
evaluated.

Some  descriptions of the  Bardenpho process label
the  first stage in the process  a  fermentation zone
instead  of an anaerobic  stage. In reality, the biological
transformations that occur  in  this reactor, whether
labeled  fermentation zone or anaerobic stage, are the
same. The fermentation zone concept originated  at
facilities where the wastewater was weak in organic
content. The purpose of this  fermentation zone was
to provide an  anaerobic  operation where particulate
organics  in influent wastewater could be hydrolyzed
(fermented) to  short-chain  fatty acids,  such  as
acetate (7). As previously discussed, soluble organics
must  be present  in the initial anaerobic  stage  for
sorption  by  the  phosphorus-accumulating
microorganisms.

The need for the presence of short-chain fatty acids
in the anaerobic  stage  of  all biological  phosphorus
uptake processes, not just the Bardenpho process,
has  been established  (7). Various  operational
approaches have been applied to ensure that these
materials are present. These include

1. adding  increments  of  primary  sludge  to  the
   anaerobic stage (8),

2. recycling  in-plant streams such as thickener
   overflow to the anaerobic stage (9),

3. infrequent mixing of the anaerobic stage to allow
   sludge deposition  and subsequent hydrolysis of
   the sludge (10),

4. provision of an off-line fermentation  reactor  for
   biological hydrolysis of primary sludge to produce
   fatty acids  to be dosed into the anaerobic stage
   (11), and

5. addition of anaerobic digester supernatant to  the
   anaerobic stage (2).

For the  Bardenpho process, Figure 7-3  indicates
that attainment of  an effluent TP concentration of 1
mg/l may require an occasional supplemental  dose of
a metal  salt  and  that a continuous polish dose of
metal  salt will probably be  required to  attain  an
effluent  TP  concentration  of  0.5 mg/l  or less.
Attainment of an effluent total nitrogen concentration
of 1.5 mg/l has  been reported for a 0.07-m3/s (1.7-
mgd)  municipal facility. The effluent TP concentration
was 3 mg/l (10).

7.4.2.3 Phosphorus  and  Nitrogen Removal with
the University of Capetown  (UCT) Process
The UCT process  was developed at the University of
Capetown, Capetown,  South Africa  (12).  A flow
schematic is given in Figure 7-4.  There are currently
no known installations  of the UCT process in  the
United States.

The  process  is akin to the  A2/O and  Bardenpho
processes. However, two  interstage  recycles   are
incorporated in the process flowsheet instead of one.
As with  the A2/O  and Bardenpho processes, mixed
liquor is recycled from the aerobic stage to the anoxic
stage, but to protect the anaerobic stage from nitrate
inhibition  of phosphorus leaching,  an   engineering
modification was made. Return sludge is directed into
the anoxic stage instead of the anaerobic stage and
                                                  118

-------
Figure 7-3.  Schematic of an activated sludge system retrofitted for the Bardenpho process.
     Polymer Metering
     Storage  Pump
         [._.(  1.
         i   /~v
        _j   t—i
       Degritted
     Wastewater
                                 Anaerobic
                                   Stage
                                     i Recycle
                                    Anoxic
                                    Stage
Aerobic
 Stage
Anoxic
Stage
Aerobic
 Stage
                                       Return Sludge
                  Primary Sludge
Effluent
                                                                          Waste
                                                                         Activated
                                                                          Sludge
I	1   L	1
   Metal Salt  Metering
   Storage    Pump
                                                                                               Existing

                                                                                               Retrofit
Final
Effluent
TP
mg/l
2
1
0.5
0.2
* at peak
Probable Need
for
Chemical Addition
None
Occasional
Continuous polish dose
Continuous polish dose
sustained flow
Final
Clarifier
SOR*
gpf/sq ft
800
600
500
500


Approximate final
Organic-N:
NH4-N:
NO2-N:
NO3-N:
nitrogen concentrations (mg/l):
3.5
1
0.1
5
then mixed liquor from the anoxic stage is recycled to
the anaerobic stage.

In  evaluating this  process for  possible  retrofit
applications, careful consideration should be given to
the detention times of the various stages since a high
degree of recycling  within the reactor could greatly
alter the  maintenance of proper  stage  environmental
conditions and substrate utilization rates.

Metal  salt addition would probably not  be needed to
achieve an effluent  TP concentration of 2 mg/l. To
achieve 1 mg/l might require occasional dosing. To
achieve 0.5 or 0.2 mg/l would require a continuous
polish dose.

7,4.2.4 Phosphorus and Nitrogen Removal  with
the Modified PhoStrip  Process
A modification of the PhoStrip process that provides
for biological  denitrification  of the nitrate  nitrogen
contained in  the return  sludge  flow is  discussed in
Reference  13.  This  modification  is  presented
schematically  in Figure 7-5.

The modification retains all the features of the original
PhoStrip  process as  previously described.  For
                                                 implementing removal of nitrogen,  the  main  stream
                                                 activated sludge system would have to be operated to
                                                 achieve nitrification.  The nitrate in the return  sludge
                                                 flow  is  directed to an  anoxic reactor ahead  of the
                                                 anaerobic stripper tank.

                                                 The denitrification rate is dependent on the hydrolysis
                                                 of organics due to  endogenous  respiration since  a
                                                 nitrified  return  sludge stream has very little  soluble
                                                 organics present.  Consideration  could  be  given to
                                                 providing a bypass line to introduce primary effluent
                                                 directly into the  anoxic  reactor  to  increase  the
                                                 denitrification rate.

                                                 The anoxic reactor is sized larger  than the quantity of
                                                 flow  required for  the anaerobic  stripping of  return
                                                 sludge  for phosphorus  removal.   A portion  of the
                                                 anoxic denitrified flow is routed directly back to the
                                                 aeration tank. Denitrification of the return sludge flow
                                                 in this  modification also  serves  to  protect the
                                                 anaerobic stripper  phosphorus leaching reaction from
                                                 the inhibiting  action of nitrate.

                                                 Theoretically,  Figure 7-5  indicates   that  the
                                                 denitrification removal capability of this  modification
                                                 would be limited to  the percentage of return  sludge
                                                    119

-------
Figure 7-4.  Schematic of an activated sludge system retrofitted for the UCT process.
     Polymer Metering
     Storage  Pump
      Degritted
     Wastewater
                 _wi  Primary
                 ^  Clarifier
                                           xRecycle 1 I  ^ Recycle 2]
Anaerobic
 Stage
Anoxic
Stage
Aerobic
 Stage
                                      Return Sludge
                  Primary Sludge

          l-O-
E«luent
                                           Waste
                                          Activated
                                           Sludge
       ;	1   /—\
   Metal Salt  Metering
   Storage    Pump
                                                         Existing

                                                         Retrofit
Final
Effluent
TP
mg/l
2
1
0.5
0.2
Probable Need
for
Chemical Addition

None
Occasional
Continuous polish dose
Continuous polish dose
Final
Clarifier
SOR'
. gpf/sq ft
800
600
500
500
* at peak sustained flow
                                                                   Approximate final nitrogen concentrations (mg/l):
                                                                      Organic-N:
                                                                      NH4-N:
                                                                      NO2-N:
                                                                      NO3-N:
                                                      3.5
                                                      1
                                                      0.1
                                                      5
flow. For instance, if the return flow were 50 percent
of  the influent plant flow, the  amount of  nitrate
nitrogen that could be denitrified would be 0.5/1.5, or
33 percent. However, it has been reported (13) that a
pilot plant operated in this mode denitrified 70 percent
of  the nitrate  nitrogen present. The  incremental
removal was attributed to coincidental denitrification in
the nitrifying  activated  sludge system. This  agrees
rather  well with  results presented  elsewhere  (2),
where a full-scale PhoStrip plant producing a nitrified
effluent with  no anoxic  reactor achieved an overall
nitrogen removal of 31 percent.

Currently, there are no known  U.S. installations of the
PhoStrip process modified for biological denitrification.
Since the PhoStrip process is a sidestream process,
there is  no apparent reason  that it  should  not  be
compatible with a  variety of  mainstream biological
denitrification processes.

Metal salt addition would probably not be needed to
achieve effluent TP concentrations of 2, 1 or 0.5 mg/l.
To achieve 0.2 mg/l, an occasional polish dose might
be required.
                   7.5 References

                   1.  Process  Design  Manual  for  Nitrogen Control.
                       U.S. EPA, Technology Transfer,  Cincinnati, OH,
                       October 1975.

                   2.  Tetreault, M.J., A.H.  Benedict, C. Kaempfer, and
                       E. F. Barth.  Biological  Phosphorus Removal: A
                       Technology Evaluation. JWPCF 58:823, 1986.

                   3.  Kang, S.J.,  P.J.  Horvatin,  and L.  Briscoe. Full-
                       Scale Biological Phosphorus Removal Using A/0
                       Process  in a Cold Climate. Proceedings of the
                       International Conference: Management Strategies
                       for  Phosphorus  in  the Environment,  Lisbon,
                       Portugal.  Published  by Selper,  Ltd., London,
                       England,  ISBN 0-948411-00-7,  1985.

                   4.  Wastewater  Engineering: Treatment, Disposal,
                       Reuse.  Revised by George  Tchnobanoglous.
                       McGraw-Hill  Book  Company, New York,  NY,
                       2nd Edition, 1979.

                   5.  T.  Comfort  and   L.  Good.   Nitrogen  and
                       Phosphorus  Control by Two Facilities in  Florida.
                                                   120

-------
Figure 7-5.   Schematic of activated sludge system retrofitted for the modified Bardenpho process.
       Degritted
     Wastewater
                                                 • Nitrifying
                                               Activated Sludge
                                                 Aeration tank
Effluent
                                            Return Sludge
                                                                (2a)
                               (7)
                    Primary Sludge
                                                 ..,  (6)
                                                                  (3)
                                                                         J r — n  (1)
                                                                         J i    i4-i_'.

                                                                        "•T (2) !
                                             (5)
                                                                                     Waste Activated
                                                                                        Sludge
i --- 1
i   i
              _
           i  /  i
           —
                                                                                                Existing

                                                                                                Retrofit
  Legend

  (1)   Portion of return sludge going to anoxic tank.
  (2)   Anoxic tank for return sludge flow
  (2a)  Portion of denitrified return sludge flow.
  (3)   Anaerobic stripper tank for leaching of phosphorus.
  (4)   Stripper tank overflow.
  (5)   Stripper tank underflow returned to activated sludge aeration tank.
  (6)   Tank containing lime slurry to precipitate phosphorus leached from return sludge in anaerobic stripper.
       Lime dose (CaO)  = 20-25 mg/l based on plant flow
  (7)   Insolubilized phosphorus returned to primary for co-settling with primary sludge.
  (8)   Lime storage.
  (9)   Lime slurry  tank.
  (10)  Pump for transfer of lime slurry to phosphorus precipitating tank.
Final
Effluent
TP
mg/l
2
1
0.5
0.2
* at peak
Probable Need
for
Chemical Addition
None
None
None
Occasional
sustained flow
Final
Clarifier
SOR"
gpf/sq ft
800
600
500
500


Approximate final
Organic-N:
NH4-N:
NO2-N:
NO3-N:
nitrogen concentrations (mg/l):
3.5
1
0.1
6
    EPA-600/2-79-075,  NTIS  No.  PB80-118813,
    U.S. EPA, Cincinnati, OH, July 1979.

 6.  Evans,  B.  and  P.  Crawford.  Introduction  of
    Biological Nutrient Removal in Canada. Presented
    at  Technology Transfer  Seminar on  Biological
    Phosphorus Removal, Sponsored by Environment
    Canada,  Burlington,  Ontario, Held  at Penticton,
    British Columbia,  Canada, April 1985.

 7.  Summary  Report  of Workshop on  Biological
    Phosphorus  Removal in  Municipal Wastewater
    Treatment.  Prepared  by  R.   L.  Irvine  and
    Associates, Inc.,  Sponsored by U.S. EPA, Water
    Engineering Research Laboratory, Cincinnati, OH,
    Held at Annapolis, MD, September 1982.
                                                        8.   Stensel,  D.,  N. Sakakibara,  D.R.  Refling,  and
                                                            C.R. Burdick.  Performance of First U.S. Full-
                                                            Scale   Bardenpho  Facility.  Presented   at
                                                            International Seminar on  Control  of Nutrients in
                                                            Municipal Wastewater  Effluents,  Sponsored  by
                                                            U.S. EPA, Cincinnati,  OH, Held at  San Diego, CA,
                                                            September 1980.

                                                        9.   Barnard,  J.   Activated  Primary Tanks  for
                                                            Phosphate  Removal.  Water-South  Africa,
                                                            10:121, 1984.

                                                        10. Nasr, S. and K. Knickerbocker. Biological Nutrient
                                                            Removal - Payson,  Arizona.  Presented at  the
                                                            58th Annual  Conference  of the  Water  Pollution
                                                     121

-------
   Control  Federation,  Kansas City, MO,  October
   1985.

11. Seyen, J., P. LeFlohic, G.M. Faup, M. Meganck,
   and  J.C. Block. A Separate  Acetate Producing
   Reactor to Improve Biological  Phosphorus
   Removal.  Proceedings of  the International
   Conference:  Managment  Strategies  for
   Phosphorus in the Environment, Lisbon,  Portugal.
   Published by Selper, Ltd., London, England, ISBN
   0-948411-00-7,  1985.

12. Siebritz,  I.P., G.  Ekama,  and G.vR. Marais.  A
   Parametric  Model for   Biological  Excess
   Phosphorus Removal. Presented at IAWPR Post
   Conference on Phosphate  Removal in Biological
   Treatment Processes, Pretoria, South Africa, April
   5, 1982.

13. Match,  L.C.  and  R.F. Drnevich. PhoStrip;  A
   Biological-Chemical System  for  Removing
   Phosphorus. Advances in Water  and Wastewater
   Treatment:  Biological Nutrient  Removal, Edited by
   M. Wanielista  and W.W.  Eckenfelder,  Jr.,  Ann
   Arbor Science Publishers,  Inc.,  Ann Arbor, Ml,
   1978.
                                               122

-------
                                              Chapters
                Estimating Costs for Chemical Phosphorus Removal in the CBDB
8.1 Introduction

This chapter contains cost data sheets (Figures 8-1
through 8-8) that  summarize  the estimated  capital,
annual alum  and polymer, and total annual costs to
retrofit existing  treatment  plants in  the CBDB to
achieve phosphorus removal by  means  of chemical
treatment.  These  are  incremental  costs over  and
above the current costs to build and operate plants in
the CBDB. The costs of pH instrumentation  and
controls, additional clarification capacity, increased
sludge conditioning and handling capacities, additional
building space for housing  chemicals and chemical
feed  equipment,  and  effluent  filtration are  not
included. The need for these items will be dictated by
site-specific conditions such as present capacities of
unit processes, wastewater  quality, the existing
sludge  handling scheme, the  phosphorus removal
option selected, and applicable  effluent  limitations,
among others.

Depending on the degree of excess sludge handling
capacity available  at a specific treatment plant  and
the type of sludge handling  and disposal methods in
use, only minor increases in capital and O&M costs
may  be necessary to process and  dispose of the
greater quantities  of sludge resulting from chemical
phosphorus removal. Conversely,  if a plant is  already
operating  at or near  its existing  sludge handling
capacity  and  new  sludge handling  and disposal
facilities must be built to accommodate the increased
amounts of sludge produced, significant expenditures
may be required.

Since the need for additional sludge handling capacity
must  be  determined on a  case-by-case  basis,
generalized cost estimates associated with increased
sludge production resulting from chemical phosphorus
removal  could be misleading.  For  this  reason,  cost
estimates  to retrofit  existing plants to chemical
phosphorus  removal  are limited  in this chapter to
capital and O&M requirements directly related to the
storage and feeding of chemicals.

The  chemical  retrofit  costs summarized in  Figures
8-1 through  8-8 apply to all  of  the  treatment  plant
categories found  in the  CBDB  except  wastewater
lagoons. These categories include:
  plug flow activated sludge,
  step aeration activated sludge,
  complete mix activated sludge,
  contact stabilization activated  sludge,
  pure oxygen activated sludge,
  single-stage nitrifying activated sludge,
  two-stage nitrifying activated  sludge,
  extended aeration,
  oxidation ditches,
  standard-rate trickling filters,
  high-rate trickling filters,  and
  RBCs.
Four of the cost data sheets (Figures 8-1 through
8-4), one  for each of the effluent TP  limitations  (2,
1, 0.5, and 0.2 mg/l) considered in this manual, were
developed for an influent TP concentration range of 6
to 10 mg/l. The other four cost data sheets (Figures
8-5  through 8-8) were  developed for  the  same
effluent  TP  limitations,  but  an  influent TP
concentration range of 3 to 6 mg/l.

Eighteen of the  operating plants  included  in Tables
3-1  through  3-13  use  alum   for   chemical
phosphorus removal. For nine of these 18, the annual
chemical costs of alum and polymer fall within the
appropriate  ranges  of  theoretical  annual alum and
polymer costs shown  in  Figures  8-1  through 8-8.
The  annual chemical costs for the other nine  plants
are less than those predicted by these figures.  These
comparisons indicate that an inherent conservatism is
built  into a theoretical stoichiometric dosing approach.
The  annual chemical cost  curves presented in this
chapter, therefore,  should  represent  an  adequate
chemicals  O&M   budget  for chemical phosphorus
removal planning purposes for virtually all  conceivable
wastewater  characteristics  and  influent  conditions
based on current chemical pricing structures.

In meeting 0.5- and  0.2-mg/l TP  effluent limitations,
it is realized that substantial  additional costs could be
involved in providing  for improved  effluent suspended
solids removals.  This is particularly true for high-rate
trickling filters, which  also  might  require  additional
biological  reactor capacity  to  effectively insolubilize
phosphorus to low effluent levels.  Estimating average
incremental costs  for these site-  and situation-
specific requirements is impractical and  beyond the
                                                 123

-------
Figure 8-1.  Estimated chemical phosphorus removal costs for an  influent TP range of 6 - 10 mg/l  and  an effluent TP
           limitation of 2 mg/l.
                     Annual Alum and Polymer Cost
                                    Total Annual Cost*

                      10 I	1	1	T
                       100,000    200,000

                               $/year
300,000
100,000    200,000

        $/year
                                                                                               300,000
   1 Sum ol the annual alum and polymer cost and the amortized chemical system capital cost. Costs associated with sludge treatment and
    disposal are not included.
                                              Plant
                                              Size
                                              mgd

                                             < o.i
                                            0.1 -1
                                            > i -5
                                            >5 -10
             Chemical System
               Capital Cost
                  $

                34,000
                54,000
               130,000
               170,000
 scope  of this  handbook.  Rather,  the designer  is
 advised to carefully evaluate the potential  impact  of
 effluent polishing on the total cost of any anticipated
 retrofit project.

 As  indicated previously in Chapter 2,  a theoretical
 model  being developed from research  currently  in
 progress  (1,2) predicts  that  metal  ion  dose
 requirements to attain low  effluent TP concentrations
 of  <1  mg/l  are  independent  of  influent  TP
 concentration.  Published data confirming this model
 are lacking at this time. In  the absence of such data,
 the cost curves presented in this  chapter are based
 on  conventional  metal  ion-to-influent  TP  dose
 relationships for  all  four effluent TP limitations
 considered in this document. If the above theory (1,2)
 is eventually verified,  Rgure  8-3 (0.5-mg/l  effluent
             TP limit at influent TP of 6-10 mg/l) and Figure 8-7
             (0.5-mg/l  effluent TP  limit at influent TP of  3-6
             mg/l) would appropriately be merged  into one  figure
             as  would Figure  8-4 (0.2-mg/l effluent TP limit at
             influent TP  of 6-10  mg/l)  and Figure  8-8  (0.2-mg/l
             effluent TP limit at influent TP  of 3-6 mg/l)

             Estimated costs  for  retrofitting existing plants  using
             biological  phosphorus  removal processes are  not
             provided in this manual because each  retrofit must be
             uniquely designed and  the necessary  modifications
             can range from minimal to  considerable.  Usually, no
             significant net increase is  experienced  in  operation
             and maintenance costs when a biological phosphorus
             removal system is installed. License fees are required
             for some biological phosphorus removal processes.
             The amount of the  fees is determined on a  case-
                                                    124

-------
Figure 8-2.  Estimated chemical phosphorus removal costs for an influent TP range of  6  - 10 mg/1 and an effluent TP
           limitation of 1 mg/l.
                     Annual Alum and Polymer Cost
                                                                              Total Annual Cosf
                       150,000    300,000

                               $/year
450,000
150,000    300,000

        $/year
                                                                                                450,000
    Sum of the annual alum and polymer cost and the amortized chemical system capital cost. Costs associated with sludge treatment and
    disposal are not included.
                                              Plant
                                              Size
                                              mgd

                                             < 0.1
                                            0.1 -1
                                            > 1 -5
                                            >5 -10
             Chemical System
               Capital Cost
                  $

                34,000
                54,000
               130,000
               170,000
 by-case basis by the process  patent holders. These
 fees can sometimes be substantial and may preclude
 the use of a specific process.


 8.2 Illustrative Example
 Figures  8-1  through 8-8  each  contain  a graph
 showing a range of annual alum and polymer costs as
 a function of plant size,  a graph showing a range of
 total annual costs as a function of plant size, and a
 tabulation of estimated capital costs for four plant size
 ranges. For  example, Figure  8-1  presents the  cost
 data for chemical  phosphorus  removal  for an influent
 TP concentration of 6 to 10 mg/l and an effluent TP
 limitation of 2. mg/l. To  estimate the capital, annual
 alum and polymer, and total annual costs for a 0.18-
             m3/s  (4-mgd) plant with these influent and effluent
             conditions, the reader would proceed as follows:

             Using the capital cost tabulation, the capital cost to
             retrofit any plant between 0.04 and  0.18 m3/s (1  and
             5 mgd) is approximately  $130,000. This cost includes
             construction,  engineering, legal,  and  administrative
             fees, and contingencies. This cost is for the chemical
             storage, feed, and distribution system only.

             Moving to the  first graph,  the annual  alum  and
             polymer cost would range  between  $100,000  and
             $125,000 per year. As noted in Chapter 3, the cost
             of ferric chloride or ferrous  chloride would  be lower
             than the cost of alum. Therefore, the costs presented
             here are conservative.
                                                    125

-------
Figure 8-3.   Estimated chemical phosphorus removal costs  for an influent TP range of 6  - 10 mg/l and an effluent TP
            limitation of 0.5 mg/l.
                     Annual Alum and Polymer Cost
                                    Total Annual Cost*
                      200,000    400,000

                              $/year
600,000
200,000    400,000

        $/year
600,000
   ' Sum of the annual alum and polymer cost and the amortized chemical system capital cost. Costs associated with sludge treatment and
   disposal are not included.
                                             Plant
                                             Size
                                             mgd

                                             < 0.1
                                            0.1 -1
                                            > 1 -5
                                            >5-10
            Chemical System
              Capital Cost
                  $

                34,000
                54,000
               145,000
               170,000
The second graph shows the estimated total annual
cost. This graph is  based  on  an assumed annual
capital  cost  of  10 percent (based  on  8  percent
interest over a 20-year period) of the original capital
cost ($13,000 in  this  case) plus the annual alum  and
polymer cost range  ($100,000  to $125,000 in  this
case). In this example, the estimated total annual cost
would range  between  $113,000 and  $138,000  per
year.
             8.3 References

             1.  Personal  communication from  R.I. Sedlak,  The
                Soap and Detergent Association, New York, NY,
                to R.C. Brenner, U.S. EPA, Cincinnati, OH,  May
                20, 1987.

             2.  Personal  communication  from  D.  Jenkins,
                University  of California,  Berkeley,  CA, to  S.J.
                Kang,  McNamee, Porter and Seeley,  Ann  Arbor,
                Ml, July 31, 1987.
                                                   126

-------
Figure 8-4.   Estimated chemical  phosphorus  removal costs for an  influent TP range of 6 - 10  mg/l  and an  effluent TP
             limitation of 0.2 mg/l.
                        Annual Alum and Polymer Cost
                                                                                         Total Annual Cost"
                          400,000    800,000     1,200,000

                                   $/year
                   400,000     800,000     1,200,000

                             $/year
     Sum of the annual alum and polymer cost and the amortized chemical system capital cost Costs associated with sludge treatment and
     disposal are not included.

                                                    Plant       Chemical System
                                            	Size	Capital Cost
                                                    mgd

                                                    < 0.1
                                                   0.1 -1
                                                   > 1 -5
                                                   >5-10
    $

 41,000
 87,000
185,000
200,000
                                                           127

-------
Figure 8-5.   Estimated chemical phosphorus removal costs for an influent TP range of 3 - 6 mg/l and an effluent TP limitation
             of 2 mg/l.
                        Annual Alum and Polymer Cost
                        Total Annual Cosf
                         60,000      120,000     180,000

                                  $/year
                    60,000     120,000     180,000

                             $/year
    Sum of the annual alum and polymer cost and the amortized chemical system capital cost. Costs associated with sludge treatment and
    disposal are not included.

                                                   Plant       Chemical System
                                            	Size	Capital Cost	
                                                    mgd

                                                   < 0.1
                                                  0.1 -1
                                                  > 1 -5
                                                  >5-10
 34,000
 54,000
115,000
160,000
                                                          128

-------
Figure 8-6.   Estimated chemical phosphorus removal costs for an influent TP range of 3 - 6 mg/l and an effluent TP limitation
             of 1 mg/l.
                        Annual Alum and Polymer Cost
                                                                                          Total Annual Cost*
                          80,000     160,000

                                   $/year
240,000
80,000     160,000

         $/year
                                                                                                             240,000
    Sum of the annual alum and polymer cost and the amortized chemical system capital cost Costs associated with sludge treatment and
    disposal are not included.
                                                    Plant
                                                    Size
                                                    mgd

                                                    < 0.1
                                                  0.1 -1
                                                  > 1 -5
                                                  >5 - 10
              Chemical System
                Capital Cost
                  34,000
                  54,000
                 115,000
                 160,000
                                                           129

-------
Figure 8-7.   Estimated chemical phosphorus removal costs for an influent TP range of 3 - 6 mg/l and an effluent TP limitation
             of 0.5 mg/l.
                        Annual Alum and Polymer Cost
                                        Total Annual Cost*
                         100,000     200,000

                                   $/year
300,000
100,000    200,000     300,000

         $/year
   1 Sum of the annual alum and polymer cost and the amortized chemical system capital cost. Costs associated with sludge treatment and
    disposal are not included.
                                                    Plant
                                                    Size
                                                    mgd

                                                   < O.i
                                                  0.1 -1
                                                  >  i -5
                                                  >5 - 10
              Chemical System
                Capital Cost
                    $

                  34,000
                  54,000
                 120,000
                 170,000
                                                           130

-------
Figure 8-8.   Estimated chemical phosphorus removal costs for an influent TP range of 3 - 6 mg/l and an effluent TP limitation
             of 0.2 mg/l.
                        Annual Alum and Polymer Cost
                                                                                         Total Annual Cost
                         250,000     500,000     750,000

                                   $/year
                    250,000    500,000     750,000

                             $/year
    Sum of the annual alum and polymer cost and the amortized chemical system capital cost. Costs associated with sludge treatment and
    disposal are not included.

                                                    Plant       Chemical System
                                            	Size	Capital Cost	
                                                    mgd

                                                    < 0.1
                                                  0.1 -1
                                                  > 1 - 5
                                                  >5 - 10
  .  $

 41,000
 79,000
185,000
200,000
                                                           131

-------

-------
                                            Chapter 9
           Factors Affecting Implementation of Phosphorus Removal in the CBDB
9.1 Introduction

The purpose of this chapter is to assist Chesapeake
Bay Area government officials  in visualizing the broad
factors involved in  implementing  a comprehensive
program of phosphorus removal in the CBDB.


9.2   Cost  to  Implement   Phosphorus
Removal
Based on the estimated costs  to remove phosphorus
by chemical  addition  given in   Chapter 8,  the
approximate  capital  costs to  retrofit CBDB plants
based on size,  influent  phosphorus concentration
range, and  effluent phosphorus   requirement  are
summarized in Table 9-1. To  put these  capital costs
in perspective, the approximate costs of constructing
secondary  treatment  plants  (without  phosphorus
removal) are also given.  The total costs to retrofit all
429  plants in  the  CBDB  that  are currently  not
practicing phosphorus removal  for the four effluent TP
limits  considered in  this  manual are given in Tables
9-2 and  9-3  for the  influent TP concentration
ranges of 6 to 10 and 3 to 6 mg/l, respectively. These
costs  are for the chemical storage, feed, and piping
systems only. They  do not include  the costs for pH
control, additional plant capacity or sludge handling
equipment, increased sludge  disposal  quantities,  or
effluent polishing.

Table 9-2 indicates that the  total  capital  cost for
chemical storage and feed to retrofit these 429 plants
would be  approximately  $29,000,000 for an influent
TP concentration range of 6 to 10  mg/l and effluent
TP limitations of 2, 1, or  0.5 mg/l. For an effluent TP
limitation  of  0.2-mg/l,  the  cost  increases
approximately 35 percent to $39,000,000. For influent
TP concentrations of  3  to 6 mg/l, the estimated
capital costs are approximately 5 percent less  than
those for an influent TP in the range of 6 to 10 mg/l.

O&M cost totals are not shown because they must be
calculated for each individual plant  size in the CBDB
matrix. This  can be done by using  the annual
chemical cost range chart presented in  Table 9-4.

As indicated previously  in Chapter 2,  a theoretical
model being developed  from  research currently  in
progress  (1,2) predicts  that metal ion  dose
requirements to attain low effluent TP concentrations
of  <1  mg/l  are  independent of  influent  TP
concentration.  Published data confirming this model
are lacking at this time. In the absence of such data,
the tabular summaries of estimated capital costs and
estimated  annual  chemical costs for  chemical
phosphorus  removal given  in this chapter are based
on  conventional metal  ion-to-influent  TP  dose
ratios for all  four effluent TP limitations considered in
this  document.  If this  theory  (1,2)  is eventually
verified, the  estimated capital costs  to  achieve 0.5-
and  0.2-mg/l effluent TP concentrations in  Table  9-
1 would become the same for both the 6-10 and  3-
6 mg/l influent TP  ranges. Similarly, the estimated
capital costs in the 0.5- and 0.2-mg/l effluent  TP
columns  in  Tables 9-2  and  9-3  would  become
identical.  Finally, no distinction  between the annual
chemical  costs for  the  0.5-  and 0.2-mg/l  effluent
TP  limits in  Table 9-4 would  be appropriate for the
two influent TP ranges.

Capital and O&M costs for necessary sludge handling
improvements will vary depending on the amount  of
sludge handling capacity available at each plant, the
types of sludge treatment and handling processes in
use, and the plant location (urban versus rural), which
generally dictates the methods of sludge disposal that
can be considered.


9.3  Comparison  of  Chemical  and
Biological Retrofit Systems
Table  9-5  summarizes the  major  differences
between chemical and biological  phosphorus  removal
retrofit systems.

9.3.7  Effect of Excessive  Infiltration/Inflow  on
Process Selection
Excessive  infiltration/inflow has no major effect on the
design of chemical retrofit systems. However, it can
seriously affect biological retrofit systems (e.g., larger
tank sizes may be required) and must be factored
into the overall design.

9.3.2 Process Reliability
Chemical  treatment  is a very reliable  process for
phosphorus removal. It is estimated that wastewater
                                               133

-------
Table 9-1.   Estimated Capital Costs to Retrofit CBDB Plants for Phosphorus Removal Using Chemical Addition, Arranged by
           Influent TP, Effluent TP, and Design Flow1
                                                           Effluent TP
 Plant Size
2.0 mg/l
1.0 mg/l
                                                                       0.5 mg/l
                                                              0.2 mg/l
                                                                          $
                                                                $
Influent TP: 6-1 0 mo/1
< 0.1 mgd
0.1 - 1 mgd
> 1 -Smgd
> 5 -10 mgd
> 10mfld2
Intluofil TP: 3-6 mg/l
< 0.1 mgd
0.1 - 1 mgd
> 1 -Smgd
> 5 -10 mgd
> 10 mgd2

34,000
54,000
130,000
170,000
213,000

34,000
34,000
115,000
160,000
200.000

34,000
54,000
130,000
170,000
213,000

34,000
54,000
115,000
160,000
200,000

34,000
54,000
145,000
170,000
213,000

34,000
54,000
120,000
170,000
213,000

41,000
87,000
185,000
200,000
250,000

41,000
79,000
185,000
200,000
250,000
  1 To put these capital costs in perspective, the approximate capital and annual O&M costs for conventional secondary treatment plants
   without phosphorus removal utilizing the activated sludge process, vacuum filter sludge dewatering, and landfilling of dewatered sludge
   are (3):
      Design Flow    Capital Cost
        0.1 mgd     $2,400.000 ($65,750/Mgal)
        1 mgd      $8,000,000 ($21,920/Mgal)
        5 mgd      $18,600,000 ($lO,l90/Mgal)
        10 mgd     $29,300,000 ($8,030/Mgal)
              Annual O&M Cost
              $200,000 ($5,480/Mgal)
              $700,000 ($1,920/Mgal)
              $1,500,000 ($820/Mgal)
              $3,000,000 ($820/Mgal)
  2Sfnce plant sizes over 10 mgd are not listed in this table, capital cost estimates of 25 percent above the 5-10 mgd estimates are assumed
   across the board.
treatment plants  utilizing  chemical  addition  for
phosphorus  removal achieve their effluent TP limits
90 percent of the time.
A sufficient data base is not available to judge long-
term reliability of  biological  phosphorus  removal at
this time. Chemical feed equipment for backup dosing
and/or effluent polishing can be installed to enhance
reliability.

9.3.3 Potential Technological Advances
Technological advances can be expected to occur in
the next  several  years in  the area  of biological
phosphorus   removal.   The    emerging
processes/concepts include:
• A/O and A2/O
• PhoStrip II
• Bardenpho
• Magnesium  ammonia  phosphate  precipitation
   during anaerobic digestion
• European  technology using  managed biological
   systems  for  nutrient  control.  Investigators in
   Denmark, Germany,  Austria,  and Japan  are
   working with a variety of process options.
• Metal salt dose requirements and optimum  dosage
   points to polish effluent TP concentrations to 0.5
   mg/l  and below  in  conjunction  with biological
   phosphorus removal processes.
                         9.3.4 Impact of License Fees
                         Certain  biological phosphorus  removal processes
                         require the payment of a license fee. The amount of
                         the fee, which can be substantial, is determined on a
                         case-by-case  basis  by  the process patent  holders.
                         It  is recommended  that  municipalities considering
                         these technologies  negotiate license fees  prior to
                         embarking on rigorous retrofit planning and design.

                         9.3.5 Degree of Operation and Control Difficulty
                         Biological  phosphorus  removal   processes  are
                         generally more difficult to operate and control than
                         chemical phosphorus removal processes. The degree
                         of difficulty  can be  significant.  Operations must be
                         adjusted to account  for  1) temperature  effects on the
                         biological activity of a complex sludge biomass, 2) the
                         ratio of  influent  BOD  to  phosphorus,  3)  internal
                         recycle  flows,  4)  sludge removal  rates  from
                         secondary clarifiers,  and 5) the phosphorus content of
                         in-plant recycle streams.

                         9.3.6 Additional Staffing Requirements
                         The estimated ranges  of  man-hours  required per
                         year to operate and  maintain a ferric chloride or alum
                         feed system were given previously  in Table 5-20 as
                         a  function  of plant  size. These man-hours can be
                         converted to numbers  of personnel by dividing by
                         1,500. For example, from the  chart, a maximum of
                                                   134

-------
Table 9-2.   Estimated Capital Costs to Retrofit CBDB Plants for Phosphorus Removal Using Chemical Addition; Influent TP
           Range: 6 - 10 mg/l
Plant Size
mgd
< 0.1



0.1 - 1



> 1 -5



> 5- 10



> 10



Total


Grand Total
State

VA
MD
PA
Total
VA
MD
PA
Total
VA
MD
PA
Total
VA
MD
PA
Total
VA
MD
PA
Total
VA
MD
PA

No. of Plants Not
Currently Practicing -
Phosphorus Removal

32
138
11
181
62
39
62
163
21
10
22
53
5
1
3
g
16
3
4
23
136
191
102
429

2.0 or 1.0
$1,000
1,088
4,692
374
6,154
3,348
2,106
3,348
8,802
2,730
1,300
2,860
6,890
850
170
510
1,530
3,408
639
852
4,89,9
11,424
8,907
7,944
28,275
Effluent TP (mg/l)
0.5
$1,000
1,088
4,692
374
6,154
3,348
2,106
3,348
8,802
3,045
1,450
3,190
7,685
850
170
510
1,530
3,408
639
852
4,899
11,739
9,057
8,274
29,070

0.2
$1,000
1,312
5,658
451
7,421
5,394
3,393
5,394
14,181
3,885
1,850
4,070
9,805
1,000
200
600
1,800
4,000
750
1,000
5,750
15,591
11,851
11,515
38,957
1,580 man-hours per year is required to operate and
maintain an alum feed system for a plant in the 0.22
to 0.4 m3/s (5 to  10 mgd) range. This equates to
about one additional staff person.

Additional  staff time will also be required to operate
and maintain biological phosphorus removal systems.
However,  due to the newness of this  technology,
additional staff time has not been quantified.

9.3.7 Degree of Maintenance Difficulty
Chemical feed systems will  typically require a higher
degree of maintenance than biological phosphorus
removal systems.  Chemical feed systems require
maintenance at the storage, makeup,  and distribution
points  of  the   system,  and  sophisticated
instrumentation maintenance for larger systems may
be  necessary. The  maintenance  problems  are
compounded  when  corrosive chemicals  like  ferric
chloride must be handled. Maintenance on biological
phosphorus removal systems should be limited to the
tank mixers  and recycle  pumps, which is relatively
simple, safe, and inexpensive to provide.


9.4 Administrative issues
9.4.1  Planning   and  Construction  Period
Schedules
The estimated time periods necessary to  retrofit  a
wastewater treatment  plant  for phosphorus removal
are shown  in Table 9-6. The times shown are from
the initiation of design through plant startup.

9.4.2 Operator Training Seminars
It  is recommended that  each state  in  the CBDB
conduct operator training  seminars  for  phosphorus
removal.  These  seminars  should  be conducted at
least twice  a year at a central location.  In  addition,
plant designers should  make personnel  available to
conduct operator training  sessions at  each plant
retrofitted. These sessions should cover  the theory
and operation of the phosphorus removal system to
be used. Individual site training should begin  a  few
months prior to, and be repeated after, plant startup.

9.5 References
1.   Personal communication  from  R.I. Sedlak, The
    Soap and Detergent Association, New York, NY,
    to R.C.  Brenner, U.S. EPA, Cincinnati, OH, May
    20, 1987.

2.   Personal communication from D. Jenkins,
    University of  California,  Berkeley,  CA,  to S.J.
    Rang, McNamee, Porter and Seeley,  Ann Arbor,
    Ml, July 31, 1987.

3.   DeWolf, G., P. Murin, J. Jarvis, and M. Kelly. The
    Cost  Digest:  Cost Summaries  of Selected
    Environmental Control  Technologies.  EPA-
    600/8-84-010, U.S.  EPA,  Washington,  DC,
    October, 1984.
                                                135

-------
Table 9-3.
Estimated Capital Costs to Retrofit CBDB Plants for Phosphorus Removal Using Chemical Addition; Influent TP
Rango: 3-6 mg/l
                                         No. of Plants Not
                                                                  Effluent TP (mg/l)
Plant Size
mod
< 0.1



0.1 • 1



> 1 -5



> 5- 10



> 10



Total


Grand Total
State

VA
MD
PA
Total
VA
MD
PA
Total
VA
MD
PA
Total
VA
MD
PA
Total
VA
MD
PA
Total
VA
MD
PA

Currently Practicing —
Phosphorus Removal

32
138
11
181
62
39
62
163
21
10
22
53
5
1
3
9
16
3
4
23
136
191
102
429
2.0 or 1.0
$1,000
1,088
4,692
374
6,154
3,348
2,106
3,348
8,802
2,415
1,150
2,530
6,095
800
160
480
1,440
3,200
600
800
4,600
10,851
8,708
7.532
27,091
0.5
$1,000
1,088
4,692
374
6,154
3,348
2,106
3,348
8,802
2,520
1,200
2,640
6,360
850
170
510
1,530
3,408
639
852
4,899
11,214
8,807
7,724
27,745
0.2
$1,000
1,312
5,658
451
7,421
4,898
3,081
4,898
12,877
3,885
1,850
4,070
9,805
1,000
200
600
1,800
4,000
750
1,000
5,750
15.095
11,539
11,019
37,653
 Tablo 9-4.
  Influent TP
 Estimated  Annual  Chemical  Costs  for
 Phosphorus Removal
                       Effluent TP
                        Limitation
                               Annual
                             Chemical Cost
  6-10
  3-6
              mg/I

               2
               1
               0.5
               0.2

               2
               1
               0.5
               0.2
 $/Mgal

 68 - 84
82 -104
102 -142
137 - 350
 42-52
 50-64
 62-88
83 - 217
                                                       136

-------
Table 9-5    Comparison of Chemical and Biological Retrofit Systems

 Items                   	Chemical System
                                                                   Biological System
 Attainable Effluent TP
 Concentration

 Amenable Unit Processes
 Reliability

 Costs


 Sludge Quantities



 Operator Training
 Additional Staffing
 Requirements
 Infiltration/Inflow
 Potential Technical
 Advantages
0.2 mg/l


All secondary treatment processes can be retrofitted.


Reliable,  proven technology.

High O&M in terms of chemical and sludge handling,
more difficult to maintain.

A considerable amount of chemical sludge is
produced for which additional sludge handling facilities
may be required.

Relatively simple to operate. Some training will be
required for operation of chemical feed pumps and
systems.
An additional person may be required  depending on
the size of the  plant.



No major effect on retrofit design.
None anticipated.
1.0 mg/l (0.5 mg/l or less requires chemical addition).


Amenable only to activated sludge-type secondary
processes.

Long-term reliability not proven.
Little or no excess sludge produced, low O&M costs.
Payment of license fee may be required,

Sludge quantities will increase only slightly with the
A/O and PhoStrip processes.


More difficult to operate and control. Some training
will be required for monitoring and chemical feed
system operation for the PhoStrip process.
For the PhoStrip process, an additional person may
be required depending on the size of the plant
Additional staff should  not be necessary for the A/O
process.

Can significantly affect retrofit design.
Several anticipated.
Table 9-6.    Estimated  Time Periods  for Retrofitting  an
              Existing Plant to Phosphorus Removal

             Design, Plans,
Plant Size
mgd
< 0.1
0.1 - 1
> 1 -5
> 5- 10
> 10
& Specs
months
3
4
6
8
10
Construction
months
6
8
12
18
24
Startup
months
1
i
3
4
6
Total
months
10
13
21
30
40
                                                              137

    U.S. GOVERNMENT PRINTING OFFICE: 1987—  7 «f 8 - 1 2 1 /  S7Q31

-------

-------